1 //===--- SemaOverload.cpp - C++ Overloading -------------------------------===// 2 // 3 // The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure 4 // 5 // This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source 6 // License. See LICENSE.TXT for details. 7 // 8 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 9 // 10 // This file provides Sema routines for C++ overloading. 11 // 12 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 13 14 #include "clang/Sema/Overload.h" 15 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h" 16 #include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h" 17 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h" 18 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h" 19 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h" 20 #include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h" 21 #include "clang/AST/TypeOrdering.h" 22 #include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h" 23 #include "clang/Basic/DiagnosticOptions.h" 24 #include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h" 25 #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h" 26 #include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h" 27 #include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h" 28 #include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h" 29 #include "clang/Sema/Template.h" 30 #include "clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h" 31 #include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h" 32 #include "llvm/ADT/Optional.h" 33 #include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h" 34 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h" 35 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h" 36 #include <algorithm> 37 #include <cstdlib> 38 39 using namespace clang; 40 using namespace sema; 41 42 static bool functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(const FunctionDecl *FD) { 43 return llvm::any_of(FD->parameters(), [](const ParmVarDecl *P) { 44 return P->hasAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>(); 45 }); 46 } 47 48 /// A convenience routine for creating a decayed reference to a function. 49 static ExprResult 50 CreateFunctionRefExpr(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn, NamedDecl *FoundDecl, 51 const Expr *Base, bool HadMultipleCandidates, 52 SourceLocation Loc = SourceLocation(), 53 const DeclarationNameLoc &LocInfo = DeclarationNameLoc()){ 54 if (S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FoundDecl, Loc)) 55 return ExprError(); 56 // If FoundDecl is different from Fn (such as if one is a template 57 // and the other a specialization), make sure DiagnoseUseOfDecl is 58 // called on both. 59 // FIXME: This would be more comprehensively addressed by modifying 60 // DiagnoseUseOfDecl to accept both the FoundDecl and the decl 61 // being used. 62 if (FoundDecl != Fn && S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Fn, Loc)) 63 return ExprError(); 64 if (auto *FPT = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 65 S.ResolveExceptionSpec(Loc, FPT); 66 DeclRefExpr *DRE = new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Fn, false, Fn->getType(), 67 VK_LValue, Loc, LocInfo); 68 if (HadMultipleCandidates) 69 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(true); 70 71 S.MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE, Base); 72 return S.ImpCastExprToType(DRE, S.Context.getPointerType(DRE->getType()), 73 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay); 74 } 75 76 static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType, 77 bool InOverloadResolution, 78 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 79 bool CStyle, 80 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 81 82 static bool IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, 83 QualType &ToType, 84 bool InOverloadResolution, 85 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 86 bool CStyle); 87 static OverloadingResult 88 IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 89 UserDefinedConversionSequence& User, 90 OverloadCandidateSet& Conversions, 91 bool AllowExplicit, 92 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit); 93 94 95 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 96 CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 97 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 98 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2); 99 100 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 101 CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S, 102 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 103 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2); 104 105 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 106 CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 107 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 108 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2); 109 110 /// GetConversionRank - Retrieve the implicit conversion rank 111 /// corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind. 112 ImplicitConversionRank clang::GetConversionRank(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) { 113 static const ImplicitConversionRank 114 Rank[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = { 115 ICR_Exact_Match, 116 ICR_Exact_Match, 117 ICR_Exact_Match, 118 ICR_Exact_Match, 119 ICR_Exact_Match, 120 ICR_Exact_Match, 121 ICR_Promotion, 122 ICR_Promotion, 123 ICR_Promotion, 124 ICR_Conversion, 125 ICR_Conversion, 126 ICR_Conversion, 127 ICR_Conversion, 128 ICR_Conversion, 129 ICR_Conversion, 130 ICR_Conversion, 131 ICR_Conversion, 132 ICR_Conversion, 133 ICR_Conversion, 134 ICR_OCL_Scalar_Widening, 135 ICR_Complex_Real_Conversion, 136 ICR_Conversion, 137 ICR_Conversion, 138 ICR_Writeback_Conversion, 139 ICR_Exact_Match, // NOTE(gbiv): This may not be completely right -- 140 // it was omitted by the patch that added 141 // ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion 142 ICR_C_Conversion, 143 ICR_C_Conversion_Extension 144 }; 145 return Rank[(int)Kind]; 146 } 147 148 /// GetImplicitConversionName - Return the name of this kind of 149 /// implicit conversion. 150 static const char* GetImplicitConversionName(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) { 151 static const char* const Name[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = { 152 "No conversion", 153 "Lvalue-to-rvalue", 154 "Array-to-pointer", 155 "Function-to-pointer", 156 "Function pointer conversion", 157 "Qualification", 158 "Integral promotion", 159 "Floating point promotion", 160 "Complex promotion", 161 "Integral conversion", 162 "Floating conversion", 163 "Complex conversion", 164 "Floating-integral conversion", 165 "Pointer conversion", 166 "Pointer-to-member conversion", 167 "Boolean conversion", 168 "Compatible-types conversion", 169 "Derived-to-base conversion", 170 "Vector conversion", 171 "Vector splat", 172 "Complex-real conversion", 173 "Block Pointer conversion", 174 "Transparent Union Conversion", 175 "Writeback conversion", 176 "OpenCL Zero Event Conversion", 177 "C specific type conversion", 178 "Incompatible pointer conversion" 179 }; 180 return Name[Kind]; 181 } 182 183 /// StandardConversionSequence - Set the standard conversion 184 /// sequence to the identity conversion. 185 void StandardConversionSequence::setAsIdentityConversion() { 186 First = ICK_Identity; 187 Second = ICK_Identity; 188 Third = ICK_Identity; 189 DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false; 190 QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false; 191 ReferenceBinding = false; 192 DirectBinding = false; 193 IsLvalueReference = true; 194 BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 195 BindsToRvalue = false; 196 BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 197 ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false; 198 CopyConstructor = nullptr; 199 } 200 201 /// getRank - Retrieve the rank of this standard conversion sequence 202 /// (C++ 13.3.3.1.1p3). The rank is the largest rank of each of the 203 /// implicit conversions. 204 ImplicitConversionRank StandardConversionSequence::getRank() const { 205 ImplicitConversionRank Rank = ICR_Exact_Match; 206 if (GetConversionRank(First) > Rank) 207 Rank = GetConversionRank(First); 208 if (GetConversionRank(Second) > Rank) 209 Rank = GetConversionRank(Second); 210 if (GetConversionRank(Third) > Rank) 211 Rank = GetConversionRank(Third); 212 return Rank; 213 } 214 215 /// isPointerConversionToBool - Determines whether this conversion is 216 /// a conversion of a pointer or pointer-to-member to bool. This is 217 /// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences 218 /// (C++ 13.3.3.2p4). 219 bool StandardConversionSequence::isPointerConversionToBool() const { 220 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the 221 // array-to-pointer or function-to-pointer implicit conversions, so 222 // check for their presence as well as checking whether FromType is 223 // a pointer. 224 if (getToType(1)->isBooleanType() && 225 (getFromType()->isPointerType() || 226 getFromType()->isMemberPointerType() || 227 getFromType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() || 228 getFromType()->isBlockPointerType() || 229 getFromType()->isNullPtrType() || 230 First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer || First == ICK_Function_To_Pointer)) 231 return true; 232 233 return false; 234 } 235 236 /// isPointerConversionToVoidPointer - Determines whether this 237 /// conversion is a conversion of a pointer to a void pointer. This is 238 /// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences (C++ 239 /// 13.3.3.2p4). 240 bool 241 StandardConversionSequence:: 242 isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(ASTContext& Context) const { 243 QualType FromType = getFromType(); 244 QualType ToType = getToType(1); 245 246 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the 247 // array-to-pointer implicit conversion, so check for its presence 248 // and redo the conversion to get a pointer. 249 if (First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 250 FromType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType); 251 252 if (Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && FromType->isAnyPointerType()) 253 if (const PointerType* ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) 254 return ToPtrType->getPointeeType()->isVoidType(); 255 256 return false; 257 } 258 259 /// Skip any implicit casts which could be either part of a narrowing conversion 260 /// or after one in an implicit conversion. 261 static const Expr *IgnoreNarrowingConversion(const Expr *Converted) { 262 while (const ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Converted)) { 263 switch (ICE->getCastKind()) { 264 case CK_NoOp: 265 case CK_IntegralCast: 266 case CK_IntegralToBoolean: 267 case CK_IntegralToFloating: 268 case CK_BooleanToSignedIntegral: 269 case CK_FloatingToIntegral: 270 case CK_FloatingToBoolean: 271 case CK_FloatingCast: 272 Converted = ICE->getSubExpr(); 273 continue; 274 275 default: 276 return Converted; 277 } 278 } 279 280 return Converted; 281 } 282 283 /// Check if this standard conversion sequence represents a narrowing 284 /// conversion, according to C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7. 285 /// 286 /// \param Ctx The AST context. 287 /// \param Converted The result of applying this standard conversion sequence. 288 /// \param ConstantValue If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the 289 /// value of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion. 290 /// \param ConstantType If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the 291 /// type of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion. 292 /// \param IgnoreFloatToIntegralConversion If true type-narrowing conversions 293 /// from floating point types to integral types should be ignored. 294 NarrowingKind StandardConversionSequence::getNarrowingKind( 295 ASTContext &Ctx, const Expr *Converted, APValue &ConstantValue, 296 QualType &ConstantType, bool IgnoreFloatToIntegralConversion) const { 297 assert(Ctx.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "narrowing check outside C++"); 298 299 // C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7: 300 // A narrowing conversion is an implicit conversion ... 301 QualType FromType = getToType(0); 302 QualType ToType = getToType(1); 303 304 // A conversion to an enumeration type is narrowing if the conversion to 305 // the underlying type is narrowing. This only arises for expressions of 306 // the form 'Enum{init}'. 307 if (auto *ET = ToType->getAs<EnumType>()) 308 ToType = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 309 310 switch (Second) { 311 // 'bool' is an integral type; dispatch to the right place to handle it. 312 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion: 313 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType()) 314 goto FloatingIntegralConversion; 315 if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) 316 goto IntegralConversion; 317 // Boolean conversions can be from pointers and pointers to members 318 // [conv.bool], and those aren't considered narrowing conversions. 319 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 320 321 // -- from a floating-point type to an integer type, or 322 // 323 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to a floating-point 324 // type, except where the source is a constant expression and the actual 325 // value after conversion will fit into the target type and will produce 326 // the original value when converted back to the original type, or 327 case ICK_Floating_Integral: 328 FloatingIntegralConversion: 329 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isIntegralType(Ctx)) { 330 return NK_Type_Narrowing; 331 } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() && 332 ToType->isRealFloatingType()) { 333 if (IgnoreFloatToIntegralConversion) 334 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 335 llvm::APSInt IntConstantValue; 336 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted); 337 assert(Initializer && "Unknown conversion expression"); 338 339 // If it's value-dependent, we can't tell whether it's narrowing. 340 if (Initializer->isValueDependent()) 341 return NK_Dependent_Narrowing; 342 343 if (Initializer->isIntegerConstantExpr(IntConstantValue, Ctx)) { 344 // Convert the integer to the floating type. 345 llvm::APFloat Result(Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType)); 346 Result.convertFromAPInt(IntConstantValue, IntConstantValue.isSigned(), 347 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven); 348 // And back. 349 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = IntConstantValue; 350 bool ignored; 351 Result.convertToInteger(ConvertedValue, 352 llvm::APFloat::rmTowardZero, &ignored); 353 // If the resulting value is different, this was a narrowing conversion. 354 if (IntConstantValue != ConvertedValue) { 355 ConstantValue = APValue(IntConstantValue); 356 ConstantType = Initializer->getType(); 357 return NK_Constant_Narrowing; 358 } 359 } else { 360 // Variables are always narrowings. 361 return NK_Variable_Narrowing; 362 } 363 } 364 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 365 366 // -- from long double to double or float, or from double to float, except 367 // where the source is a constant expression and the actual value after 368 // conversion is within the range of values that can be represented (even 369 // if it cannot be represented exactly), or 370 case ICK_Floating_Conversion: 371 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType() && 372 Ctx.getFloatingTypeOrder(FromType, ToType) == 1) { 373 // FromType is larger than ToType. 374 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted); 375 376 // If it's value-dependent, we can't tell whether it's narrowing. 377 if (Initializer->isValueDependent()) 378 return NK_Dependent_Narrowing; 379 380 if (Initializer->isCXX11ConstantExpr(Ctx, &ConstantValue)) { 381 // Constant! 382 assert(ConstantValue.isFloat()); 383 llvm::APFloat FloatVal = ConstantValue.getFloat(); 384 // Convert the source value into the target type. 385 bool ignored; 386 llvm::APFloat::opStatus ConvertStatus = FloatVal.convert( 387 Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType), 388 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &ignored); 389 // If there was no overflow, the source value is within the range of 390 // values that can be represented. 391 if (ConvertStatus & llvm::APFloat::opOverflow) { 392 ConstantType = Initializer->getType(); 393 return NK_Constant_Narrowing; 394 } 395 } else { 396 return NK_Variable_Narrowing; 397 } 398 } 399 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 400 401 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to an integer type 402 // that cannot represent all the values of the original type, except where 403 // the source is a constant expression and the actual value after 404 // conversion will fit into the target type and will produce the original 405 // value when converted back to the original type. 406 case ICK_Integral_Conversion: 407 IntegralConversion: { 408 assert(FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()); 409 assert(ToType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()); 410 const bool FromSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType(); 411 const unsigned FromWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(FromType); 412 const bool ToSigned = ToType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType(); 413 const unsigned ToWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(ToType); 414 415 if (FromWidth > ToWidth || 416 (FromWidth == ToWidth && FromSigned != ToSigned) || 417 (FromSigned && !ToSigned)) { 418 // Not all values of FromType can be represented in ToType. 419 llvm::APSInt InitializerValue; 420 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted); 421 422 // If it's value-dependent, we can't tell whether it's narrowing. 423 if (Initializer->isValueDependent()) 424 return NK_Dependent_Narrowing; 425 426 if (!Initializer->isIntegerConstantExpr(InitializerValue, Ctx)) { 427 // Such conversions on variables are always narrowing. 428 return NK_Variable_Narrowing; 429 } 430 bool Narrowing = false; 431 if (FromWidth < ToWidth) { 432 // Negative -> unsigned is narrowing. Otherwise, more bits is never 433 // narrowing. 434 if (InitializerValue.isSigned() && InitializerValue.isNegative()) 435 Narrowing = true; 436 } else { 437 // Add a bit to the InitializerValue so we don't have to worry about 438 // signed vs. unsigned comparisons. 439 InitializerValue = InitializerValue.extend( 440 InitializerValue.getBitWidth() + 1); 441 // Convert the initializer to and from the target width and signed-ness. 442 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = InitializerValue; 443 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.trunc(ToWidth); 444 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(ToSigned); 445 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.extend(InitializerValue.getBitWidth()); 446 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(InitializerValue.isSigned()); 447 // If the result is different, this was a narrowing conversion. 448 if (ConvertedValue != InitializerValue) 449 Narrowing = true; 450 } 451 if (Narrowing) { 452 ConstantType = Initializer->getType(); 453 ConstantValue = APValue(InitializerValue); 454 return NK_Constant_Narrowing; 455 } 456 } 457 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 458 } 459 460 default: 461 // Other kinds of conversions are not narrowings. 462 return NK_Not_Narrowing; 463 } 464 } 465 466 /// dump - Print this standard conversion sequence to standard 467 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues. 468 LLVM_DUMP_METHOD void StandardConversionSequence::dump() const { 469 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs(); 470 bool PrintedSomething = false; 471 if (First != ICK_Identity) { 472 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(First); 473 PrintedSomething = true; 474 } 475 476 if (Second != ICK_Identity) { 477 if (PrintedSomething) { 478 OS << " -> "; 479 } 480 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Second); 481 482 if (CopyConstructor) { 483 OS << " (by copy constructor)"; 484 } else if (DirectBinding) { 485 OS << " (direct reference binding)"; 486 } else if (ReferenceBinding) { 487 OS << " (reference binding)"; 488 } 489 PrintedSomething = true; 490 } 491 492 if (Third != ICK_Identity) { 493 if (PrintedSomething) { 494 OS << " -> "; 495 } 496 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Third); 497 PrintedSomething = true; 498 } 499 500 if (!PrintedSomething) { 501 OS << "No conversions required"; 502 } 503 } 504 505 /// dump - Print this user-defined conversion sequence to standard 506 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues. 507 void UserDefinedConversionSequence::dump() const { 508 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs(); 509 if (Before.First || Before.Second || Before.Third) { 510 Before.dump(); 511 OS << " -> "; 512 } 513 if (ConversionFunction) 514 OS << '\'' << *ConversionFunction << '\''; 515 else 516 OS << "aggregate initialization"; 517 if (After.First || After.Second || After.Third) { 518 OS << " -> "; 519 After.dump(); 520 } 521 } 522 523 /// dump - Print this implicit conversion sequence to standard 524 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues. 525 void ImplicitConversionSequence::dump() const { 526 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs(); 527 if (isStdInitializerListElement()) 528 OS << "Worst std::initializer_list element conversion: "; 529 switch (ConversionKind) { 530 case StandardConversion: 531 OS << "Standard conversion: "; 532 Standard.dump(); 533 break; 534 case UserDefinedConversion: 535 OS << "User-defined conversion: "; 536 UserDefined.dump(); 537 break; 538 case EllipsisConversion: 539 OS << "Ellipsis conversion"; 540 break; 541 case AmbiguousConversion: 542 OS << "Ambiguous conversion"; 543 break; 544 case BadConversion: 545 OS << "Bad conversion"; 546 break; 547 } 548 549 OS << "\n"; 550 } 551 552 void AmbiguousConversionSequence::construct() { 553 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(); 554 } 555 556 void AmbiguousConversionSequence::destruct() { 557 conversions().~ConversionSet(); 558 } 559 560 void 561 AmbiguousConversionSequence::copyFrom(const AmbiguousConversionSequence &O) { 562 FromTypePtr = O.FromTypePtr; 563 ToTypePtr = O.ToTypePtr; 564 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(O.conversions()); 565 } 566 567 namespace { 568 // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store 569 // template argument information. 570 struct DFIArguments { 571 TemplateArgument FirstArg; 572 TemplateArgument SecondArg; 573 }; 574 // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store 575 // template parameter and template argument information. 576 struct DFIParamWithArguments : DFIArguments { 577 TemplateParameter Param; 578 }; 579 // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store template argument 580 // information and the index of the problematic call argument. 581 struct DFIDeducedMismatchArgs : DFIArguments { 582 TemplateArgumentList *TemplateArgs; 583 unsigned CallArgIndex; 584 }; 585 } 586 587 /// Convert from Sema's representation of template deduction information 588 /// to the form used in overload-candidate information. 589 DeductionFailureInfo 590 clang::MakeDeductionFailureInfo(ASTContext &Context, 591 Sema::TemplateDeductionResult TDK, 592 TemplateDeductionInfo &Info) { 593 DeductionFailureInfo Result; 594 Result.Result = static_cast<unsigned>(TDK); 595 Result.HasDiagnostic = false; 596 switch (TDK) { 597 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 598 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 599 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 600 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 601 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 602 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 603 Result.Data = nullptr; 604 break; 605 606 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 607 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 608 Result.Data = Info.Param.getOpaqueValue(); 609 break; 610 611 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 612 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: { 613 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later. 614 auto *Saved = new (Context) DFIDeducedMismatchArgs; 615 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg; 616 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg; 617 Saved->TemplateArgs = Info.take(); 618 Saved->CallArgIndex = Info.CallArgIndex; 619 Result.Data = Saved; 620 break; 621 } 622 623 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: { 624 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later. 625 DFIArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIArguments; 626 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg; 627 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg; 628 Result.Data = Saved; 629 break; 630 } 631 632 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 633 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: { 634 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later. 635 DFIParamWithArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIParamWithArguments; 636 Saved->Param = Info.Param; 637 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg; 638 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg; 639 Result.Data = Saved; 640 break; 641 } 642 643 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 644 Result.Data = Info.take(); 645 if (Info.hasSFINAEDiagnostic()) { 646 PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = new (Result.Diagnostic) PartialDiagnosticAt( 647 SourceLocation(), PartialDiagnostic::NullDiagnostic()); 648 Info.takeSFINAEDiagnostic(*Diag); 649 Result.HasDiagnostic = true; 650 } 651 break; 652 653 case Sema::TDK_Success: 654 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 655 llvm_unreachable("not a deduction failure"); 656 } 657 658 return Result; 659 } 660 661 void DeductionFailureInfo::Destroy() { 662 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 663 case Sema::TDK_Success: 664 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 665 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 666 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 667 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 668 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 669 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 670 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 671 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 672 break; 673 674 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 675 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 676 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 677 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 678 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 679 // FIXME: Destroy the data? 680 Data = nullptr; 681 break; 682 683 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 684 // FIXME: Destroy the template argument list? 685 Data = nullptr; 686 if (PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = getSFINAEDiagnostic()) { 687 Diag->~PartialDiagnosticAt(); 688 HasDiagnostic = false; 689 } 690 break; 691 692 // Unhandled 693 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 694 break; 695 } 696 } 697 698 PartialDiagnosticAt *DeductionFailureInfo::getSFINAEDiagnostic() { 699 if (HasDiagnostic) 700 return static_cast<PartialDiagnosticAt*>(static_cast<void*>(Diagnostic)); 701 return nullptr; 702 } 703 704 TemplateParameter DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateParameter() { 705 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 706 case Sema::TDK_Success: 707 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 708 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 709 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 710 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 711 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 712 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 713 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 714 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 715 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 716 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 717 return TemplateParameter(); 718 719 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 720 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 721 return TemplateParameter::getFromOpaqueValue(Data); 722 723 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 724 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 725 return static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->Param; 726 727 // Unhandled 728 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 729 break; 730 } 731 732 return TemplateParameter(); 733 } 734 735 TemplateArgumentList *DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateArgumentList() { 736 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 737 case Sema::TDK_Success: 738 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 739 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 740 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 741 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 742 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 743 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 744 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 745 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 746 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 747 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 748 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 749 return nullptr; 750 751 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 752 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 753 return static_cast<DFIDeducedMismatchArgs*>(Data)->TemplateArgs; 754 755 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 756 return static_cast<TemplateArgumentList*>(Data); 757 758 // Unhandled 759 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 760 break; 761 } 762 763 return nullptr; 764 } 765 766 const TemplateArgument *DeductionFailureInfo::getFirstArg() { 767 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 768 case Sema::TDK_Success: 769 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 770 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 771 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 772 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 773 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 774 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 775 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 776 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 777 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 778 return nullptr; 779 780 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 781 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 782 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 783 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 784 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 785 return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->FirstArg; 786 787 // Unhandled 788 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 789 break; 790 } 791 792 return nullptr; 793 } 794 795 const TemplateArgument *DeductionFailureInfo::getSecondArg() { 796 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 797 case Sema::TDK_Success: 798 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 799 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 800 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 801 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 802 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 803 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 804 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 805 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 806 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 807 return nullptr; 808 809 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 810 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 811 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 812 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 813 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 814 return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->SecondArg; 815 816 // Unhandled 817 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 818 break; 819 } 820 821 return nullptr; 822 } 823 824 llvm::Optional<unsigned> DeductionFailureInfo::getCallArgIndex() { 825 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) { 826 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 827 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 828 return static_cast<DFIDeducedMismatchArgs*>(Data)->CallArgIndex; 829 830 default: 831 return llvm::None; 832 } 833 } 834 835 void OverloadCandidateSet::destroyCandidates() { 836 for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) { 837 for (auto &C : i->Conversions) 838 C.~ImplicitConversionSequence(); 839 if (!i->Viable && i->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) 840 i->DeductionFailure.Destroy(); 841 } 842 } 843 844 void OverloadCandidateSet::clear(CandidateSetKind CSK) { 845 destroyCandidates(); 846 SlabAllocator.Reset(); 847 NumInlineBytesUsed = 0; 848 Candidates.clear(); 849 Functions.clear(); 850 Kind = CSK; 851 } 852 853 namespace { 854 class UnbridgedCastsSet { 855 struct Entry { 856 Expr **Addr; 857 Expr *Saved; 858 }; 859 SmallVector<Entry, 2> Entries; 860 861 public: 862 void save(Sema &S, Expr *&E) { 863 assert(E->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast)); 864 Entry entry = { &E, E }; 865 Entries.push_back(entry); 866 E = S.stripARCUnbridgedCast(E); 867 } 868 869 void restore() { 870 for (SmallVectorImpl<Entry>::iterator 871 i = Entries.begin(), e = Entries.end(); i != e; ++i) 872 *i->Addr = i->Saved; 873 } 874 }; 875 } 876 877 /// checkPlaceholderForOverload - Do any interesting placeholder-like 878 /// preprocessing on the given expression. 879 /// 880 /// \param unbridgedCasts a collection to which to add unbridged casts; 881 /// without this, they will be immediately diagnosed as errors 882 /// 883 /// Return true on unrecoverable error. 884 static bool 885 checkPlaceholderForOverload(Sema &S, Expr *&E, 886 UnbridgedCastsSet *unbridgedCasts = nullptr) { 887 if (const BuiltinType *placeholder = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) { 888 // We can't handle overloaded expressions here because overload 889 // resolution might reasonably tweak them. 890 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) return false; 891 892 // If the context potentially accepts unbridged ARC casts, strip 893 // the unbridged cast and add it to the collection for later restoration. 894 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast && 895 unbridgedCasts) { 896 unbridgedCasts->save(S, E); 897 return false; 898 } 899 900 // Go ahead and check everything else. 901 ExprResult result = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(E); 902 if (result.isInvalid()) 903 return true; 904 905 E = result.get(); 906 return false; 907 } 908 909 // Nothing to do. 910 return false; 911 } 912 913 /// checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload - Check a set of call operands for 914 /// placeholders. 915 static bool checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(Sema &S, 916 MultiExprArg Args, 917 UnbridgedCastsSet &unbridged) { 918 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Args.size(); i != e; ++i) 919 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, Args[i], &unbridged)) 920 return true; 921 922 return false; 923 } 924 925 /// Determine whether the given New declaration is an overload of the 926 /// declarations in Old. This routine returns Ovl_Match or Ovl_NonFunction if 927 /// New and Old cannot be overloaded, e.g., if New has the same signature as 928 /// some function in Old (C++ 1.3.10) or if the Old declarations aren't 929 /// functions (or function templates) at all. When it does return Ovl_Match or 930 /// Ovl_NonFunction, MatchedDecl will point to the decl that New cannot be 931 /// overloaded with. This decl may be a UsingShadowDecl on top of the underlying 932 /// declaration. 933 /// 934 /// Example: Given the following input: 935 /// 936 /// void f(int, float); // #1 937 /// void f(int, int); // #2 938 /// int f(int, int); // #3 939 /// 940 /// When we process #1, there is no previous declaration of "f", so IsOverload 941 /// will not be used. 942 /// 943 /// When we process #2, Old contains only the FunctionDecl for #1. By comparing 944 /// the parameter types, we see that #1 and #2 are overloaded (since they have 945 /// different signatures), so this routine returns Ovl_Overload; MatchedDecl is 946 /// unchanged. 947 /// 948 /// When we process #3, Old is an overload set containing #1 and #2. We compare 949 /// the signatures of #3 to #1 (they're overloaded, so we do nothing) and then 950 /// #3 to #2. Since the signatures of #3 and #2 are identical (return types of 951 /// functions are not part of the signature), IsOverload returns Ovl_Match and 952 /// MatchedDecl will be set to point to the FunctionDecl for #2. 953 /// 954 /// 'NewIsUsingShadowDecl' indicates that 'New' is being introduced into a class 955 /// by a using declaration. The rules for whether to hide shadow declarations 956 /// ignore some properties which otherwise figure into a function template's 957 /// signature. 958 Sema::OverloadKind 959 Sema::CheckOverload(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *New, const LookupResult &Old, 960 NamedDecl *&Match, bool NewIsUsingDecl) { 961 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Old.begin(), E = Old.end(); 962 I != E; ++I) { 963 NamedDecl *OldD = *I; 964 965 bool OldIsUsingDecl = false; 966 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) { 967 OldIsUsingDecl = true; 968 969 // We can always introduce two using declarations into the same 970 // context, even if they have identical signatures. 971 if (NewIsUsingDecl) continue; 972 973 OldD = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)->getTargetDecl(); 974 } 975 976 // A using-declaration does not conflict with another declaration 977 // if one of them is hidden. 978 if ((OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && !isVisible(*I)) 979 continue; 980 981 // If either declaration was introduced by a using declaration, 982 // we'll need to use slightly different rules for matching. 983 // Essentially, these rules are the normal rules, except that 984 // function templates hide function templates with different 985 // return types or template parameter lists. 986 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules = 987 (OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && CurContext->isRecord() && 988 !New->getFriendObjectKind(); 989 990 if (FunctionDecl *OldF = OldD->getAsFunction()) { 991 if (!IsOverload(New, OldF, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) { 992 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) { 993 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I)); 994 continue; 995 } 996 997 if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldD) && 998 !shouldLinkPossiblyHiddenDecl(*I, New)) 999 continue; 1000 1001 Match = *I; 1002 return Ovl_Match; 1003 } 1004 1005 // Builtins that have custom typechecking or have a reference should 1006 // not be overloadable or redeclarable. 1007 if (!getASTContext().canBuiltinBeRedeclared(OldF)) { 1008 Match = *I; 1009 return Ovl_NonFunction; 1010 } 1011 } else if (isa<UsingDecl>(OldD) || isa<UsingPackDecl>(OldD)) { 1012 // We can overload with these, which can show up when doing 1013 // redeclaration checks for UsingDecls. 1014 assert(Old.getLookupKind() == LookupUsingDeclName); 1015 } else if (isa<TagDecl>(OldD)) { 1016 // We can always overload with tags by hiding them. 1017 } else if (auto *UUD = dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(OldD)) { 1018 // Optimistically assume that an unresolved using decl will 1019 // overload; if it doesn't, we'll have to diagnose during 1020 // template instantiation. 1021 // 1022 // Exception: if the scope is dependent and this is not a class 1023 // member, the using declaration can only introduce an enumerator. 1024 if (UUD->getQualifier()->isDependent() && !UUD->isCXXClassMember()) { 1025 Match = *I; 1026 return Ovl_NonFunction; 1027 } 1028 } else { 1029 // (C++ 13p1): 1030 // Only function declarations can be overloaded; object and type 1031 // declarations cannot be overloaded. 1032 Match = *I; 1033 return Ovl_NonFunction; 1034 } 1035 } 1036 1037 return Ovl_Overload; 1038 } 1039 1040 bool Sema::IsOverload(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old, 1041 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules, bool ConsiderCudaAttrs) { 1042 // C++ [basic.start.main]p2: This function shall not be overloaded. 1043 if (New->isMain()) 1044 return false; 1045 1046 // MSVCRT user defined entry points cannot be overloaded. 1047 if (New->isMSVCRTEntryPoint()) 1048 return false; 1049 1050 FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = Old->getDescribedFunctionTemplate(); 1051 FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate(); 1052 1053 // C++ [temp.fct]p2: 1054 // A function template can be overloaded with other function templates 1055 // and with normal (non-template) functions. 1056 if ((OldTemplate == nullptr) != (NewTemplate == nullptr)) 1057 return true; 1058 1059 // Is the function New an overload of the function Old? 1060 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType()); 1061 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType()); 1062 1063 // Compare the signatures (C++ 1.3.10) of the two functions to 1064 // determine whether they are overloads. If we find any mismatch 1065 // in the signature, they are overloads. 1066 1067 // If either of these functions is a K&R-style function (no 1068 // prototype), then we consider them to have matching signatures. 1069 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(OldQType.getTypePtr()) || 1070 isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewQType.getTypePtr())) 1071 return false; 1072 1073 const FunctionProtoType *OldType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldQType); 1074 const FunctionProtoType *NewType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(NewQType); 1075 1076 // The signature of a function includes the types of its 1077 // parameters (C++ 1.3.10), which includes the presence or absence 1078 // of the ellipsis; see C++ DR 357). 1079 if (OldQType != NewQType && 1080 (OldType->getNumParams() != NewType->getNumParams() || 1081 OldType->isVariadic() != NewType->isVariadic() || 1082 !FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(OldType, NewType))) 1083 return true; 1084 1085 // C++ [temp.over.link]p4: 1086 // The signature of a function template consists of its function 1087 // signature, its return type and its template parameter list. The names 1088 // of the template parameters are significant only for establishing the 1089 // relationship between the template parameters and the rest of the 1090 // signature. 1091 // 1092 // We check the return type and template parameter lists for function 1093 // templates first; the remaining checks follow. 1094 // 1095 // However, we don't consider either of these when deciding whether 1096 // a member introduced by a shadow declaration is hidden. 1097 if (!UseMemberUsingDeclRules && NewTemplate && 1098 (!TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 1099 OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(), 1100 false, TPL_TemplateMatch) || 1101 OldType->getReturnType() != NewType->getReturnType())) 1102 return true; 1103 1104 // If the function is a class member, its signature includes the 1105 // cv-qualifiers (if any) and ref-qualifier (if any) on the function itself. 1106 // 1107 // As part of this, also check whether one of the member functions 1108 // is static, in which case they are not overloads (C++ 1109 // 13.1p2). While not part of the definition of the signature, 1110 // this check is important to determine whether these functions 1111 // can be overloaded. 1112 CXXMethodDecl *OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old); 1113 CXXMethodDecl *NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New); 1114 if (OldMethod && NewMethod && 1115 !OldMethod->isStatic() && !NewMethod->isStatic()) { 1116 if (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier()) { 1117 if (!UseMemberUsingDeclRules && 1118 (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None || 1119 NewMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None)) { 1120 // C++0x [over.load]p2: 1121 // - Member function declarations with the same name and the same 1122 // parameter-type-list as well as member function template 1123 // declarations with the same name, the same parameter-type-list, and 1124 // the same template parameter lists cannot be overloaded if any of 1125 // them, but not all, have a ref-qualifier (8.3.5). 1126 Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), diag::err_ref_qualifier_overload) 1127 << NewMethod->getRefQualifier() << OldMethod->getRefQualifier(); 1128 Diag(OldMethod->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration); 1129 } 1130 return true; 1131 } 1132 1133 // We may not have applied the implicit const for a constexpr member 1134 // function yet (because we haven't yet resolved whether this is a static 1135 // or non-static member function). Add it now, on the assumption that this 1136 // is a redeclaration of OldMethod. 1137 unsigned OldQuals = OldMethod->getTypeQualifiers(); 1138 unsigned NewQuals = NewMethod->getTypeQualifiers(); 1139 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && NewMethod->isConstexpr() && 1140 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewMethod)) 1141 NewQuals |= Qualifiers::Const; 1142 1143 // We do not allow overloading based off of '__restrict'. 1144 OldQuals &= ~Qualifiers::Restrict; 1145 NewQuals &= ~Qualifiers::Restrict; 1146 if (OldQuals != NewQuals) 1147 return true; 1148 } 1149 1150 // Though pass_object_size is placed on parameters and takes an argument, we 1151 // consider it to be a function-level modifier for the sake of function 1152 // identity. Either the function has one or more parameters with 1153 // pass_object_size or it doesn't. 1154 if (functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(New) != 1155 functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Old)) 1156 return true; 1157 1158 // enable_if attributes are an order-sensitive part of the signature. 1159 for (specific_attr_iterator<EnableIfAttr> 1160 NewI = New->specific_attr_begin<EnableIfAttr>(), 1161 NewE = New->specific_attr_end<EnableIfAttr>(), 1162 OldI = Old->specific_attr_begin<EnableIfAttr>(), 1163 OldE = Old->specific_attr_end<EnableIfAttr>(); 1164 NewI != NewE || OldI != OldE; ++NewI, ++OldI) { 1165 if (NewI == NewE || OldI == OldE) 1166 return true; 1167 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID NewID, OldID; 1168 NewI->getCond()->Profile(NewID, Context, true); 1169 OldI->getCond()->Profile(OldID, Context, true); 1170 if (NewID != OldID) 1171 return true; 1172 } 1173 1174 if (getLangOpts().CUDA && ConsiderCudaAttrs) { 1175 // Don't allow overloading of destructors. (In theory we could, but it 1176 // would be a giant change to clang.) 1177 if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(New)) 1178 return false; 1179 1180 CUDAFunctionTarget NewTarget = IdentifyCUDATarget(New), 1181 OldTarget = IdentifyCUDATarget(Old); 1182 if (NewTarget == CFT_InvalidTarget) 1183 return false; 1184 1185 assert((OldTarget != CFT_InvalidTarget) && "Unexpected invalid target."); 1186 1187 // Allow overloading of functions with same signature and different CUDA 1188 // target attributes. 1189 return NewTarget != OldTarget; 1190 } 1191 1192 // The signatures match; this is not an overload. 1193 return false; 1194 } 1195 1196 /// Checks availability of the function depending on the current 1197 /// function context. Inside an unavailable function, unavailability is ignored. 1198 /// 1199 /// \returns true if \arg FD is unavailable and current context is inside 1200 /// an available function, false otherwise. 1201 bool Sema::isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(FunctionDecl *FD) { 1202 if (!FD->isUnavailable()) 1203 return false; 1204 1205 // Walk up the context of the caller. 1206 Decl *C = cast<Decl>(CurContext); 1207 do { 1208 if (C->isUnavailable()) 1209 return false; 1210 } while ((C = cast_or_null<Decl>(C->getDeclContext()))); 1211 return true; 1212 } 1213 1214 /// Tries a user-defined conversion from From to ToType. 1215 /// 1216 /// Produces an implicit conversion sequence for when a standard conversion 1217 /// is not an option. See TryImplicitConversion for more information. 1218 static ImplicitConversionSequence 1219 TryUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1220 bool SuppressUserConversions, 1221 bool AllowExplicit, 1222 bool InOverloadResolution, 1223 bool CStyle, 1224 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 1225 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) { 1226 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 1227 1228 if (SuppressUserConversions) { 1229 // We're not in the case above, so there is no conversion that 1230 // we can perform. 1231 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 1232 return ICS; 1233 } 1234 1235 // Attempt user-defined conversion. 1236 OverloadCandidateSet Conversions(From->getExprLoc(), 1237 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 1238 switch (IsUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, 1239 Conversions, AllowExplicit, 1240 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit)) { 1241 case OR_Success: 1242 case OR_Deleted: 1243 ICS.setUserDefined(); 1244 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4: 1245 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class 1246 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an 1247 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is 1248 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy 1249 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is 1250 // called for those cases. 1251 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor 1252 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)) { 1253 QualType FromCanon 1254 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType()); 1255 QualType ToCanon 1256 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType(); 1257 if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor() && 1258 (FromCanon == ToCanon || 1259 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getLocStart(), FromCanon, ToCanon))) { 1260 // Turn this into a "standard" conversion sequence, so that it 1261 // gets ranked with standard conversion sequences. 1262 DeclAccessPair Found = ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction; 1263 ICS.setStandard(); 1264 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 1265 ICS.Standard.setFromType(From->getType()); 1266 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 1267 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = Constructor; 1268 ICS.Standard.FoundCopyConstructor = Found; 1269 if (ToCanon != FromCanon) 1270 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base; 1271 } 1272 } 1273 break; 1274 1275 case OR_Ambiguous: 1276 ICS.setAmbiguous(); 1277 ICS.Ambiguous.setFromType(From->getType()); 1278 ICS.Ambiguous.setToType(ToType); 1279 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = Conversions.begin(); 1280 Cand != Conversions.end(); ++Cand) 1281 if (Cand->Viable) 1282 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function); 1283 break; 1284 1285 // Fall through. 1286 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 1287 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 1288 break; 1289 } 1290 1291 return ICS; 1292 } 1293 1294 /// TryImplicitConversion - Attempt to perform an implicit conversion 1295 /// from the given expression (Expr) to the given type (ToType). This 1296 /// function returns an implicit conversion sequence that can be used 1297 /// to perform the initialization. Given 1298 /// 1299 /// void f(float f); 1300 /// void g(int i) { f(i); } 1301 /// 1302 /// this routine would produce an implicit conversion sequence to 1303 /// describe the initialization of f from i, which will be a standard 1304 /// conversion sequence containing an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++ 1305 /// 4.1) followed by a floating-integral conversion (C++ 4.9). 1306 // 1307 /// Note that this routine only determines how the conversion can be 1308 /// performed; it does not actually perform the conversion. As such, 1309 /// it will not produce any diagnostics if no conversion is available, 1310 /// but will instead return an implicit conversion sequence of kind 1311 /// "BadConversion". 1312 /// 1313 /// If @p SuppressUserConversions, then user-defined conversions are 1314 /// not permitted. 1315 /// If @p AllowExplicit, then explicit user-defined conversions are 1316 /// permitted. 1317 /// 1318 /// \param AllowObjCWritebackConversion Whether we allow the Objective-C 1319 /// writeback conversion, which allows __autoreleasing id* parameters to 1320 /// be initialized with __strong id* or __weak id* arguments. 1321 static ImplicitConversionSequence 1322 TryImplicitConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1323 bool SuppressUserConversions, 1324 bool AllowExplicit, 1325 bool InOverloadResolution, 1326 bool CStyle, 1327 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 1328 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) { 1329 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 1330 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution, 1331 ICS.Standard, CStyle, AllowObjCWritebackConversion)){ 1332 ICS.setStandard(); 1333 return ICS; 1334 } 1335 1336 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 1337 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 1338 return ICS; 1339 } 1340 1341 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4: 1342 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class 1343 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an 1344 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is 1345 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy/move 1346 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is 1347 // called for those cases. 1348 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 1349 if (ToType->getAs<RecordType>() && FromType->getAs<RecordType>() && 1350 (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType) || 1351 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getLocStart(), FromType, ToType))) { 1352 ICS.setStandard(); 1353 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 1354 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType); 1355 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 1356 1357 // We don't actually check at this point whether there is a valid 1358 // copy/move constructor, since overloading just assumes that it 1359 // exists. When we actually perform initialization, we'll find the 1360 // appropriate constructor to copy the returned object, if needed. 1361 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = nullptr; 1362 1363 // Determine whether this is considered a derived-to-base conversion. 1364 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 1365 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base; 1366 1367 return ICS; 1368 } 1369 1370 return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions, 1371 AllowExplicit, InOverloadResolution, CStyle, 1372 AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 1373 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit); 1374 } 1375 1376 ImplicitConversionSequence 1377 Sema::TryImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1378 bool SuppressUserConversions, 1379 bool AllowExplicit, 1380 bool InOverloadResolution, 1381 bool CStyle, 1382 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) { 1383 return ::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType, 1384 SuppressUserConversions, AllowExplicit, 1385 InOverloadResolution, CStyle, 1386 AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 1387 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 1388 } 1389 1390 /// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the 1391 /// expression From to the type ToType. Returns the 1392 /// converted expression. Flavor is the kind of conversion we're 1393 /// performing, used in the error message. If @p AllowExplicit, 1394 /// explicit user-defined conversions are permitted. 1395 ExprResult 1396 Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1397 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit) { 1398 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 1399 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, Action, AllowExplicit, ICS); 1400 } 1401 1402 ExprResult 1403 Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1404 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit, 1405 ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS) { 1406 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From)) 1407 return ExprError(); 1408 1409 // Objective-C ARC: Determine whether we will allow the writeback conversion. 1410 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion 1411 = getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && 1412 (Action == AA_Passing || Action == AA_Sending); 1413 if (getLangOpts().ObjC1) 1414 CheckObjCBridgeRelatedConversions(From->getLocStart(), 1415 ToType, From->getType(), From); 1416 ICS = ::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType, 1417 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 1418 AllowExplicit, 1419 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 1420 /*CStyle=*/false, 1421 AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 1422 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 1423 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, ICS, Action); 1424 } 1425 1426 /// Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid 1427 /// conversion that strips "noexcept" or "noreturn" off the nested function 1428 /// type. 1429 bool Sema::IsFunctionConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 1430 QualType &ResultTy) { 1431 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 1432 return false; 1433 1434 // Permit the conversion F(t __attribute__((noreturn))) -> F(t) 1435 // or F(t noexcept) -> F(t) 1436 // where F adds one of the following at most once: 1437 // - a pointer 1438 // - a member pointer 1439 // - a block pointer 1440 // Changes here need matching changes in FindCompositePointerType. 1441 CanQualType CanTo = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType); 1442 CanQualType CanFrom = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 1443 Type::TypeClass TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass(); 1444 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false; 1445 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) { 1446 if (TyClass == Type::Pointer) { 1447 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 1448 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 1449 } else if (TyClass == Type::BlockPointer) { 1450 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 1451 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 1452 } else if (TyClass == Type::MemberPointer) { 1453 auto ToMPT = CanTo.getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 1454 auto FromMPT = CanFrom.getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 1455 // A function pointer conversion cannot change the class of the function. 1456 if (ToMPT->getClass() != FromMPT->getClass()) 1457 return false; 1458 CanTo = ToMPT->getPointeeType(); 1459 CanFrom = FromMPT->getPointeeType(); 1460 } else { 1461 return false; 1462 } 1463 1464 TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass(); 1465 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false; 1466 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) 1467 return false; 1468 } 1469 1470 const auto *FromFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanFrom); 1471 FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFn->getExtInfo(); 1472 1473 const auto *ToFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanTo); 1474 FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFn->getExtInfo(); 1475 1476 bool Changed = false; 1477 1478 // Drop 'noreturn' if not present in target type. 1479 if (FromEInfo.getNoReturn() && !ToEInfo.getNoReturn()) { 1480 FromFn = Context.adjustFunctionType(FromFn, FromEInfo.withNoReturn(false)); 1481 Changed = true; 1482 } 1483 1484 // Drop 'noexcept' if not present in target type. 1485 if (const auto *FromFPT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FromFn)) { 1486 const auto *ToFPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(ToFn); 1487 if (FromFPT->isNothrow() && !ToFPT->isNothrow()) { 1488 FromFn = cast<FunctionType>( 1489 Context.getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(QualType(FromFPT, 0), 1490 EST_None) 1491 .getTypePtr()); 1492 Changed = true; 1493 } 1494 1495 // Convert FromFPT's ExtParameterInfo if necessary. The conversion is valid 1496 // only if the ExtParameterInfo lists of the two function prototypes can be 1497 // merged and the merged list is identical to ToFPT's ExtParameterInfo list. 1498 SmallVector<FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo, 4> NewParamInfos; 1499 bool CanUseToFPT, CanUseFromFPT; 1500 if (Context.mergeExtParameterInfo(ToFPT, FromFPT, CanUseToFPT, 1501 CanUseFromFPT, NewParamInfos) && 1502 CanUseToFPT && !CanUseFromFPT) { 1503 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo ExtInfo = FromFPT->getExtProtoInfo(); 1504 ExtInfo.ExtParameterInfos = 1505 NewParamInfos.empty() ? nullptr : NewParamInfos.data(); 1506 QualType QT = Context.getFunctionType(FromFPT->getReturnType(), 1507 FromFPT->getParamTypes(), ExtInfo); 1508 FromFn = QT->getAs<FunctionType>(); 1509 Changed = true; 1510 } 1511 } 1512 1513 if (!Changed) 1514 return false; 1515 1516 assert(QualType(FromFn, 0).isCanonical()); 1517 if (QualType(FromFn, 0) != CanTo) return false; 1518 1519 ResultTy = ToType; 1520 return true; 1521 } 1522 1523 /// Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid 1524 /// vector conversion. 1525 /// 1526 /// \param ICK Will be set to the vector conversion kind, if this is a vector 1527 /// conversion. 1528 static bool IsVectorConversion(Sema &S, QualType FromType, 1529 QualType ToType, ImplicitConversionKind &ICK) { 1530 // We need at least one of these types to be a vector type to have a vector 1531 // conversion. 1532 if (!ToType->isVectorType() && !FromType->isVectorType()) 1533 return false; 1534 1535 // Identical types require no conversions. 1536 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 1537 return false; 1538 1539 // There are no conversions between extended vector types, only identity. 1540 if (ToType->isExtVectorType()) { 1541 // There are no conversions between extended vector types other than the 1542 // identity conversion. 1543 if (FromType->isExtVectorType()) 1544 return false; 1545 1546 // Vector splat from any arithmetic type to a vector. 1547 if (FromType->isArithmeticType()) { 1548 ICK = ICK_Vector_Splat; 1549 return true; 1550 } 1551 } 1552 1553 // We can perform the conversion between vector types in the following cases: 1554 // 1)vector types are equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types 1555 // 2)lax vector conversions are permitted and the vector types are of the 1556 // same size 1557 if (ToType->isVectorType() && FromType->isVectorType()) { 1558 if (S.Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromType, ToType) || 1559 S.isLaxVectorConversion(FromType, ToType)) { 1560 ICK = ICK_Vector_Conversion; 1561 return true; 1562 } 1563 } 1564 1565 return false; 1566 } 1567 1568 static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 1569 bool InOverloadResolution, 1570 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 1571 bool CStyle); 1572 1573 /// IsStandardConversion - Determines whether there is a standard 1574 /// conversion sequence (C++ [conv], C++ [over.ics.scs]) from the 1575 /// expression From to the type ToType. Standard conversion sequences 1576 /// only consider non-class types; for conversions that involve class 1577 /// types, use TryImplicitConversion. If a conversion exists, SCS will 1578 /// contain the standard conversion sequence required to perform this 1579 /// conversion and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this 1580 /// routine will return false and the value of SCS is unspecified. 1581 static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType, 1582 bool InOverloadResolution, 1583 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 1584 bool CStyle, 1585 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) { 1586 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 1587 1588 // Standard conversions (C++ [conv]) 1589 SCS.setAsIdentityConversion(); 1590 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = false; 1591 SCS.setFromType(FromType); 1592 SCS.CopyConstructor = nullptr; 1593 1594 // There are no standard conversions for class types in C++, so 1595 // abort early. When overloading in C, however, we do permit them. 1596 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 1597 (FromType->isRecordType() || ToType->isRecordType())) 1598 return false; 1599 1600 // The first conversion can be an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, 1601 // array-to-pointer conversion, or function-to-pointer conversion 1602 // (C++ 4p1). 1603 1604 if (FromType == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 1605 DeclAccessPair AccessPair; 1606 if (FunctionDecl *Fn 1607 = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(From, ToType, false, 1608 AccessPair)) { 1609 // We were able to resolve the address of the overloaded function, 1610 // so we can convert to the type of that function. 1611 FromType = Fn->getType(); 1612 SCS.setFromType(FromType); 1613 1614 // we can sometimes resolve &foo<int> regardless of ToType, so check 1615 // if the type matches (identity) or we are converting to bool 1616 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType( 1617 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), FromType)) { 1618 QualType resultTy; 1619 // if the function type matches except for [[noreturn]], it's ok 1620 if (!S.IsFunctionConversion(FromType, 1621 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), resultTy)) 1622 // otherwise, only a boolean conversion is standard 1623 if (!ToType->isBooleanType()) 1624 return false; 1625 } 1626 1627 // Check if the "from" expression is taking the address of an overloaded 1628 // function and recompute the FromType accordingly. Take advantage of the 1629 // fact that non-static member functions *must* have such an address-of 1630 // expression. 1631 CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn); 1632 if (Method && !Method->isStatic()) { 1633 assert(isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens()) && 1634 "Non-unary operator on non-static member address"); 1635 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() 1636 == UO_AddrOf && 1637 "Non-address-of operator on non-static member address"); 1638 const Type *ClassType 1639 = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(Method->getParent()).getTypePtr(); 1640 FromType = S.Context.getMemberPointerType(FromType, ClassType); 1641 } else if (isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())) { 1642 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() == 1643 UO_AddrOf && 1644 "Non-address-of operator for overloaded function expression"); 1645 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType); 1646 } 1647 1648 // Check that we've computed the proper type after overload resolution. 1649 // FIXME: FixOverloadedFunctionReference has side-effects; we shouldn't 1650 // be calling it from within an NDEBUG block. 1651 assert(S.Context.hasSameType( 1652 FromType, 1653 S.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(From, AccessPair, Fn)->getType())); 1654 } else { 1655 return false; 1656 } 1657 } 1658 // Lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++11 4.1): 1659 // A glvalue (3.10) of a non-function, non-array type T can 1660 // be converted to a prvalue. 1661 bool argIsLValue = From->isGLValue(); 1662 if (argIsLValue && 1663 !FromType->isFunctionType() && !FromType->isArrayType() && 1664 S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType) != S.Context.OverloadTy) { 1665 SCS.First = ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue; 1666 1667 // C11 6.3.2.1p2: 1668 // ... if the lvalue has atomic type, the value has the non-atomic version 1669 // of the type of the lvalue ... 1670 if (const AtomicType *Atomic = FromType->getAs<AtomicType>()) 1671 FromType = Atomic->getValueType(); 1672 1673 // If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the 1674 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the rvalue 1675 // is T (C++ 4.1p1). C++ can't get here with class types; in C, we 1676 // just strip the qualifiers because they don't matter. 1677 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1678 } else if (FromType->isArrayType()) { 1679 // Array-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.2) 1680 SCS.First = ICK_Array_To_Pointer; 1681 1682 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown 1683 // bound of T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to 1684 // T" (C++ 4.2p1). 1685 FromType = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType); 1686 1687 if (S.IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(From, ToType)) { 1688 // This conversion is deprecated in C++03 (D.4) 1689 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = true; 1690 1691 // For the purpose of ranking in overload resolution 1692 // (13.3.3.1.1), this conversion is considered an 1693 // array-to-pointer conversion followed by a qualification 1694 // conversion (4.4). (C++ 4.2p2) 1695 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 1696 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification; 1697 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false; 1698 SCS.setAllToTypes(FromType); 1699 return true; 1700 } 1701 } else if (FromType->isFunctionType() && argIsLValue) { 1702 // Function-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.3). 1703 SCS.First = ICK_Function_To_Pointer; 1704 1705 if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(From->IgnoreParenCasts())) 1706 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl())) 1707 if (!S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD)) 1708 return false; 1709 1710 // An lvalue of function type T can be converted to an rvalue of 1711 // type "pointer to T." The result is a pointer to the 1712 // function. (C++ 4.3p1). 1713 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType); 1714 } else { 1715 // We don't require any conversions for the first step. 1716 SCS.First = ICK_Identity; 1717 } 1718 SCS.setToType(0, FromType); 1719 1720 // The second conversion can be an integral promotion, floating 1721 // point promotion, integral conversion, floating point conversion, 1722 // floating-integral conversion, pointer conversion, 1723 // pointer-to-member conversion, or boolean conversion (C++ 4p1). 1724 // For overloading in C, this can also be a "compatible-type" 1725 // conversion. 1726 bool IncompatibleObjC = false; 1727 ImplicitConversionKind SecondICK = ICK_Identity; 1728 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) { 1729 // The unqualified versions of the types are the same: there's no 1730 // conversion to do. 1731 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 1732 } else if (S.IsIntegralPromotion(From, FromType, ToType)) { 1733 // Integral promotion (C++ 4.5). 1734 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Promotion; 1735 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1736 } else if (S.IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromType, ToType)) { 1737 // Floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). 1738 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Promotion; 1739 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1740 } else if (S.IsComplexPromotion(FromType, ToType)) { 1741 // Complex promotion (Clang extension) 1742 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Promotion; 1743 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1744 } else if (ToType->isBooleanType() && 1745 (FromType->isArithmeticType() || 1746 FromType->isAnyPointerType() || 1747 FromType->isBlockPointerType() || 1748 FromType->isMemberPointerType() || 1749 FromType->isNullPtrType())) { 1750 // Boolean conversions (C++ 4.12). 1751 SCS.Second = ICK_Boolean_Conversion; 1752 FromType = S.Context.BoolTy; 1753 } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() && 1754 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) { 1755 // Integral conversions (C++ 4.7). 1756 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Conversion; 1757 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1758 } else if (FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isAnyComplexType()) { 1759 // Complex conversions (C99 6.3.1.6) 1760 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Conversion; 1761 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1762 } else if ((FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isArithmeticType()) || 1763 (ToType->isAnyComplexType() && FromType->isArithmeticType())) { 1764 // Complex-real conversions (C99 6.3.1.7) 1765 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Real; 1766 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1767 } else if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) { 1768 // FIXME: disable conversions between long double and __float128 if 1769 // their representation is different until there is back end support 1770 // We of course allow this conversion if long double is really double. 1771 if (&S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(FromType) != 1772 &S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType)) { 1773 bool Float128AndLongDouble = ((FromType == S.Context.Float128Ty && 1774 ToType == S.Context.LongDoubleTy) || 1775 (FromType == S.Context.LongDoubleTy && 1776 ToType == S.Context.Float128Ty)); 1777 if (Float128AndLongDouble && 1778 (&S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(S.Context.LongDoubleTy) == 1779 &llvm::APFloat::PPCDoubleDouble())) 1780 return false; 1781 } 1782 // Floating point conversions (C++ 4.8). 1783 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Conversion; 1784 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1785 } else if ((FromType->isRealFloatingType() && 1786 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) || 1787 (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() && 1788 ToType->isRealFloatingType())) { 1789 // Floating-integral conversions (C++ 4.9). 1790 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Integral; 1791 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1792 } else if (S.IsBlockPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) { 1793 SCS.Second = ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion; 1794 } else if (AllowObjCWritebackConversion && 1795 S.isObjCWritebackConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) { 1796 SCS.Second = ICK_Writeback_Conversion; 1797 } else if (S.IsPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, InOverloadResolution, 1798 FromType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 1799 // Pointer conversions (C++ 4.10). 1800 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Conversion; 1801 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = IncompatibleObjC; 1802 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1803 } else if (S.IsMemberPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, 1804 InOverloadResolution, FromType)) { 1805 // Pointer to member conversions (4.11). 1806 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Member; 1807 } else if (IsVectorConversion(S, FromType, ToType, SecondICK)) { 1808 SCS.Second = SecondICK; 1809 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1810 } else if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 1811 S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType)) { 1812 // Compatible conversions (Clang extension for C function overloading) 1813 SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion; 1814 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 1815 } else if (IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, 1816 InOverloadResolution, 1817 SCS, CStyle)) { 1818 SCS.Second = ICK_TransparentUnionConversion; 1819 FromType = ToType; 1820 } else if (tryAtomicConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution, SCS, 1821 CStyle)) { 1822 // tryAtomicConversion has updated the standard conversion sequence 1823 // appropriately. 1824 return true; 1825 } else if (ToType->isEventT() && 1826 From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext()) && 1827 From->EvaluateKnownConstInt(S.getASTContext()) == 0) { 1828 SCS.Second = ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion; 1829 FromType = ToType; 1830 } else if (ToType->isQueueT() && 1831 From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext()) && 1832 (From->EvaluateKnownConstInt(S.getASTContext()) == 0)) { 1833 SCS.Second = ICK_Zero_Queue_Conversion; 1834 FromType = ToType; 1835 } else { 1836 // No second conversion required. 1837 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 1838 } 1839 SCS.setToType(1, FromType); 1840 1841 // The third conversion can be a function pointer conversion or a 1842 // qualification conversion (C++ [conv.fctptr], [conv.qual]). 1843 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion; 1844 if (S.IsFunctionConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) { 1845 // Function pointer conversions (removing 'noexcept') including removal of 1846 // 'noreturn' (Clang extension). 1847 SCS.Third = ICK_Function_Conversion; 1848 } else if (S.IsQualificationConversion(FromType, ToType, CStyle, 1849 ObjCLifetimeConversion)) { 1850 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification; 1851 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = ObjCLifetimeConversion; 1852 FromType = ToType; 1853 } else { 1854 // No conversion required 1855 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity; 1856 } 1857 1858 // C++ [over.best.ics]p6: 1859 // [...] Any difference in top-level cv-qualification is 1860 // subsumed by the initialization itself and does not constitute 1861 // a conversion. [...] 1862 QualType CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 1863 QualType CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType); 1864 if (CanonFrom.getLocalUnqualifiedType() 1865 == CanonTo.getLocalUnqualifiedType() && 1866 CanonFrom.getLocalQualifiers() != CanonTo.getLocalQualifiers()) { 1867 FromType = ToType; 1868 CanonFrom = CanonTo; 1869 } 1870 1871 SCS.setToType(2, FromType); 1872 1873 if (CanonFrom == CanonTo) 1874 return true; 1875 1876 // If we have not converted the argument type to the parameter type, 1877 // this is a bad conversion sequence, unless we're resolving an overload in C. 1878 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !InOverloadResolution) 1879 return false; 1880 1881 ExprResult ER = ExprResult{From}; 1882 Sema::AssignConvertType Conv = 1883 S.CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(ToType, ER, 1884 /*Diagnose=*/false, 1885 /*DiagnoseCFAudited=*/false, 1886 /*ConvertRHS=*/false); 1887 ImplicitConversionKind SecondConv; 1888 switch (Conv) { 1889 case Sema::Compatible: 1890 SecondConv = ICK_C_Only_Conversion; 1891 break; 1892 // For our purposes, discarding qualifiers is just as bad as using an 1893 // incompatible pointer. Note that an IncompatiblePointer conversion can drop 1894 // qualifiers, as well. 1895 case Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers: 1896 case Sema::IncompatiblePointer: 1897 case Sema::IncompatiblePointerSign: 1898 SecondConv = ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion; 1899 break; 1900 default: 1901 return false; 1902 } 1903 1904 // First can only be an lvalue conversion, so we pretend that this was the 1905 // second conversion. First should already be valid from earlier in the 1906 // function. 1907 SCS.Second = SecondConv; 1908 SCS.setToType(1, ToType); 1909 1910 // Third is Identity, because Second should rank us worse than any other 1911 // conversion. This could also be ICK_Qualification, but it's simpler to just 1912 // lump everything in with the second conversion, and we don't gain anything 1913 // from making this ICK_Qualification. 1914 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity; 1915 SCS.setToType(2, ToType); 1916 return true; 1917 } 1918 1919 static bool 1920 IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, 1921 QualType &ToType, 1922 bool InOverloadResolution, 1923 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 1924 bool CStyle) { 1925 1926 const RecordType *UT = ToType->getAsUnionType(); 1927 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) 1928 return false; 1929 // The field to initialize within the transparent union. 1930 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl(); 1931 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields. 1932 for (const auto *it : UD->fields()) { 1933 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, it->getType(), InOverloadResolution, SCS, 1934 CStyle, /*ObjCWritebackConversion=*/false)) { 1935 ToType = it->getType(); 1936 return true; 1937 } 1938 } 1939 return false; 1940 } 1941 1942 /// IsIntegralPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from the 1943 /// expression From (whose potentially-adjusted type is FromType) to 1944 /// ToType is an integral promotion (C++ 4.5). If so, returns true and 1945 /// sets PromotedType to the promoted type. 1946 bool Sema::IsIntegralPromotion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 1947 const BuiltinType *To = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 1948 // All integers are built-in. 1949 if (!To) { 1950 return false; 1951 } 1952 1953 // An rvalue of type char, signed char, unsigned char, short int, or 1954 // unsigned short int can be converted to an rvalue of type int if 1955 // int can represent all the values of the source type; otherwise, 1956 // the source rvalue can be converted to an rvalue of type unsigned 1957 // int (C++ 4.5p1). 1958 if (FromType->isPromotableIntegerType() && !FromType->isBooleanType() && 1959 !FromType->isEnumeralType()) { 1960 if (// We can promote any signed, promotable integer type to an int 1961 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() || 1962 // We can promote any unsigned integer type whose size is 1963 // less than int to an int. 1964 Context.getTypeSize(FromType) < Context.getTypeSize(ToType))) { 1965 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int; 1966 } 1967 1968 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt; 1969 } 1970 1971 // C++11 [conv.prom]p3: 1972 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is not 1973 // fixed (7.2) can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the 1974 // following types that can represent all the values of the enumeration 1975 // (i.e., the values in the range bmin to bmax as described in 7.2): int, 1976 // unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned 1977 // long long int. If none of the types in that list can represent all the 1978 // values of the enumeration, an rvalue a prvalue of an unscoped enumeration 1979 // type can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the extended integer type 1980 // with lowest integer conversion rank (4.13) greater than the rank of long 1981 // long in which all the values of the enumeration can be represented. If 1982 // there are two such extended types, the signed one is chosen. 1983 // C++11 [conv.prom]p4: 1984 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed 1985 // can be converted to a prvalue of its underlying type. Moreover, if 1986 // integral promotion can be applied to its underlying type, a prvalue of an 1987 // unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed can also be 1988 // converted to a prvalue of the promoted underlying type. 1989 if (const EnumType *FromEnumType = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()) { 1990 // C++0x 7.2p9: Note that this implicit enum to int conversion is not 1991 // provided for a scoped enumeration. 1992 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isScoped()) 1993 return false; 1994 1995 // We can perform an integral promotion to the underlying type of the enum, 1996 // even if that's not the promoted type. Note that the check for promoting 1997 // the underlying type is based on the type alone, and does not consider 1998 // the bitfield-ness of the actual source expression. 1999 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isFixed()) { 2000 QualType Underlying = FromEnumType->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 2001 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Underlying, ToType) || 2002 IsIntegralPromotion(nullptr, Underlying, ToType); 2003 } 2004 2005 // We have already pre-calculated the promotion type, so this is trivial. 2006 if (ToType->isIntegerType() && 2007 isCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromType)) 2008 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType( 2009 ToType, FromEnumType->getDecl()->getPromotionType()); 2010 } 2011 2012 // C++0x [conv.prom]p2: 2013 // A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t (3.9.1) can be converted 2014 // to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the following types that can 2015 // represent all the values of its underlying type: int, unsigned int, 2016 // long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned long long int. 2017 // If none of the types in that list can represent all the values of its 2018 // underlying type, an rvalue a prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, 2019 // or wchar_t can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of its underlying 2020 // type. 2021 if (FromType->isAnyCharacterType() && !FromType->isCharType() && 2022 ToType->isIntegerType()) { 2023 // Determine whether the type we're converting from is signed or 2024 // unsigned. 2025 bool FromIsSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerType(); 2026 uint64_t FromSize = Context.getTypeSize(FromType); 2027 2028 // The types we'll try to promote to, in the appropriate 2029 // order. Try each of these types. 2030 QualType PromoteTypes[6] = { 2031 Context.IntTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy, 2032 Context.LongTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy , 2033 Context.LongLongTy, Context.UnsignedLongLongTy 2034 }; 2035 for (int Idx = 0; Idx < 6; ++Idx) { 2036 uint64_t ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]); 2037 if (FromSize < ToSize || 2038 (FromSize == ToSize && 2039 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType())) { 2040 // We found the type that we can promote to. If this is the 2041 // type we wanted, we have a promotion. Otherwise, no 2042 // promotion. 2043 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, PromoteTypes[Idx]); 2044 } 2045 } 2046 } 2047 2048 // An rvalue for an integral bit-field (9.6) can be converted to an 2049 // rvalue of type int if int can represent all the values of the 2050 // bit-field; otherwise, it can be converted to unsigned int if 2051 // unsigned int can represent all the values of the bit-field. If 2052 // the bit-field is larger yet, no integral promotion applies to 2053 // it. If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any 2054 // other value of that type for promotion purposes (C++ 4.5p3). 2055 // FIXME: We should delay checking of bit-fields until we actually perform the 2056 // conversion. 2057 if (From) { 2058 if (FieldDecl *MemberDecl = From->getSourceBitField()) { 2059 llvm::APSInt BitWidth; 2060 if (FromType->isIntegralType(Context) && 2061 MemberDecl->getBitWidth()->isIntegerConstantExpr(BitWidth, Context)) { 2062 llvm::APSInt ToSize(BitWidth.getBitWidth(), BitWidth.isUnsigned()); 2063 ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(ToType); 2064 2065 // Are we promoting to an int from a bitfield that fits in an int? 2066 if (BitWidth < ToSize || 2067 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize)) { 2068 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int; 2069 } 2070 2071 // Are we promoting to an unsigned int from an unsigned bitfield 2072 // that fits into an unsigned int? 2073 if (FromType->isUnsignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize) { 2074 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt; 2075 } 2076 2077 return false; 2078 } 2079 } 2080 } 2081 2082 // An rvalue of type bool can be converted to an rvalue of type int, 2083 // with false becoming zero and true becoming one (C++ 4.5p4). 2084 if (FromType->isBooleanType() && To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int) { 2085 return true; 2086 } 2087 2088 return false; 2089 } 2090 2091 /// IsFloatingPointPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from 2092 /// FromType to ToType is a floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). If so, 2093 /// returns true and sets PromotedType to the promoted type. 2094 bool Sema::IsFloatingPointPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 2095 if (const BuiltinType *FromBuiltin = FromType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) 2096 if (const BuiltinType *ToBuiltin = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) { 2097 /// An rvalue of type float can be converted to an rvalue of type 2098 /// double. (C++ 4.6p1). 2099 if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float && 2100 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) 2101 return true; 2102 2103 // C99 6.3.1.5p1: 2104 // When a float is promoted to double or long double, or a 2105 // double is promoted to long double [...]. 2106 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 2107 (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float || 2108 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) && 2109 (ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble || 2110 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float128)) 2111 return true; 2112 2113 // Half can be promoted to float. 2114 if (!getLangOpts().NativeHalfType && 2115 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half && 2116 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float) 2117 return true; 2118 } 2119 2120 return false; 2121 } 2122 2123 /// Determine if a conversion is a complex promotion. 2124 /// 2125 /// A complex promotion is defined as a complex -> complex conversion 2126 /// where the conversion between the underlying real types is a 2127 /// floating-point or integral promotion. 2128 bool Sema::IsComplexPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 2129 const ComplexType *FromComplex = FromType->getAs<ComplexType>(); 2130 if (!FromComplex) 2131 return false; 2132 2133 const ComplexType *ToComplex = ToType->getAs<ComplexType>(); 2134 if (!ToComplex) 2135 return false; 2136 2137 return IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromComplex->getElementType(), 2138 ToComplex->getElementType()) || 2139 IsIntegralPromotion(nullptr, FromComplex->getElementType(), 2140 ToComplex->getElementType()); 2141 } 2142 2143 /// BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType - In a pointer conversion from 2144 /// the pointer type FromPtr to a pointer to type ToPointee, with the 2145 /// same type qualifiers as FromPtr has on its pointee type. ToType, 2146 /// if non-empty, will be a pointer to ToType that may or may not have 2147 /// the right set of qualifiers on its pointee. 2148 /// 2149 static QualType 2150 BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(const Type *FromPtr, 2151 QualType ToPointee, QualType ToType, 2152 ASTContext &Context, 2153 bool StripObjCLifetime = false) { 2154 assert((FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::Pointer || 2155 FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::ObjCObjectPointer) && 2156 "Invalid similarly-qualified pointer type"); 2157 2158 /// Conversions to 'id' subsume cv-qualifier conversions. 2159 if (ToType->isObjCIdType() || ToType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) 2160 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 2161 2162 QualType CanonFromPointee 2163 = Context.getCanonicalType(FromPtr->getPointeeType()); 2164 QualType CanonToPointee = Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointee); 2165 Qualifiers Quals = CanonFromPointee.getQualifiers(); 2166 2167 if (StripObjCLifetime) 2168 Quals.removeObjCLifetime(); 2169 2170 // Exact qualifier match -> return the pointer type we're converting to. 2171 if (CanonToPointee.getLocalQualifiers() == Quals) { 2172 // ToType is exactly what we need. Return it. 2173 if (!ToType.isNull()) 2174 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 2175 2176 // Build a pointer to ToPointee. It has the right qualifiers 2177 // already. 2178 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType)) 2179 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(ToPointee); 2180 return Context.getPointerType(ToPointee); 2181 } 2182 2183 // Just build a canonical type that has the right qualifiers. 2184 QualType QualifiedCanonToPointee 2185 = Context.getQualifiedType(CanonToPointee.getLocalUnqualifiedType(), Quals); 2186 2187 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType)) 2188 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee); 2189 return Context.getPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee); 2190 } 2191 2192 static bool isNullPointerConstantForConversion(Expr *Expr, 2193 bool InOverloadResolution, 2194 ASTContext &Context) { 2195 // Handle value-dependent integral null pointer constants correctly. 2196 // http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#903 2197 if (Expr->isValueDependent() && !Expr->isTypeDependent() && 2198 Expr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !Expr->getType()->isEnumeralType()) 2199 return !InOverloadResolution; 2200 2201 return Expr->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 2202 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull 2203 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull); 2204 } 2205 2206 /// IsPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the 2207 /// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, 2208 /// can be converted to the type ToType via a pointer conversion (C++ 2209 /// 4.10). If so, returns true and places the converted type (that 2210 /// might differ from ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into 2211 /// ConvertedType. 2212 /// 2213 /// This routine also supports conversions to and from block pointers 2214 /// and conversions with Objective-C's 'id', 'id<protocols...>', and 2215 /// pointers to interfaces. FIXME: Once we've determined the 2216 /// appropriate overloading rules for Objective-C, we may want to 2217 /// split the Objective-C checks into a different routine; however, 2218 /// GCC seems to consider all of these conversions to be pointer 2219 /// conversions, so for now they live here. IncompatibleObjC will be 2220 /// set if the conversion is an allowed Objective-C conversion that 2221 /// should result in a warning. 2222 bool Sema::IsPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 2223 bool InOverloadResolution, 2224 QualType& ConvertedType, 2225 bool &IncompatibleObjC) { 2226 IncompatibleObjC = false; 2227 if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, ConvertedType, 2228 IncompatibleObjC)) 2229 return true; 2230 2231 // Conversion from a null pointer constant to any Objective-C pointer type. 2232 if (ToType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 2233 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 2234 ConvertedType = ToType; 2235 return true; 2236 } 2237 2238 // Blocks: Block pointers can be converted to void*. 2239 if (FromType->isBlockPointerType() && ToType->isPointerType() && 2240 ToType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) { 2241 ConvertedType = ToType; 2242 return true; 2243 } 2244 // Blocks: A null pointer constant can be converted to a block 2245 // pointer type. 2246 if (ToType->isBlockPointerType() && 2247 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 2248 ConvertedType = ToType; 2249 return true; 2250 } 2251 2252 // If the left-hand-side is nullptr_t, the right side can be a null 2253 // pointer constant. 2254 if (ToType->isNullPtrType() && 2255 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 2256 ConvertedType = ToType; 2257 return true; 2258 } 2259 2260 const PointerType* ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>(); 2261 if (!ToTypePtr) 2262 return false; 2263 2264 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a pointer type (C++ 4.10p1). 2265 if (isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) { 2266 ConvertedType = ToType; 2267 return true; 2268 } 2269 2270 // Beyond this point, both types need to be pointers 2271 // , including objective-c pointers. 2272 QualType ToPointeeType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 2273 if (FromType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType() && 2274 !getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) { 2275 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType( 2276 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(), 2277 ToPointeeType, 2278 ToType, Context); 2279 return true; 2280 } 2281 const PointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>(); 2282 if (!FromTypePtr) 2283 return false; 2284 2285 QualType FromPointeeType = FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 2286 2287 // If the unqualified pointee types are the same, this can't be a 2288 // pointer conversion, so don't do all of the work below. 2289 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) 2290 return false; 2291 2292 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv T," where T is an object type, 2293 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv void" (C++ 2294 // 4.10p2). 2295 if (FromPointeeType->isIncompleteOrObjectType() && 2296 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) { 2297 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 2298 ToPointeeType, 2299 ToType, Context, 2300 /*StripObjCLifetime=*/true); 2301 return true; 2302 } 2303 2304 // MSVC allows implicit function to void* type conversion. 2305 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() && 2306 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) { 2307 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 2308 ToPointeeType, 2309 ToType, Context); 2310 return true; 2311 } 2312 2313 // When we're overloading in C, we allow a special kind of pointer 2314 // conversion for compatible-but-not-identical pointee types. 2315 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 2316 Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 2317 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 2318 ToPointeeType, 2319 ToType, Context); 2320 return true; 2321 } 2322 2323 // C++ [conv.ptr]p3: 2324 // 2325 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv D," where D is a class type, 2326 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv B," where 2327 // B is a base class (clause 10) of D. If B is an inaccessible 2328 // (clause 11) or ambiguous (10.2) base class of D, a program that 2329 // necessitates this conversion is ill-formed. The result of the 2330 // conversion is a pointer to the base class sub-object of the 2331 // derived class object. The null pointer value is converted to 2332 // the null pointer value of the destination type. 2333 // 2334 // Note that we do not check for ambiguity or inaccessibility 2335 // here. That is handled by CheckPointerConversion. 2336 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 2337 FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() && 2338 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType) && 2339 IsDerivedFrom(From->getLocStart(), FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 2340 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 2341 ToPointeeType, 2342 ToType, Context); 2343 return true; 2344 } 2345 2346 if (FromPointeeType->isVectorType() && ToPointeeType->isVectorType() && 2347 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 2348 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr, 2349 ToPointeeType, 2350 ToType, Context); 2351 return true; 2352 } 2353 2354 return false; 2355 } 2356 2357 /// Adopt the given qualifiers for the given type. 2358 static QualType AdoptQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, Qualifiers Qs){ 2359 Qualifiers TQs = T.getQualifiers(); 2360 2361 // Check whether qualifiers already match. 2362 if (TQs == Qs) 2363 return T; 2364 2365 if (Qs.compatiblyIncludes(TQs)) 2366 return Context.getQualifiedType(T, Qs); 2367 2368 return Context.getQualifiedType(T.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs); 2369 } 2370 2371 /// isObjCPointerConversion - Determines whether this is an 2372 /// Objective-C pointer conversion. Subroutine of IsPointerConversion, 2373 /// with the same arguments and return values. 2374 bool Sema::isObjCPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 2375 QualType& ConvertedType, 2376 bool &IncompatibleObjC) { 2377 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1) 2378 return false; 2379 2380 // The set of qualifiers on the type we're converting from. 2381 Qualifiers FromQualifiers = FromType.getQualifiers(); 2382 2383 // First, we handle all conversions on ObjC object pointer types. 2384 const ObjCObjectPointerType* ToObjCPtr = 2385 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 2386 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromObjCPtr = 2387 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 2388 2389 if (ToObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr) { 2390 // If the pointee types are the same (ignoring qualifications), 2391 // then this is not a pointer conversion. 2392 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(), 2393 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType())) 2394 return false; 2395 2396 // Conversion between Objective-C pointers. 2397 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToObjCPtr, FromObjCPtr)) { 2398 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = ToObjCPtr->getInterfaceType(); 2399 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = FromObjCPtr->getInterfaceType(); 2400 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHS && RHS && 2401 !ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs( 2402 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType())) 2403 return false; 2404 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr, 2405 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(), 2406 ToType, Context); 2407 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers); 2408 return true; 2409 } 2410 2411 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr, ToObjCPtr)) { 2412 // Okay: this is some kind of implicit downcast of Objective-C 2413 // interfaces, which is permitted. However, we're going to 2414 // complain about it. 2415 IncompatibleObjC = true; 2416 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr, 2417 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(), 2418 ToType, Context); 2419 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers); 2420 return true; 2421 } 2422 } 2423 // Beyond this point, both types need to be C pointers or block pointers. 2424 QualType ToPointeeType; 2425 if (const PointerType *ToCPtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) 2426 ToPointeeType = ToCPtr->getPointeeType(); 2427 else if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr = 2428 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) { 2429 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to any object 2430 // to a block pointer type. 2431 if (FromObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) { 2432 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers); 2433 return true; 2434 } 2435 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType(); 2436 } 2437 else if (FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() && 2438 ToObjCPtr && ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) { 2439 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a block pointer type to a 2440 // pointer to any object. 2441 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers); 2442 return true; 2443 } 2444 else 2445 return false; 2446 2447 QualType FromPointeeType; 2448 if (const PointerType *FromCPtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) 2449 FromPointeeType = FromCPtr->getPointeeType(); 2450 else if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr = 2451 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) 2452 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType(); 2453 else 2454 return false; 2455 2456 // If we have pointers to pointers, recursively check whether this 2457 // is an Objective-C conversion. 2458 if (FromPointeeType->isPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isPointerType() && 2459 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType, 2460 IncompatibleObjC)) { 2461 // We always complain about this conversion. 2462 IncompatibleObjC = true; 2463 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType); 2464 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers); 2465 return true; 2466 } 2467 // Allow conversion of pointee being objective-c pointer to another one; 2468 // as in I* to id. 2469 if (FromPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() && 2470 ToPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() && 2471 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType, 2472 IncompatibleObjC)) { 2473 2474 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType); 2475 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers); 2476 return true; 2477 } 2478 2479 // If we have pointers to functions or blocks, check whether the only 2480 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C 2481 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion (but 2482 // complain about it). 2483 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType 2484 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2485 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType 2486 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2487 if (FromFunctionType && ToFunctionType) { 2488 // If the function types are exactly the same, this isn't an 2489 // Objective-C pointer conversion. 2490 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromPointeeType) 2491 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointeeType)) 2492 return false; 2493 2494 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these 2495 // function types are obviously different. 2496 if (FromFunctionType->getNumParams() != ToFunctionType->getNumParams() || 2497 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic() || 2498 FromFunctionType->getTypeQuals() != ToFunctionType->getTypeQuals()) 2499 return false; 2500 2501 bool HasObjCConversion = false; 2502 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromFunctionType->getReturnType()) == 2503 Context.getCanonicalType(ToFunctionType->getReturnType())) { 2504 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do. 2505 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromFunctionType->getReturnType(), 2506 ToFunctionType->getReturnType(), 2507 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 2508 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion. 2509 HasObjCConversion = true; 2510 } else { 2511 // Function types are too different. Abort. 2512 return false; 2513 } 2514 2515 // Check argument types. 2516 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumParams(); 2517 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 2518 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx); 2519 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx); 2520 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromArgType) 2521 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToArgType)) { 2522 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do. 2523 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromArgType, ToArgType, 2524 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 2525 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion. 2526 HasObjCConversion = true; 2527 } else { 2528 // Argument types are too different. Abort. 2529 return false; 2530 } 2531 } 2532 2533 if (HasObjCConversion) { 2534 // We had an Objective-C conversion. Allow this pointer 2535 // conversion, but complain about it. 2536 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers); 2537 IncompatibleObjC = true; 2538 return true; 2539 } 2540 } 2541 2542 return false; 2543 } 2544 2545 /// Determine whether this is an Objective-C writeback conversion, 2546 /// used for parameter passing when performing automatic reference counting. 2547 /// 2548 /// \param FromType The type we're converting form. 2549 /// 2550 /// \param ToType The type we're converting to. 2551 /// 2552 /// \param ConvertedType The type that will be produced after applying 2553 /// this conversion. 2554 bool Sema::isObjCWritebackConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 2555 QualType &ConvertedType) { 2556 if (!getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount || 2557 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) 2558 return false; 2559 2560 // Parameter must be a pointer to __autoreleasing (with no other qualifiers). 2561 QualType ToPointee; 2562 if (const PointerType *ToPointer = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) 2563 ToPointee = ToPointer->getPointeeType(); 2564 else 2565 return false; 2566 2567 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToPointee.getQualifiers(); 2568 if (!ToPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() || 2569 ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing || 2570 !ToQuals.withoutObjCLifetime().empty()) 2571 return false; 2572 2573 // Argument must be a pointer to __strong to __weak. 2574 QualType FromPointee; 2575 if (const PointerType *FromPointer = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) 2576 FromPointee = FromPointer->getPointeeType(); 2577 else 2578 return false; 2579 2580 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromPointee.getQualifiers(); 2581 if (!FromPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() || 2582 (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Strong && 2583 FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Weak)) 2584 return false; 2585 2586 // Make sure that we have compatible qualifiers. 2587 FromQuals.setObjCLifetime(Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing); 2588 if (!ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals)) 2589 return false; 2590 2591 // Remove qualifiers from the pointee type we're converting from; they 2592 // aren't used in the compatibility check belong, and we'll be adding back 2593 // qualifiers (with __autoreleasing) if the compatibility check succeeds. 2594 FromPointee = FromPointee.getUnqualifiedType(); 2595 2596 // The unqualified form of the pointee types must be compatible. 2597 ToPointee = ToPointee.getUnqualifiedType(); 2598 bool IncompatibleObjC; 2599 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointee, ToPointee)) 2600 FromPointee = ToPointee; 2601 else if (!isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointee, ToPointee, FromPointee, 2602 IncompatibleObjC)) 2603 return false; 2604 2605 /// Construct the type we're converting to, which is a pointer to 2606 /// __autoreleasing pointee. 2607 FromPointee = Context.getQualifiedType(FromPointee, FromQuals); 2608 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(FromPointee); 2609 return true; 2610 } 2611 2612 bool Sema::IsBlockPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 2613 QualType& ConvertedType) { 2614 QualType ToPointeeType; 2615 if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr = 2616 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) 2617 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType(); 2618 else 2619 return false; 2620 2621 QualType FromPointeeType; 2622 if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr = 2623 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) 2624 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType(); 2625 else 2626 return false; 2627 // We have pointer to blocks, check whether the only 2628 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C 2629 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion. 2630 2631 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType 2632 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2633 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType 2634 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2635 2636 if (!FromFunctionType || !ToFunctionType) 2637 return false; 2638 2639 if (Context.hasSameType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) 2640 return true; 2641 2642 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these 2643 // function types are obviously different. 2644 if (FromFunctionType->getNumParams() != ToFunctionType->getNumParams() || 2645 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic()) 2646 return false; 2647 2648 FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFunctionType->getExtInfo(); 2649 FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFunctionType->getExtInfo(); 2650 if (FromEInfo != ToEInfo) 2651 return false; 2652 2653 bool IncompatibleObjC = false; 2654 if (Context.hasSameType(FromFunctionType->getReturnType(), 2655 ToFunctionType->getReturnType())) { 2656 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do. 2657 } else { 2658 QualType RHS = FromFunctionType->getReturnType(); 2659 QualType LHS = ToFunctionType->getReturnType(); 2660 if ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !RHS->isRecordType()) && 2661 !RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers()) 2662 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType(); 2663 2664 if (Context.hasSameType(RHS,LHS)) { 2665 // OK exact match. 2666 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(RHS, LHS, 2667 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 2668 if (IncompatibleObjC) 2669 return false; 2670 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion. 2671 } 2672 else 2673 return false; 2674 } 2675 2676 // Check argument types. 2677 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumParams(); 2678 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 2679 IncompatibleObjC = false; 2680 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx); 2681 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx); 2682 if (Context.hasSameType(FromArgType, ToArgType)) { 2683 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do. 2684 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(ToArgType, FromArgType, 2685 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) { 2686 if (IncompatibleObjC) 2687 return false; 2688 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion. 2689 } else 2690 // Argument types are too different. Abort. 2691 return false; 2692 } 2693 2694 SmallVector<FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo, 4> NewParamInfos; 2695 bool CanUseToFPT, CanUseFromFPT; 2696 if (!Context.mergeExtParameterInfo(ToFunctionType, FromFunctionType, 2697 CanUseToFPT, CanUseFromFPT, 2698 NewParamInfos)) 2699 return false; 2700 2701 ConvertedType = ToType; 2702 return true; 2703 } 2704 2705 enum { 2706 ft_default, 2707 ft_different_class, 2708 ft_parameter_arity, 2709 ft_parameter_mismatch, 2710 ft_return_type, 2711 ft_qualifer_mismatch, 2712 ft_noexcept 2713 }; 2714 2715 /// Attempts to get the FunctionProtoType from a Type. Handles 2716 /// MemberFunctionPointers properly. 2717 static const FunctionProtoType *tryGetFunctionProtoType(QualType FromType) { 2718 if (auto *FPT = FromType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 2719 return FPT; 2720 2721 if (auto *MPT = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 2722 return MPT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 2723 2724 return nullptr; 2725 } 2726 2727 /// HandleFunctionTypeMismatch - Gives diagnostic information for differeing 2728 /// function types. Catches different number of parameter, mismatch in 2729 /// parameter types, and different return types. 2730 void Sema::HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PartialDiagnostic &PDiag, 2731 QualType FromType, QualType ToType) { 2732 // If either type is not valid, include no extra info. 2733 if (FromType.isNull() || ToType.isNull()) { 2734 PDiag << ft_default; 2735 return; 2736 } 2737 2738 // Get the function type from the pointers. 2739 if (FromType->isMemberPointerType() && ToType->isMemberPointerType()) { 2740 const MemberPointerType *FromMember = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(), 2741 *ToMember = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 2742 if (!Context.hasSameType(FromMember->getClass(), ToMember->getClass())) { 2743 PDiag << ft_different_class << QualType(ToMember->getClass(), 0) 2744 << QualType(FromMember->getClass(), 0); 2745 return; 2746 } 2747 FromType = FromMember->getPointeeType(); 2748 ToType = ToMember->getPointeeType(); 2749 } 2750 2751 if (FromType->isPointerType()) 2752 FromType = FromType->getPointeeType(); 2753 if (ToType->isPointerType()) 2754 ToType = ToType->getPointeeType(); 2755 2756 // Remove references. 2757 FromType = FromType.getNonReferenceType(); 2758 ToType = ToType.getNonReferenceType(); 2759 2760 // Don't print extra info for non-specialized template functions. 2761 if (FromType->isInstantiationDependentType() && 2762 !FromType->getAs<TemplateSpecializationType>()) { 2763 PDiag << ft_default; 2764 return; 2765 } 2766 2767 // No extra info for same types. 2768 if (Context.hasSameType(FromType, ToType)) { 2769 PDiag << ft_default; 2770 return; 2771 } 2772 2773 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunction = tryGetFunctionProtoType(FromType), 2774 *ToFunction = tryGetFunctionProtoType(ToType); 2775 2776 // Both types need to be function types. 2777 if (!FromFunction || !ToFunction) { 2778 PDiag << ft_default; 2779 return; 2780 } 2781 2782 if (FromFunction->getNumParams() != ToFunction->getNumParams()) { 2783 PDiag << ft_parameter_arity << ToFunction->getNumParams() 2784 << FromFunction->getNumParams(); 2785 return; 2786 } 2787 2788 // Handle different parameter types. 2789 unsigned ArgPos; 2790 if (!FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(FromFunction, ToFunction, &ArgPos)) { 2791 PDiag << ft_parameter_mismatch << ArgPos + 1 2792 << ToFunction->getParamType(ArgPos) 2793 << FromFunction->getParamType(ArgPos); 2794 return; 2795 } 2796 2797 // Handle different return type. 2798 if (!Context.hasSameType(FromFunction->getReturnType(), 2799 ToFunction->getReturnType())) { 2800 PDiag << ft_return_type << ToFunction->getReturnType() 2801 << FromFunction->getReturnType(); 2802 return; 2803 } 2804 2805 unsigned FromQuals = FromFunction->getTypeQuals(), 2806 ToQuals = ToFunction->getTypeQuals(); 2807 if (FromQuals != ToQuals) { 2808 PDiag << ft_qualifer_mismatch << ToQuals << FromQuals; 2809 return; 2810 } 2811 2812 // Handle exception specification differences on canonical type (in C++17 2813 // onwards). 2814 if (cast<FunctionProtoType>(FromFunction->getCanonicalTypeUnqualified()) 2815 ->isNothrow() != 2816 cast<FunctionProtoType>(ToFunction->getCanonicalTypeUnqualified()) 2817 ->isNothrow()) { 2818 PDiag << ft_noexcept; 2819 return; 2820 } 2821 2822 // Unable to find a difference, so add no extra info. 2823 PDiag << ft_default; 2824 } 2825 2826 /// FunctionParamTypesAreEqual - This routine checks two function proto types 2827 /// for equality of their argument types. Caller has already checked that 2828 /// they have same number of arguments. If the parameters are different, 2829 /// ArgPos will have the parameter index of the first different parameter. 2830 bool Sema::FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(const FunctionProtoType *OldType, 2831 const FunctionProtoType *NewType, 2832 unsigned *ArgPos) { 2833 for (FunctionProtoType::param_type_iterator O = OldType->param_type_begin(), 2834 N = NewType->param_type_begin(), 2835 E = OldType->param_type_end(); 2836 O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) { 2837 if (!Context.hasSameType(O->getUnqualifiedType(), 2838 N->getUnqualifiedType())) { 2839 if (ArgPos) 2840 *ArgPos = O - OldType->param_type_begin(); 2841 return false; 2842 } 2843 } 2844 return true; 2845 } 2846 2847 /// CheckPointerConversion - Check the pointer conversion from the 2848 /// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for 2849 /// ambiguous or inaccessible derived-to-base pointer 2850 /// conversions for which IsPointerConversion has already returned 2851 /// true. It returns true and produces a diagnostic if there was an 2852 /// error, or returns false otherwise. 2853 bool Sema::CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 2854 CastKind &Kind, 2855 CXXCastPath& BasePath, 2856 bool IgnoreBaseAccess, 2857 bool Diagnose) { 2858 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 2859 bool IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast = IgnoreBaseAccess; 2860 2861 Kind = CK_BitCast; 2862 2863 if (Diagnose && !IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast && !FromType->isAnyPointerType() && 2864 From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) == 2865 Expr::NPCK_ZeroExpression) { 2866 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(From->getType(), Context.BoolTy)) 2867 DiagRuntimeBehavior(From->getExprLoc(), From, 2868 PDiag(diag::warn_impcast_bool_to_null_pointer) 2869 << ToType << From->getSourceRange()); 2870 else if (!isUnevaluatedContext()) 2871 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_non_literal_null_pointer) 2872 << ToType << From->getSourceRange(); 2873 } 2874 if (const PointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 2875 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 2876 QualType FromPointeeType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(), 2877 ToPointeeType = ToPtrType->getPointeeType(); 2878 2879 if (FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() && 2880 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) { 2881 // We must have a derived-to-base conversion. Check an 2882 // ambiguous or inaccessible conversion. 2883 unsigned InaccessibleID = 0; 2884 unsigned AmbigiousID = 0; 2885 if (Diagnose) { 2886 InaccessibleID = diag::err_upcast_to_inaccessible_base; 2887 AmbigiousID = diag::err_ambiguous_derived_to_base_conv; 2888 } 2889 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion( 2890 FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, InaccessibleID, AmbigiousID, 2891 From->getExprLoc(), From->getSourceRange(), DeclarationName(), 2892 &BasePath, IgnoreBaseAccess)) 2893 return true; 2894 2895 // The conversion was successful. 2896 Kind = CK_DerivedToBase; 2897 } 2898 2899 if (Diagnose && !IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast && 2900 FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) { 2901 assert(getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && 2902 "this should only be possible with MSVCCompat!"); 2903 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_ms_impcast_fn_obj) 2904 << From->getSourceRange(); 2905 } 2906 } 2907 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrType = 2908 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 2909 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrType = 2910 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 2911 // Objective-C++ conversions are always okay. 2912 // FIXME: We should have a different class of conversions for the 2913 // Objective-C++ implicit conversions. 2914 if (FromPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType() || ToPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType()) 2915 return false; 2916 } else if (FromType->isBlockPointerType()) { 2917 Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast; 2918 } else { 2919 Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast; 2920 } 2921 } else if (ToType->isBlockPointerType()) { 2922 if (!FromType->isBlockPointerType()) 2923 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast; 2924 } 2925 2926 // We shouldn't fall into this case unless it's valid for other 2927 // reasons. 2928 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) 2929 Kind = CK_NullToPointer; 2930 2931 return false; 2932 } 2933 2934 /// IsMemberPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the 2935 /// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, can be 2936 /// converted to the type ToType via a member pointer conversion (C++ 4.11). 2937 /// If so, returns true and places the converted type (that might differ from 2938 /// ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into ConvertedType. 2939 bool Sema::IsMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, 2940 QualType ToType, 2941 bool InOverloadResolution, 2942 QualType &ConvertedType) { 2943 const MemberPointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 2944 if (!ToTypePtr) 2945 return false; 2946 2947 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a member pointer (C++ 4.11p1) 2948 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 2949 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull 2950 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) { 2951 ConvertedType = ToType; 2952 return true; 2953 } 2954 2955 // Otherwise, both types have to be member pointers. 2956 const MemberPointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 2957 if (!FromTypePtr) 2958 return false; 2959 2960 // A pointer to member of B can be converted to a pointer to member of D, 2961 // where D is derived from B (C++ 4.11p2). 2962 QualType FromClass(FromTypePtr->getClass(), 0); 2963 QualType ToClass(ToTypePtr->getClass(), 0); 2964 2965 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromClass, ToClass) && 2966 IsDerivedFrom(From->getLocStart(), ToClass, FromClass)) { 2967 ConvertedType = Context.getMemberPointerType(FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(), 2968 ToClass.getTypePtr()); 2969 return true; 2970 } 2971 2972 return false; 2973 } 2974 2975 /// CheckMemberPointerConversion - Check the member pointer conversion from the 2976 /// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for ambiguous or 2977 /// virtual or inaccessible base-to-derived member pointer conversions 2978 /// for which IsMemberPointerConversion has already returned true. It returns 2979 /// true and produces a diagnostic if there was an error, or returns false 2980 /// otherwise. 2981 bool Sema::CheckMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType, 2982 CastKind &Kind, 2983 CXXCastPath &BasePath, 2984 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) { 2985 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 2986 const MemberPointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 2987 if (!FromPtrType) { 2988 // This must be a null pointer to member pointer conversion 2989 assert(From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 2990 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull) && 2991 "Expr must be null pointer constant!"); 2992 Kind = CK_NullToMemberPointer; 2993 return false; 2994 } 2995 2996 const MemberPointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 2997 assert(ToPtrType && "No member pointer cast has a target type " 2998 "that is not a member pointer."); 2999 3000 QualType FromClass = QualType(FromPtrType->getClass(), 0); 3001 QualType ToClass = QualType(ToPtrType->getClass(), 0); 3002 3003 // FIXME: What about dependent types? 3004 assert(FromClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class."); 3005 assert(ToClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class."); 3006 3007 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true, 3008 /*DetectVirtual=*/true); 3009 bool DerivationOkay = 3010 IsDerivedFrom(From->getLocStart(), ToClass, FromClass, Paths); 3011 assert(DerivationOkay && 3012 "Should not have been called if derivation isn't OK."); 3013 (void)DerivationOkay; 3014 3015 if (Paths.isAmbiguous(Context.getCanonicalType(FromClass). 3016 getUnqualifiedType())) { 3017 std::string PathDisplayStr = getAmbiguousPathsDisplayString(Paths); 3018 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_ambiguous_memptr_conv) 3019 << 0 << FromClass << ToClass << PathDisplayStr << From->getSourceRange(); 3020 return true; 3021 } 3022 3023 if (const RecordType *VBase = Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) { 3024 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_memptr_conv_via_virtual) 3025 << FromClass << ToClass << QualType(VBase, 0) 3026 << From->getSourceRange(); 3027 return true; 3028 } 3029 3030 if (!IgnoreBaseAccess) 3031 CheckBaseClassAccess(From->getExprLoc(), FromClass, ToClass, 3032 Paths.front(), 3033 diag::err_downcast_from_inaccessible_base); 3034 3035 // Must be a base to derived member conversion. 3036 BuildBasePathArray(Paths, BasePath); 3037 Kind = CK_BaseToDerivedMemberPointer; 3038 return false; 3039 } 3040 3041 /// Determine whether the lifetime conversion between the two given 3042 /// qualifiers sets is nontrivial. 3043 static bool isNonTrivialObjCLifetimeConversion(Qualifiers FromQuals, 3044 Qualifiers ToQuals) { 3045 // Converting anything to const __unsafe_unretained is trivial. 3046 if (ToQuals.hasConst() && 3047 ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone) 3048 return false; 3049 3050 return true; 3051 } 3052 3053 /// IsQualificationConversion - Determines whether the conversion from 3054 /// an rvalue of type FromType to ToType is a qualification conversion 3055 /// (C++ 4.4). 3056 /// 3057 /// \param ObjCLifetimeConversion Output parameter that will be set to indicate 3058 /// when the qualification conversion involves a change in the Objective-C 3059 /// object lifetime. 3060 bool 3061 Sema::IsQualificationConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType, 3062 bool CStyle, bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) { 3063 FromType = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 3064 ToType = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType); 3065 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false; 3066 3067 // If FromType and ToType are the same type, this is not a 3068 // qualification conversion. 3069 if (FromType.getUnqualifiedType() == ToType.getUnqualifiedType()) 3070 return false; 3071 3072 // (C++ 4.4p4): 3073 // A conversion can add cv-qualifiers at levels other than the first 3074 // in multi-level pointers, subject to the following rules: [...] 3075 bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true; 3076 bool UnwrappedAnyPointer = false; 3077 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(FromType, ToType)) { 3078 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to 3079 // determine if this still looks like a qualification 3080 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of 3081 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again 3082 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left to 3083 // unwrap. 3084 UnwrappedAnyPointer = true; 3085 3086 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromType.getQualifiers(); 3087 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToType.getQualifiers(); 3088 3089 // Ignore __unaligned qualifier if this type is void. 3090 if (ToType.getUnqualifiedType()->isVoidType()) 3091 FromQuals.removeUnaligned(); 3092 3093 // Objective-C ARC: 3094 // Check Objective-C lifetime conversions. 3095 if (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() && 3096 UnwrappedAnyPointer) { 3097 if (ToQuals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(FromQuals)) { 3098 if (isNonTrivialObjCLifetimeConversion(FromQuals, ToQuals)) 3099 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true; 3100 FromQuals.removeObjCLifetime(); 3101 ToQuals.removeObjCLifetime(); 3102 } else { 3103 // Qualification conversions cannot cast between different 3104 // Objective-C lifetime qualifiers. 3105 return false; 3106 } 3107 } 3108 3109 // Allow addition/removal of GC attributes but not changing GC attributes. 3110 if (FromQuals.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQuals.getObjCGCAttr() && 3111 (!FromQuals.hasObjCGCAttr() || !ToQuals.hasObjCGCAttr())) { 3112 FromQuals.removeObjCGCAttr(); 3113 ToQuals.removeObjCGCAttr(); 3114 } 3115 3116 // -- for every j > 0, if const is in cv 1,j then const is in cv 3117 // 2,j, and similarly for volatile. 3118 if (!CStyle && !ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals)) 3119 return false; 3120 3121 // -- if the cv 1,j and cv 2,j are different, then const is in 3122 // every cv for 0 < k < j. 3123 if (!CStyle && FromQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != ToQuals.getCVRQualifiers() 3124 && !PreviousToQualsIncludeConst) 3125 return false; 3126 3127 // Keep track of whether all prior cv-qualifiers in the "to" type 3128 // include const. 3129 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst 3130 = PreviousToQualsIncludeConst && ToQuals.hasConst(); 3131 } 3132 3133 // We are left with FromType and ToType being the pointee types 3134 // after unwrapping the original FromType and ToType the same number 3135 // of types. If we unwrapped any pointers, and if FromType and 3136 // ToType have the same unqualified type (since we checked 3137 // qualifiers above), then this is a qualification conversion. 3138 return UnwrappedAnyPointer && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType,ToType); 3139 } 3140 3141 /// - Determine whether this is a conversion from a scalar type to an 3142 /// atomic type. 3143 /// 3144 /// If successful, updates \c SCS's second and third steps in the conversion 3145 /// sequence to finish the conversion. 3146 static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 3147 bool InOverloadResolution, 3148 StandardConversionSequence &SCS, 3149 bool CStyle) { 3150 const AtomicType *ToAtomic = ToType->getAs<AtomicType>(); 3151 if (!ToAtomic) 3152 return false; 3153 3154 StandardConversionSequence InnerSCS; 3155 if (!IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToAtomic->getValueType(), 3156 InOverloadResolution, InnerSCS, 3157 CStyle, /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false)) 3158 return false; 3159 3160 SCS.Second = InnerSCS.Second; 3161 SCS.setToType(1, InnerSCS.getToType(1)); 3162 SCS.Third = InnerSCS.Third; 3163 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime 3164 = InnerSCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime; 3165 SCS.setToType(2, InnerSCS.getToType(2)); 3166 return true; 3167 } 3168 3169 static bool isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(ASTContext &Context, 3170 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor, 3171 QualType Type) { 3172 const FunctionProtoType *CtorType = 3173 Constructor->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 3174 if (CtorType->getNumParams() > 0) { 3175 QualType FirstArg = CtorType->getParamType(0); 3176 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Type, FirstArg.getNonReferenceType())) 3177 return true; 3178 } 3179 return false; 3180 } 3181 3182 static OverloadingResult 3183 IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 3184 CXXRecordDecl *To, 3185 UserDefinedConversionSequence &User, 3186 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 3187 bool AllowExplicit) { 3188 CandidateSet.clear(OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion); 3189 for (auto *D : S.LookupConstructors(To)) { 3190 auto Info = getConstructorInfo(D); 3191 if (!Info) 3192 continue; 3193 3194 bool Usable = !Info.Constructor->isInvalidDecl() && 3195 S.isInitListConstructor(Info.Constructor) && 3196 (AllowExplicit || !Info.Constructor->isExplicit()); 3197 if (Usable) { 3198 // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type, 3199 // suppress conversions. 3200 bool SuppressUserConversions = isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType( 3201 S.Context, Info.Constructor, ToType); 3202 if (Info.ConstructorTmpl) 3203 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(Info.ConstructorTmpl, Info.FoundDecl, 3204 /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr, From, 3205 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions); 3206 else 3207 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Info.Constructor, Info.FoundDecl, From, 3208 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions); 3209 } 3210 } 3211 3212 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 3213 3214 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 3215 switch (auto Result = 3216 CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), 3217 Best)) { 3218 case OR_Deleted: 3219 case OR_Success: { 3220 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function. 3221 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function); 3222 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context); 3223 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such. 3224 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion(); 3225 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates; 3226 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor; 3227 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl; 3228 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion(); 3229 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()); 3230 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType); 3231 return Result; 3232 } 3233 3234 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 3235 return OR_No_Viable_Function; 3236 case OR_Ambiguous: 3237 return OR_Ambiguous; 3238 } 3239 3240 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!"); 3241 } 3242 3243 /// Determines whether there is a user-defined conversion sequence 3244 /// (C++ [over.ics.user]) that converts expression From to the type 3245 /// ToType. If such a conversion exists, User will contain the 3246 /// user-defined conversion sequence that performs such a conversion 3247 /// and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this routine returns 3248 /// false and User is unspecified. 3249 /// 3250 /// \param AllowExplicit true if the conversion should consider C++0x 3251 /// "explicit" conversion functions as well as non-explicit conversion 3252 /// functions (C++0x [class.conv.fct]p2). 3253 /// 3254 /// \param AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit true if the conversion should 3255 /// allow an extra Objective-C pointer conversion on uses of explicit 3256 /// constructors. Requires \c AllowExplicit to also be set. 3257 static OverloadingResult 3258 IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 3259 UserDefinedConversionSequence &User, 3260 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 3261 bool AllowExplicit, 3262 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) { 3263 assert(AllowExplicit || !AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit); 3264 CandidateSet.clear(OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion); 3265 3266 // Whether we will only visit constructors. 3267 bool ConstructorsOnly = false; 3268 3269 // If the type we are conversion to is a class type, enumerate its 3270 // constructors. 3271 if (const RecordType *ToRecordType = ToType->getAs<RecordType>()) { 3272 // C++ [over.match.ctor]p1: 3273 // When objects of class type are direct-initialized (8.5), or 3274 // copy-initialized from an expression of the same or a 3275 // derived class type (8.5), overload resolution selects the 3276 // constructor. [...] For copy-initialization, the candidate 3277 // functions are all the converting constructors (12.3.1) of 3278 // that class. The argument list is the expression-list within 3279 // the parentheses of the initializer. 3280 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, From->getType()) || 3281 (From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>() && 3282 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getLocStart(), From->getType(), ToType))) 3283 ConstructorsOnly = true; 3284 3285 if (!S.isCompleteType(From->getExprLoc(), ToType)) { 3286 // We're not going to find any constructors. 3287 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *ToRecordDecl 3288 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ToRecordType->getDecl())) { 3289 3290 Expr **Args = &From; 3291 unsigned NumArgs = 1; 3292 bool ListInitializing = false; 3293 if (InitListExpr *InitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From)) { 3294 // But first, see if there is an init-list-constructor that will work. 3295 OverloadingResult Result = IsInitializerListConstructorConversion( 3296 S, From, ToType, ToRecordDecl, User, CandidateSet, AllowExplicit); 3297 if (Result != OR_No_Viable_Function) 3298 return Result; 3299 // Never mind. 3300 CandidateSet.clear( 3301 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion); 3302 3303 // If we're list-initializing, we pass the individual elements as 3304 // arguments, not the entire list. 3305 Args = InitList->getInits(); 3306 NumArgs = InitList->getNumInits(); 3307 ListInitializing = true; 3308 } 3309 3310 for (auto *D : S.LookupConstructors(ToRecordDecl)) { 3311 auto Info = getConstructorInfo(D); 3312 if (!Info) 3313 continue; 3314 3315 bool Usable = !Info.Constructor->isInvalidDecl(); 3316 if (ListInitializing) 3317 Usable = Usable && (AllowExplicit || !Info.Constructor->isExplicit()); 3318 else 3319 Usable = Usable && 3320 Info.Constructor->isConvertingConstructor(AllowExplicit); 3321 if (Usable) { 3322 bool SuppressUserConversions = !ConstructorsOnly; 3323 if (SuppressUserConversions && ListInitializing) { 3324 SuppressUserConversions = false; 3325 if (NumArgs == 1) { 3326 // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type, 3327 // suppress conversions. 3328 SuppressUserConversions = isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType( 3329 S.Context, Info.Constructor, ToType); 3330 } 3331 } 3332 if (Info.ConstructorTmpl) 3333 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate( 3334 Info.ConstructorTmpl, Info.FoundDecl, 3335 /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr, llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), 3336 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions); 3337 else 3338 // Allow one user-defined conversion when user specifies a 3339 // From->ToType conversion via an static cast (c-style, etc). 3340 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Info.Constructor, Info.FoundDecl, 3341 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs), 3342 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions); 3343 } 3344 } 3345 } 3346 } 3347 3348 // Enumerate conversion functions, if we're allowed to. 3349 if (ConstructorsOnly || isa<InitListExpr>(From)) { 3350 } else if (!S.isCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), From->getType())) { 3351 // No conversion functions from incomplete types. 3352 } else if (const RecordType *FromRecordType 3353 = From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) { 3354 if (CXXRecordDecl *FromRecordDecl 3355 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FromRecordType->getDecl())) { 3356 // Add all of the conversion functions as candidates. 3357 const auto &Conversions = FromRecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 3358 for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) { 3359 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = I.getPair(); 3360 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl(); 3361 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()); 3362 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 3363 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 3364 3365 CXXConversionDecl *Conv; 3366 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate; 3367 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))) 3368 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()); 3369 else 3370 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 3371 3372 if (AllowExplicit || !Conv->isExplicit()) { 3373 if (ConvTemplate) 3374 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, FoundDecl, 3375 ActingContext, From, ToType, 3376 CandidateSet, 3377 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit); 3378 else 3379 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext, 3380 From, ToType, CandidateSet, 3381 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit); 3382 } 3383 } 3384 } 3385 } 3386 3387 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 3388 3389 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 3390 switch (auto Result = CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), 3391 Best)) { 3392 case OR_Success: 3393 case OR_Deleted: 3394 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function. 3395 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor 3396 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function)) { 3397 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1: 3398 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a 3399 // constructor (12.3.1), the initial standard conversion 3400 // sequence converts the source type to the type required by 3401 // the argument of the constructor. 3402 // 3403 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context); 3404 if (isa<InitListExpr>(From)) { 3405 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such. 3406 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion(); 3407 } else { 3408 if (Best->Conversions[0].isEllipsis()) 3409 User.EllipsisConversion = true; 3410 else { 3411 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard; 3412 User.EllipsisConversion = false; 3413 } 3414 } 3415 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates; 3416 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor; 3417 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl; 3418 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion(); 3419 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()); 3420 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType); 3421 return Result; 3422 } 3423 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion 3424 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Best->Function)) { 3425 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1: 3426 // 3427 // [...] If the user-defined conversion is specified by a 3428 // conversion function (12.3.2), the initial standard 3429 // conversion sequence converts the source type to the 3430 // implicit object parameter of the conversion function. 3431 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard; 3432 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates; 3433 User.ConversionFunction = Conversion; 3434 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl; 3435 User.EllipsisConversion = false; 3436 3437 // C++ [over.ics.user]p2: 3438 // The second standard conversion sequence converts the 3439 // result of the user-defined conversion to the target type 3440 // for the sequence. Since an implicit conversion sequence 3441 // is an initialization, the special rules for 3442 // initialization by user-defined conversion apply when 3443 // selecting the best user-defined conversion for a 3444 // user-defined conversion sequence (see 13.3.3 and 3445 // 13.3.3.1). 3446 User.After = Best->FinalConversion; 3447 return Result; 3448 } 3449 llvm_unreachable("Not a constructor or conversion function?"); 3450 3451 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 3452 return OR_No_Viable_Function; 3453 3454 case OR_Ambiguous: 3455 return OR_Ambiguous; 3456 } 3457 3458 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!"); 3459 } 3460 3461 bool 3462 Sema::DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType) { 3463 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 3464 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(From->getExprLoc(), 3465 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 3466 OverloadingResult OvResult = 3467 IsUserDefinedConversion(*this, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, 3468 CandidateSet, false, false); 3469 if (OvResult == OR_Ambiguous) 3470 Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_ambiguous_condition) 3471 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange(); 3472 else if (OvResult == OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty()) { 3473 if (!RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType, 3474 diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition_incomplete, 3475 From->getType(), From->getSourceRange())) 3476 Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition) 3477 << false << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << ToType; 3478 } else 3479 return false; 3480 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, From); 3481 return true; 3482 } 3483 3484 /// Compare the user-defined conversion functions or constructors 3485 /// of two user-defined conversion sequences to determine whether any ordering 3486 /// is possible. 3487 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3488 compareConversionFunctions(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Function1, 3489 FunctionDecl *Function2) { 3490 if (!S.getLangOpts().ObjC1 || !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 3491 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3492 3493 // Objective-C++: 3494 // If both conversion functions are implicitly-declared conversions from 3495 // a lambda closure type to a function pointer and a block pointer, 3496 // respectively, always prefer the conversion to a function pointer, 3497 // because the function pointer is more lightweight and is more likely 3498 // to keep code working. 3499 CXXConversionDecl *Conv1 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXConversionDecl>(Function1); 3500 if (!Conv1) 3501 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3502 3503 CXXConversionDecl *Conv2 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Function2); 3504 if (!Conv2) 3505 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3506 3507 if (Conv1->getParent()->isLambda() && Conv2->getParent()->isLambda()) { 3508 bool Block1 = Conv1->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType(); 3509 bool Block2 = Conv2->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType(); 3510 if (Block1 != Block2) 3511 return Block1 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 3512 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3513 } 3514 3515 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3516 } 3517 3518 static bool hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion( 3519 const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS) { 3520 return (ICS.isStandard() && ICS.Standard.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr) || 3521 (ICS.isUserDefined() && 3522 ICS.UserDefined.Before.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr); 3523 } 3524 3525 /// CompareImplicitConversionSequences - Compare two implicit 3526 /// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the 3527 /// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2). 3528 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3529 CompareImplicitConversionSequences(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 3530 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS1, 3531 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS2) 3532 { 3533 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p2): When comparing the basic forms of implicit 3534 // conversion sequences (as defined in 13.3.3.1) 3535 // -- a standard conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.1) is a better 3536 // conversion sequence than a user-defined conversion sequence or 3537 // an ellipsis conversion sequence, and 3538 // -- a user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2) is a better 3539 // conversion sequence than an ellipsis conversion sequence 3540 // (13.3.3.1.3). 3541 // 3542 // C++0x [over.best.ics]p10: 3543 // For the purpose of ranking implicit conversion sequences as 3544 // described in 13.3.3.2, the ambiguous conversion sequence is 3545 // treated as a user-defined sequence that is indistinguishable 3546 // from any other user-defined conversion sequence. 3547 3548 // String literal to 'char *' conversion has been deprecated in C++03. It has 3549 // been removed from C++11. We still accept this conversion, if it happens at 3550 // the best viable function. Otherwise, this conversion is considered worse 3551 // than ellipsis conversion. Consider this as an extension; this is not in the 3552 // standard. For example: 3553 // 3554 // int &f(...); // #1 3555 // void f(char*); // #2 3556 // void g() { int &r = f("foo"); } 3557 // 3558 // In C++03, we pick #2 as the best viable function. 3559 // In C++11, we pick #1 as the best viable function, because ellipsis 3560 // conversion is better than string-literal to char* conversion (since there 3561 // is no such conversion in C++11). If there was no #1 at all or #1 couldn't 3562 // convert arguments, #2 would be the best viable function in C++11. 3563 // If the best viable function has this conversion, a warning will be issued 3564 // in C++03, or an ExtWarn (+SFINAE failure) will be issued in C++11. 3565 3566 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && !S.getLangOpts().WritableStrings && 3567 hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS1) != 3568 hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS2)) 3569 return hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS1) 3570 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 3571 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3572 3573 if (ICS1.getKindRank() < ICS2.getKindRank()) 3574 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3575 if (ICS2.getKindRank() < ICS1.getKindRank()) 3576 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3577 3578 // The following checks require both conversion sequences to be of 3579 // the same kind. 3580 if (ICS1.getKind() != ICS2.getKind()) 3581 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3582 3583 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result = 3584 ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3585 3586 // Two implicit conversion sequences of the same form are 3587 // indistinguishable conversion sequences unless one of the 3588 // following rules apply: (C++ 13.3.3.2p3): 3589 3590 // List-initialization sequence L1 is a better conversion sequence than 3591 // list-initialization sequence L2 if: 3592 // - L1 converts to std::initializer_list<X> for some X and L2 does not, or, 3593 // if not that, 3594 // - L1 converts to type "array of N1 T", L2 converts to type "array of N2 T", 3595 // and N1 is smaller than N2., 3596 // even if one of the other rules in this paragraph would otherwise apply. 3597 if (!ICS1.isBad()) { 3598 if (ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() && 3599 !ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement()) 3600 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3601 if (!ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() && 3602 ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement()) 3603 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3604 } 3605 3606 if (ICS1.isStandard()) 3607 // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence than 3608 // standard conversion sequence S2 if [...] 3609 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, Loc, 3610 ICS1.Standard, ICS2.Standard); 3611 else if (ICS1.isUserDefined()) { 3612 // User-defined conversion sequence U1 is a better conversion 3613 // sequence than another user-defined conversion sequence U2 if 3614 // they contain the same user-defined conversion function or 3615 // constructor and if the second standard conversion sequence of 3616 // U1 is better than the second standard conversion sequence of 3617 // U2 (C++ 13.3.3.2p3). 3618 if (ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction == 3619 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction) 3620 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, Loc, 3621 ICS1.UserDefined.After, 3622 ICS2.UserDefined.After); 3623 else 3624 Result = compareConversionFunctions(S, 3625 ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction, 3626 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction); 3627 } 3628 3629 return Result; 3630 } 3631 3632 static bool hasSimilarType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T1, QualType T2) { 3633 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) { 3634 Qualifiers Quals; 3635 T1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, Quals); 3636 T2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, Quals); 3637 } 3638 3639 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2); 3640 } 3641 3642 // Per 13.3.3.2p3, compare the given standard conversion sequences to 3643 // determine if one is a proper subset of the other. 3644 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3645 compareStandardConversionSubsets(ASTContext &Context, 3646 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 3647 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) { 3648 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result 3649 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3650 3651 // the identity conversion sequence is considered to be a subsequence of 3652 // any non-identity conversion sequence 3653 if (SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && !SCS2.isIdentityConversion()) 3654 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3655 else if (!SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && SCS2.isIdentityConversion()) 3656 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3657 3658 if (SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second) { 3659 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Identity) 3660 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3661 else if (SCS2.Second == ICK_Identity) 3662 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3663 else 3664 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3665 } else if (!hasSimilarType(Context, SCS1.getToType(1), SCS2.getToType(1))) 3666 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3667 3668 if (SCS1.Third == SCS2.Third) { 3669 return Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getToType(2), SCS2.getToType(2))? Result 3670 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3671 } 3672 3673 if (SCS1.Third == ICK_Identity) 3674 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 3675 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable 3676 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3677 3678 if (SCS2.Third == ICK_Identity) 3679 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 3680 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable 3681 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3682 3683 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3684 } 3685 3686 /// Determine whether one of the given reference bindings is better 3687 /// than the other based on what kind of bindings they are. 3688 static bool 3689 isBetterReferenceBindingKind(const StandardConversionSequence &SCS1, 3690 const StandardConversionSequence &SCS2) { 3691 // C++0x [over.ics.rank]p3b4: 3692 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3) and neither refers to an 3693 // implicit object parameter of a non-static member function declared 3694 // without a ref-qualifier, and *either* S1 binds an rvalue reference 3695 // to an rvalue and S2 binds an lvalue reference *or S1 binds an 3696 // lvalue reference to a function lvalue and S2 binds an rvalue 3697 // reference*. 3698 // 3699 // FIXME: Rvalue references. We're going rogue with the above edits, 3700 // because the semantics in the current C++0x working paper (N3225 at the 3701 // time of this writing) break the standard definition of std::forward 3702 // and std::reference_wrapper when dealing with references to functions. 3703 // Proposed wording changes submitted to CWG for consideration. 3704 if (SCS1.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier || 3705 SCS2.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier) 3706 return false; 3707 3708 return (!SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToRvalue && 3709 SCS2.IsLvalueReference) || 3710 (SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToFunctionLvalue && 3711 !SCS2.IsLvalueReference && SCS2.BindsToFunctionLvalue); 3712 } 3713 3714 /// CompareStandardConversionSequences - Compare two standard 3715 /// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the 3716 /// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2p3). 3717 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3718 CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 3719 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 3720 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) 3721 { 3722 // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence 3723 // than standard conversion sequence S2 if (C++ 13.3.3.2p3): 3724 3725 // -- S1 is a proper subsequence of S2 (comparing the conversion 3726 // sequences in the canonical form defined by 13.3.3.1.1, 3727 // excluding any Lvalue Transformation; the identity conversion 3728 // sequence is considered to be a subsequence of any 3729 // non-identity conversion sequence) or, if not that, 3730 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind CK 3731 = compareStandardConversionSubsets(S.Context, SCS1, SCS2)) 3732 return CK; 3733 3734 // -- the rank of S1 is better than the rank of S2 (by the rules 3735 // defined below), or, if not that, 3736 ImplicitConversionRank Rank1 = SCS1.getRank(); 3737 ImplicitConversionRank Rank2 = SCS2.getRank(); 3738 if (Rank1 < Rank2) 3739 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3740 else if (Rank2 < Rank1) 3741 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3742 3743 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p4): Two conversion sequences with the same rank 3744 // are indistinguishable unless one of the following rules 3745 // applies: 3746 3747 // A conversion that is not a conversion of a pointer, or 3748 // pointer to member, to bool is better than another conversion 3749 // that is such a conversion. 3750 if (SCS1.isPointerConversionToBool() != SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool()) 3751 return SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool() 3752 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 3753 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3754 3755 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b2: 3756 // 3757 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A, 3758 // conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of B* to 3759 // void*, and conversion of A* to void* is better than conversion 3760 // of B* to void*. 3761 bool SCS1ConvertsToVoid 3762 = SCS1.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context); 3763 bool SCS2ConvertsToVoid 3764 = SCS2.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context); 3765 if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid != SCS2ConvertsToVoid) { 3766 // Exactly one of the conversion sequences is a conversion to 3767 // a void pointer; it's the worse conversion. 3768 return SCS2ConvertsToVoid ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 3769 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3770 } else if (!SCS1ConvertsToVoid && !SCS2ConvertsToVoid) { 3771 // Neither conversion sequence converts to a void pointer; compare 3772 // their derived-to-base conversions. 3773 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind DerivedCK 3774 = CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(S, Loc, SCS1, SCS2)) 3775 return DerivedCK; 3776 } else if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid && SCS2ConvertsToVoid && 3777 !S.Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getFromType(), SCS2.getFromType())) { 3778 // Both conversion sequences are conversions to void 3779 // pointers. Compare the source types to determine if there's an 3780 // inheritance relationship in their sources. 3781 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType(); 3782 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType(); 3783 3784 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer 3785 // conversion, if we need to. 3786 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 3787 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1); 3788 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 3789 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2); 3790 3791 QualType FromPointee1 = FromType1->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 3792 QualType FromPointee2 = FromType2->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 3793 3794 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee2, FromPointee1)) 3795 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3796 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee1, FromPointee2)) 3797 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3798 3799 // Objective-C++: If one interface is more specific than the 3800 // other, it is the better one. 3801 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr1 3802 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 3803 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr2 3804 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 3805 if (FromObjCPtr1 && FromObjCPtr2) { 3806 bool AssignLeft = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr1, 3807 FromObjCPtr2); 3808 bool AssignRight = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr2, 3809 FromObjCPtr1); 3810 if (AssignLeft != AssignRight) { 3811 return AssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 3812 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3813 } 3814 } 3815 } 3816 3817 // Compare based on qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3, 3818 // bullet 3). 3819 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind QualCK 3820 = CompareQualificationConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2)) 3821 return QualCK; 3822 3823 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) { 3824 // Check for a better reference binding based on the kind of bindings. 3825 if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS1, SCS2)) 3826 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3827 else if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS2, SCS1)) 3828 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3829 3830 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p3b4: 3831 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3), and the types to 3832 // which the references refer are the same type except for 3833 // top-level cv-qualifiers, and the type to which the reference 3834 // initialized by S2 refers is more cv-qualified than the type 3835 // to which the reference initialized by S1 refers. 3836 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2); 3837 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2); 3838 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1); 3839 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2); 3840 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals; 3841 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals); 3842 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals); 3843 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) { 3844 // Objective-C++ ARC: If the references refer to objects with different 3845 // lifetimes, prefer bindings that don't change lifetime. 3846 if (SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding != 3847 SCS2.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding) { 3848 return SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding 3849 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 3850 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3851 } 3852 3853 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the 3854 // type for comparison. 3855 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals) 3856 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals); 3857 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals) 3858 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals); 3859 if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) 3860 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3861 else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) 3862 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3863 } 3864 } 3865 3866 // In Microsoft mode, prefer an integral conversion to a 3867 // floating-to-integral conversion if the integral conversion 3868 // is between types of the same size. 3869 // For example: 3870 // void f(float); 3871 // void f(int); 3872 // int main { 3873 // long a; 3874 // f(a); 3875 // } 3876 // Here, MSVC will call f(int) instead of generating a compile error 3877 // as clang will do in standard mode. 3878 if (S.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && SCS1.Second == ICK_Integral_Conversion && 3879 SCS2.Second == ICK_Floating_Integral && 3880 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getFromType()) == 3881 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getToType(2))) 3882 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3883 3884 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3885 } 3886 3887 /// CompareQualificationConversions - Compares two standard conversion 3888 /// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their 3889 /// qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3 bullet 3). 3890 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 3891 CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S, 3892 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 3893 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) { 3894 // C++ 13.3.3.2p3: 3895 // -- S1 and S2 differ only in their qualification conversion and 3896 // yield similar types T1 and T2 (C++ 4.4), respectively, and the 3897 // cv-qualification signature of type T1 is a proper subset of 3898 // the cv-qualification signature of type T2, and S1 is not the 3899 // deprecated string literal array-to-pointer conversion (4.2). 3900 if (SCS1.First != SCS2.First || SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second || 3901 SCS1.Third != SCS2.Third || SCS1.Third != ICK_Qualification) 3902 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3903 3904 // FIXME: the example in the standard doesn't use a qualification 3905 // conversion (!) 3906 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2); 3907 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2); 3908 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1); 3909 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2); 3910 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals; 3911 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals); 3912 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals); 3913 3914 // If the types are the same, we won't learn anything by unwrapped 3915 // them. 3916 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) 3917 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3918 3919 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type 3920 // for comparison. 3921 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals) 3922 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals); 3923 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals) 3924 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals); 3925 3926 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result 3927 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3928 3929 // Objective-C++ ARC: 3930 // Prefer qualification conversions not involving a change in lifetime 3931 // to qualification conversions that do not change lifetime. 3932 if (SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime != 3933 SCS2.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime) { 3934 Result = SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime 3935 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 3936 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3937 } 3938 3939 while (S.Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) { 3940 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to 3941 // determine if this still looks like a qualification 3942 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of 3943 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again 3944 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left 3945 // to unwrap. This essentially mimics what 3946 // IsQualificationConversion does, but here we're checking for a 3947 // strict subset of qualifiers. 3948 if (T1.getCVRQualifiers() == T2.getCVRQualifiers()) 3949 // The qualifiers are the same, so this doesn't tell us anything 3950 // about how the sequences rank. 3951 ; 3952 else if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) { 3953 // T1 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence. 3954 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse) 3955 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's 3956 // qualifiers. 3957 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3958 3959 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 3960 } else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) { 3961 // T2 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence. 3962 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better) 3963 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's 3964 // qualifiers. 3965 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3966 3967 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 3968 } else { 3969 // Qualifiers are disjoint. 3970 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3971 } 3972 3973 // If the types after this point are equivalent, we're done. 3974 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2)) 3975 break; 3976 } 3977 3978 // Check that the winning standard conversion sequence isn't using 3979 // the deprecated string literal array to pointer conversion. 3980 switch (Result) { 3981 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better: 3982 if (SCS1.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr) 3983 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3984 break; 3985 3986 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable: 3987 break; 3988 3989 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse: 3990 if (SCS2.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr) 3991 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 3992 break; 3993 } 3994 3995 return Result; 3996 } 3997 3998 /// CompareDerivedToBaseConversions - Compares two standard conversion 3999 /// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their 4000 /// various kinds of derived-to-base conversions (C++ 4001 /// [over.ics.rank]p4b3). As part of these checks, we also look at 4002 /// conversions between Objective-C interface types. 4003 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind 4004 CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 4005 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1, 4006 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) { 4007 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType(); 4008 QualType ToType1 = SCS1.getToType(1); 4009 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType(); 4010 QualType ToType2 = SCS2.getToType(1); 4011 4012 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer 4013 // conversion, if we need to. 4014 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 4015 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1); 4016 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer) 4017 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2); 4018 4019 // Canonicalize all of the types. 4020 FromType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType1); 4021 ToType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType1); 4022 FromType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType2); 4023 ToType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType2); 4024 4025 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b3: 4026 // 4027 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A and 4028 // class C is derived directly or indirectly from B, 4029 // 4030 // Compare based on pointer conversions. 4031 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && 4032 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && 4033 /*FIXME: Remove if Objective-C id conversions get their own rank*/ 4034 FromType1->isPointerType() && FromType2->isPointerType() && 4035 ToType1->isPointerType() && ToType2->isPointerType()) { 4036 QualType FromPointee1 4037 = FromType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 4038 QualType ToPointee1 4039 = ToType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 4040 QualType FromPointee2 4041 = FromType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 4042 QualType ToPointee2 4043 = ToType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType(); 4044 4045 // -- conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*, 4046 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) { 4047 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee1, ToPointee2)) 4048 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4049 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee2, ToPointee1)) 4050 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4051 } 4052 4053 // -- conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*, 4054 if (FromPointee1 != FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 == ToPointee2) { 4055 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee2, FromPointee1)) 4056 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4057 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee1, FromPointee2)) 4058 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4059 } 4060 } else if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && 4061 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) { 4062 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr1 4063 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 4064 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr2 4065 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 4066 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr1 4067 = ToType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 4068 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr2 4069 = ToType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 4070 4071 if (FromPtr1 && FromPtr2 && ToPtr1 && ToPtr2) { 4072 // Apply the same conversion ranking rules for Objective-C pointer types 4073 // that we do for C++ pointers to class types. However, we employ the 4074 // Objective-C pseudo-subtyping relationship used for assignment of 4075 // Objective-C pointer types. 4076 bool FromAssignLeft 4077 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr1, FromPtr2); 4078 bool FromAssignRight 4079 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr2, FromPtr1); 4080 bool ToAssignLeft 4081 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr1, ToPtr2); 4082 bool ToAssignRight 4083 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr2, ToPtr1); 4084 4085 // A conversion to an a non-id object pointer type or qualified 'id' 4086 // type is better than a conversion to 'id'. 4087 if (ToPtr1->isObjCIdType() && 4088 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())) 4089 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4090 if (ToPtr2->isObjCIdType() && 4091 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())) 4092 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4093 4094 // A conversion to a non-id object pointer type is better than a 4095 // conversion to a qualified 'id' type 4096 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()) 4097 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4098 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()) 4099 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4100 4101 // A conversion to an a non-Class object pointer type or qualified 'Class' 4102 // type is better than a conversion to 'Class'. 4103 if (ToPtr1->isObjCClassType() && 4104 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())) 4105 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4106 if (ToPtr2->isObjCClassType() && 4107 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())) 4108 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4109 4110 // A conversion to a non-Class object pointer type is better than a 4111 // conversion to a qualified 'Class' type. 4112 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()) 4113 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4114 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()) 4115 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4116 4117 // -- "conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*," 4118 if (S.Context.hasSameType(FromType1, FromType2) && 4119 !FromPtr1->isObjCIdType() && !FromPtr1->isObjCClassType() && 4120 (ToAssignLeft != ToAssignRight)) { 4121 if (FromPtr1->isSpecialized()) { 4122 // "conversion of B<A> * to B * is better than conversion of B * to 4123 // C *. 4124 bool IsFirstSame = 4125 FromPtr1->getInterfaceDecl() == ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl(); 4126 bool IsSecondSame = 4127 FromPtr1->getInterfaceDecl() == ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl(); 4128 if (IsFirstSame) { 4129 if (!IsSecondSame) 4130 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4131 } else if (IsSecondSame) 4132 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4133 } 4134 return ToAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse 4135 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4136 } 4137 4138 // -- "conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*," 4139 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2) && 4140 (FromAssignLeft != FromAssignRight)) 4141 return FromAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better 4142 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4143 } 4144 } 4145 4146 // Ranking of member-pointer types. 4147 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && 4148 FromType1->isMemberPointerType() && FromType2->isMemberPointerType() && 4149 ToType1->isMemberPointerType() && ToType2->isMemberPointerType()) { 4150 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer1 = 4151 FromType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 4152 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer1 = 4153 ToType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 4154 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer2 = 4155 FromType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 4156 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer2 = 4157 ToType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 4158 const Type *FromPointeeType1 = FromMemPointer1->getClass(); 4159 const Type *ToPointeeType1 = ToMemPointer1->getClass(); 4160 const Type *FromPointeeType2 = FromMemPointer2->getClass(); 4161 const Type *ToPointeeType2 = ToMemPointer2->getClass(); 4162 QualType FromPointee1 = QualType(FromPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 4163 QualType ToPointee1 = QualType(ToPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 4164 QualType FromPointee2 = QualType(FromPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 4165 QualType ToPointee2 = QualType(ToPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType(); 4166 // conversion of A::* to B::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*, 4167 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) { 4168 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee1, ToPointee2)) 4169 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4170 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee2, ToPointee1)) 4171 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4172 } 4173 // conversion of B::* to C::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::* 4174 if (ToPointee1 == ToPointee2 && FromPointee1 != FromPointee2) { 4175 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee1, FromPointee2)) 4176 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4177 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee2, FromPointee1)) 4178 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4179 } 4180 } 4181 4182 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) { 4183 // -- conversion of C to B is better than conversion of C to A, 4184 // -- binding of an expression of type C to a reference of type 4185 // B& is better than binding an expression of type C to a 4186 // reference of type A&, 4187 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) && 4188 !S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) { 4189 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToType1, ToType2)) 4190 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4191 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToType2, ToType1)) 4192 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4193 } 4194 4195 // -- conversion of B to A is better than conversion of C to A. 4196 // -- binding of an expression of type B to a reference of type 4197 // A& is better than binding an expression of type C to a 4198 // reference of type A&, 4199 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) && 4200 S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) { 4201 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromType2, FromType1)) 4202 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 4203 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromType1, FromType2)) 4204 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse; 4205 } 4206 } 4207 4208 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable; 4209 } 4210 4211 /// Determine whether the given type is valid, e.g., it is not an invalid 4212 /// C++ class. 4213 static bool isTypeValid(QualType T) { 4214 if (CXXRecordDecl *Record = T->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) 4215 return !Record->isInvalidDecl(); 4216 4217 return true; 4218 } 4219 4220 /// CompareReferenceRelationship - Compare the two types T1 and T2 to 4221 /// determine whether they are reference-related, 4222 /// reference-compatible, reference-compatible with added 4223 /// qualification, or incompatible, for use in C++ initialization by 4224 /// reference (C++ [dcl.ref.init]p4). Neither type can be a reference 4225 /// type, and the first type (T1) is the pointee type of the reference 4226 /// type being initialized. 4227 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult 4228 Sema::CompareReferenceRelationship(SourceLocation Loc, 4229 QualType OrigT1, QualType OrigT2, 4230 bool &DerivedToBase, 4231 bool &ObjCConversion, 4232 bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) { 4233 assert(!OrigT1->isReferenceType() && 4234 "T1 must be the pointee type of the reference type"); 4235 assert(!OrigT2->isReferenceType() && "T2 cannot be a reference type"); 4236 4237 QualType T1 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT1); 4238 QualType T2 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT2); 4239 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals; 4240 QualType UnqualT1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals); 4241 QualType UnqualT2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals); 4242 4243 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4: 4244 // Given types "cv1 T1" and "cv2 T2," "cv1 T1" is 4245 // reference-related to "cv2 T2" if T1 is the same type as T2, or 4246 // T1 is a base class of T2. 4247 DerivedToBase = false; 4248 ObjCConversion = false; 4249 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false; 4250 QualType ConvertedT2; 4251 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) { 4252 // Nothing to do. 4253 } else if (isCompleteType(Loc, OrigT2) && 4254 isTypeValid(UnqualT1) && isTypeValid(UnqualT2) && 4255 IsDerivedFrom(Loc, UnqualT2, UnqualT1)) 4256 DerivedToBase = true; 4257 else if (UnqualT1->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() && 4258 UnqualT2->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() && 4259 Context.canBindObjCObjectType(UnqualT1, UnqualT2)) 4260 ObjCConversion = true; 4261 else if (UnqualT2->isFunctionType() && 4262 IsFunctionConversion(UnqualT2, UnqualT1, ConvertedT2)) 4263 // C++1z [dcl.init.ref]p4: 4264 // cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if [...] T2 is "noexcept 4265 // function" and T1 is "function" 4266 // 4267 // We extend this to also apply to 'noreturn', so allow any function 4268 // conversion between function types. 4269 return Ref_Compatible; 4270 else 4271 return Ref_Incompatible; 4272 4273 // At this point, we know that T1 and T2 are reference-related (at 4274 // least). 4275 4276 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type 4277 // for comparison. 4278 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals) 4279 T1 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals); 4280 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals) 4281 T2 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals); 4282 4283 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4: 4284 // "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if T1 is 4285 // reference-related to T2 and cv1 is the same cv-qualification 4286 // as, or greater cv-qualification than, cv2. For purposes of 4287 // overload resolution, cases for which cv1 is greater 4288 // cv-qualification than cv2 are identified as 4289 // reference-compatible with added qualification (see 13.3.3.2). 4290 // 4291 // Note that we also require equivalence of Objective-C GC and address-space 4292 // qualifiers when performing these computations, so that e.g., an int in 4293 // address space 1 is not reference-compatible with an int in address 4294 // space 2. 4295 if (T1Quals.getObjCLifetime() != T2Quals.getObjCLifetime() && 4296 T1Quals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(T2Quals)) { 4297 if (isNonTrivialObjCLifetimeConversion(T2Quals, T1Quals)) 4298 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true; 4299 4300 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime(); 4301 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime(); 4302 } 4303 4304 // MS compiler ignores __unaligned qualifier for references; do the same. 4305 T1Quals.removeUnaligned(); 4306 T2Quals.removeUnaligned(); 4307 4308 if (T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals)) 4309 return Ref_Compatible; 4310 else 4311 return Ref_Related; 4312 } 4313 4314 /// Look for a user-defined conversion to a value reference-compatible 4315 /// with DeclType. Return true if something definite is found. 4316 static bool 4317 FindConversionForRefInit(Sema &S, ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS, 4318 QualType DeclType, SourceLocation DeclLoc, 4319 Expr *Init, QualType T2, bool AllowRvalues, 4320 bool AllowExplicit) { 4321 assert(T2->isRecordType() && "Can only find conversions of record types."); 4322 CXXRecordDecl *T2RecordDecl 4323 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(T2->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()); 4324 4325 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet( 4326 DeclLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion); 4327 const auto &Conversions = T2RecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 4328 for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) { 4329 NamedDecl *D = *I; 4330 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()); 4331 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 4332 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 4333 4334 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate 4335 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D); 4336 CXXConversionDecl *Conv; 4337 if (ConvTemplate) 4338 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()); 4339 else 4340 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 4341 4342 // If this is an explicit conversion, and we're not allowed to consider 4343 // explicit conversions, skip it. 4344 if (!AllowExplicit && Conv->isExplicit()) 4345 continue; 4346 4347 if (AllowRvalues) { 4348 bool DerivedToBase = false; 4349 bool ObjCConversion = false; 4350 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false; 4351 4352 // If we are initializing an rvalue reference, don't permit conversion 4353 // functions that return lvalues. 4354 if (!ConvTemplate && DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) { 4355 const ReferenceType *RefType 4356 = Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<LValueReferenceType>(); 4357 if (RefType && !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()) 4358 continue; 4359 } 4360 4361 if (!ConvTemplate && 4362 S.CompareReferenceRelationship( 4363 DeclLoc, 4364 Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType() 4365 .getUnqualifiedType(), 4366 DeclType.getNonReferenceType().getUnqualifiedType(), 4367 DerivedToBase, ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion) == 4368 Sema::Ref_Incompatible) 4369 continue; 4370 } else { 4371 // If the conversion function doesn't return a reference type, 4372 // it can't be considered for this conversion. An rvalue reference 4373 // is only acceptable if its referencee is a function type. 4374 4375 const ReferenceType *RefType = 4376 Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<ReferenceType>(); 4377 if (!RefType || 4378 (!RefType->isLValueReferenceType() && 4379 !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType())) 4380 continue; 4381 } 4382 4383 if (ConvTemplate) 4384 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, I.getPair(), ActingDC, 4385 Init, DeclType, CandidateSet, 4386 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 4387 else 4388 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init, 4389 DeclType, CandidateSet, 4390 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 4391 } 4392 4393 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 4394 4395 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 4396 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, DeclLoc, Best)) { 4397 case OR_Success: 4398 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1: 4399 // 4400 // [...] If the parameter binds directly to the result of 4401 // applying a conversion function to the argument 4402 // expression, the implicit conversion sequence is a 4403 // user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2), with the 4404 // second standard conversion sequence either an identity 4405 // conversion or, if the conversion function returns an 4406 // entity of a type that is a derived class of the parameter 4407 // type, a derived-to-base Conversion. 4408 if (!Best->FinalConversion.DirectBinding) 4409 return false; 4410 4411 ICS.setUserDefined(); 4412 ICS.UserDefined.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard; 4413 ICS.UserDefined.After = Best->FinalConversion; 4414 ICS.UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates; 4415 ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Best->Function; 4416 ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl; 4417 ICS.UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false; 4418 assert(ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding && 4419 ICS.UserDefined.After.DirectBinding && 4420 "Expected a direct reference binding!"); 4421 return true; 4422 4423 case OR_Ambiguous: 4424 ICS.setAmbiguous(); 4425 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(); 4426 Cand != CandidateSet.end(); ++Cand) 4427 if (Cand->Viable) 4428 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function); 4429 return true; 4430 4431 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 4432 case OR_Deleted: 4433 // There was no suitable conversion, or we found a deleted 4434 // conversion; continue with other checks. 4435 return false; 4436 } 4437 4438 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!"); 4439 } 4440 4441 /// Compute an implicit conversion sequence for reference 4442 /// initialization. 4443 static ImplicitConversionSequence 4444 TryReferenceInit(Sema &S, Expr *Init, QualType DeclType, 4445 SourceLocation DeclLoc, 4446 bool SuppressUserConversions, 4447 bool AllowExplicit) { 4448 assert(DeclType->isReferenceType() && "Reference init needs a reference"); 4449 4450 // Most paths end in a failed conversion. 4451 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 4452 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType); 4453 4454 QualType T1 = DeclType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType(); 4455 QualType T2 = Init->getType(); 4456 4457 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try 4458 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the 4459 // type of the resulting function. 4460 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 4461 DeclAccessPair Found; 4462 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Init, DeclType, 4463 false, Found)) 4464 T2 = Fn->getType(); 4465 } 4466 4467 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer. 4468 bool isRValRef = DeclType->isRValueReferenceType(); 4469 bool DerivedToBase = false; 4470 bool ObjCConversion = false; 4471 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false; 4472 Expr::Classification InitCategory = Init->Classify(S.Context); 4473 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship 4474 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(DeclLoc, T1, T2, DerivedToBase, 4475 ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion); 4476 4477 4478 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5: 4479 // A reference to type "cv1 T1" is initialized by an expression 4480 // of type "cv2 T2" as follows: 4481 4482 // -- If reference is an lvalue reference and the initializer expression 4483 if (!isRValRef) { 4484 // -- is an lvalue (but is not a bit-field), and "cv1 T1" is 4485 // reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or 4486 // 4487 // Per C++ [over.ics.ref]p4, we don't check the bit-field property here. 4488 if (InitCategory.isLValue() && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Compatible) { 4489 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1: 4490 // When a parameter of reference type binds directly (8.5.3) 4491 // to an argument expression, the implicit conversion sequence 4492 // is the identity conversion, unless the argument expression 4493 // has a type that is a derived class of the parameter type, 4494 // in which case the implicit conversion sequence is a 4495 // derived-to-base Conversion (13.3.3.1). 4496 ICS.setStandard(); 4497 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity; 4498 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base 4499 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion 4500 : ICK_Identity; 4501 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity; 4502 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr(); 4503 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2); 4504 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1); 4505 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1); 4506 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true; 4507 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true; 4508 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef; 4509 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType(); 4510 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = false; 4511 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 4512 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion; 4513 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = nullptr; 4514 ICS.Standard.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false; 4515 4516 // Nothing more to do: the inaccessibility/ambiguity check for 4517 // derived-to-base conversions is suppressed when we're 4518 // computing the implicit conversion sequence (C++ 4519 // [over.best.ics]p2). 4520 return ICS; 4521 } 4522 4523 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is 4524 // not reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly 4525 // converted to an lvalue of type "cv3 T3," where "cv1 T1" 4526 // is reference-compatible with "cv3 T3" 92) (this 4527 // conversion is selected by enumerating the applicable 4528 // conversion functions (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best 4529 // one through overload resolution (13.3)), 4530 if (!SuppressUserConversions && T2->isRecordType() && 4531 S.isCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2) && 4532 RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible) { 4533 if (FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc, 4534 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/false, 4535 AllowExplicit)) 4536 return ICS; 4537 } 4538 } 4539 4540 // -- Otherwise, the reference shall be an lvalue reference to a 4541 // non-volatile const type (i.e., cv1 shall be const), or the reference 4542 // shall be an rvalue reference. 4543 if (!isRValRef && (!T1.isConstQualified() || T1.isVolatileQualified())) 4544 return ICS; 4545 4546 // -- If the initializer expression 4547 // 4548 // -- is an xvalue, class prvalue, array prvalue or function 4549 // lvalue and "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2", or 4550 if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Compatible && 4551 (InitCategory.isXValue() || 4552 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && (T2->isRecordType() || T2->isArrayType())) || 4553 (InitCategory.isLValue() && T2->isFunctionType()))) { 4554 ICS.setStandard(); 4555 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity; 4556 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base 4557 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion 4558 : ICK_Identity; 4559 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity; 4560 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr(); 4561 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2); 4562 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1); 4563 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1); 4564 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true; 4565 // In C++0x, this is always a direct binding. In C++98/03, it's a direct 4566 // binding unless we're binding to a class prvalue. 4567 // Note: Although xvalues wouldn't normally show up in C++98/03 code, we 4568 // allow the use of rvalue references in C++98/03 for the benefit of 4569 // standard library implementors; therefore, we need the xvalue check here. 4570 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = 4571 S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 || 4572 !(InitCategory.isPRValue() || T2->isRecordType()); 4573 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef; 4574 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType(); 4575 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = InitCategory.isRValue(); 4576 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 4577 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion; 4578 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = nullptr; 4579 ICS.Standard.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false; 4580 return ICS; 4581 } 4582 4583 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is not 4584 // reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly converted to 4585 // an xvalue, class prvalue, or function lvalue of type 4586 // "cv3 T3", where "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with 4587 // "cv3 T3", 4588 // 4589 // then the reference is bound to the value of the initializer 4590 // expression in the first case and to the result of the conversion 4591 // in the second case (or, in either case, to an appropriate base 4592 // class subobject). 4593 if (!SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible && 4594 T2->isRecordType() && S.isCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2) && 4595 FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc, 4596 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/true, 4597 AllowExplicit)) { 4598 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference 4599 // and the second standard conversion sequence of the 4600 // user-defined conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue 4601 // conversion, the program is ill-formed. 4602 if (ICS.isUserDefined() && isRValRef && 4603 ICS.UserDefined.After.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) 4604 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType); 4605 4606 return ICS; 4607 } 4608 4609 // A temporary of function type cannot be created; don't even try. 4610 if (T1->isFunctionType()) 4611 return ICS; 4612 4613 // -- Otherwise, a temporary of type "cv1 T1" is created and 4614 // initialized from the initializer expression using the 4615 // rules for a non-reference copy initialization (8.5). The 4616 // reference is then bound to the temporary. If T1 is 4617 // reference-related to T2, cv1 must be the same 4618 // cv-qualification as, or greater cv-qualification than, 4619 // cv2; otherwise, the program is ill-formed. 4620 if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Related) { 4621 // If cv1 == cv2 or cv1 is a greater cv-qualified than cv2, then 4622 // we would be reference-compatible or reference-compatible with 4623 // added qualification. But that wasn't the case, so the reference 4624 // initialization fails. 4625 // 4626 // Note that we only want to check address spaces and cvr-qualifiers here. 4627 // ObjC GC, lifetime and unaligned qualifiers aren't important. 4628 Qualifiers T1Quals = T1.getQualifiers(); 4629 Qualifiers T2Quals = T2.getQualifiers(); 4630 T1Quals.removeObjCGCAttr(); 4631 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime(); 4632 T2Quals.removeObjCGCAttr(); 4633 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime(); 4634 // MS compiler ignores __unaligned qualifier for references; do the same. 4635 T1Quals.removeUnaligned(); 4636 T2Quals.removeUnaligned(); 4637 if (!T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals)) 4638 return ICS; 4639 } 4640 4641 // If at least one of the types is a class type, the types are not 4642 // related, and we aren't allowed any user conversions, the 4643 // reference binding fails. This case is important for breaking 4644 // recursion, since TryImplicitConversion below will attempt to 4645 // create a temporary through the use of a copy constructor. 4646 if (SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible && 4647 (T1->isRecordType() || T2->isRecordType())) 4648 return ICS; 4649 4650 // If T1 is reference-related to T2 and the reference is an rvalue 4651 // reference, the initializer expression shall not be an lvalue. 4652 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related && 4653 isRValRef && Init->Classify(S.Context).isLValue()) 4654 return ICS; 4655 4656 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p2: 4657 // When a parameter of reference type is not bound directly to 4658 // an argument expression, the conversion sequence is the one 4659 // required to convert the argument expression to the 4660 // underlying type of the reference according to 4661 // 13.3.3.1. Conceptually, this conversion sequence corresponds 4662 // to copy-initializing a temporary of the underlying type with 4663 // the argument expression. Any difference in top-level 4664 // cv-qualification is subsumed by the initialization itself 4665 // and does not constitute a conversion. 4666 ICS = TryImplicitConversion(S, Init, T1, SuppressUserConversions, 4667 /*AllowExplicit=*/false, 4668 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 4669 /*CStyle=*/false, 4670 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false, 4671 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 4672 4673 // Of course, that's still a reference binding. 4674 if (ICS.isStandard()) { 4675 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true; 4676 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef; 4677 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 4678 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = true; 4679 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 4680 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false; 4681 } else if (ICS.isUserDefined()) { 4682 const ReferenceType *LValRefType = 4683 ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction->getReturnType() 4684 ->getAs<LValueReferenceType>(); 4685 4686 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p3: 4687 // Except for an implicit object parameter, for which see 13.3.1, a 4688 // standard conversion sequence cannot be formed if it requires [...] 4689 // binding an rvalue reference to an lvalue other than a function 4690 // lvalue. 4691 // Note that the function case is not possible here. 4692 if (DeclType->isRValueReferenceType() && LValRefType) { 4693 // FIXME: This is the wrong BadConversionSequence. The problem is binding 4694 // an rvalue reference to a (non-function) lvalue, not binding an lvalue 4695 // reference to an rvalue! 4696 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, Init, DeclType); 4697 return ICS; 4698 } 4699 4700 ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding = true; 4701 ICS.UserDefined.After.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef; 4702 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 4703 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToRvalue = !LValRefType; 4704 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 4705 ICS.UserDefined.After.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false; 4706 } 4707 4708 return ICS; 4709 } 4710 4711 static ImplicitConversionSequence 4712 TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 4713 bool SuppressUserConversions, 4714 bool InOverloadResolution, 4715 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 4716 bool AllowExplicit = false); 4717 4718 /// TryListConversion - Try to copy-initialize a value of type ToType from the 4719 /// initializer list From. 4720 static ImplicitConversionSequence 4721 TryListConversion(Sema &S, InitListExpr *From, QualType ToType, 4722 bool SuppressUserConversions, 4723 bool InOverloadResolution, 4724 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) { 4725 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p1: 4726 // When an argument is an initializer list, it is not an expression and 4727 // special rules apply for converting it to a parameter type. 4728 4729 ImplicitConversionSequence Result; 4730 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType); 4731 4732 // We need a complete type for what follows. Incomplete types can never be 4733 // initialized from init lists. 4734 if (!S.isCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType)) 4735 return Result; 4736 4737 // Per DR1467: 4738 // If the parameter type is a class X and the initializer list has a single 4739 // element of type cv U, where U is X or a class derived from X, the 4740 // implicit conversion sequence is the one required to convert the element 4741 // to the parameter type. 4742 // 4743 // Otherwise, if the parameter type is a character array [... ] 4744 // and the initializer list has a single element that is an 4745 // appropriately-typed string literal (8.5.2 [dcl.init.string]), the 4746 // implicit conversion sequence is the identity conversion. 4747 if (From->getNumInits() == 1) { 4748 if (ToType->isRecordType()) { 4749 QualType InitType = From->getInit(0)->getType(); 4750 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(InitType, ToType) || 4751 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getLocStart(), InitType, ToType)) 4752 return TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType, 4753 SuppressUserConversions, 4754 InOverloadResolution, 4755 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 4756 } 4757 // FIXME: Check the other conditions here: array of character type, 4758 // initializer is a string literal. 4759 if (ToType->isArrayType()) { 4760 InitializedEntity Entity = 4761 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType, 4762 /*Consumed=*/false); 4763 if (S.CanPerformCopyInitialization(Entity, From)) { 4764 Result.setStandard(); 4765 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 4766 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType); 4767 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 4768 return Result; 4769 } 4770 } 4771 } 4772 4773 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p2: Otherwise, if the parameter type [...] (below). 4774 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p2: 4775 // If the parameter type is std::initializer_list<X> or "array of X" and 4776 // all the elements can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit 4777 // conversion sequence is the worst conversion necessary to convert an 4778 // element of the list to X. 4779 // 4780 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p3: 4781 // Otherwise, if the parameter type is "array of N X", if the initializer 4782 // list has exactly N elements or if it has fewer than N elements and X is 4783 // default-constructible, and if all the elements of the initializer list 4784 // can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit conversion sequence is 4785 // the worst conversion necessary to convert an element of the list to X. 4786 // 4787 // FIXME: We're missing a lot of these checks. 4788 bool toStdInitializerList = false; 4789 QualType X; 4790 if (ToType->isArrayType()) 4791 X = S.Context.getAsArrayType(ToType)->getElementType(); 4792 else 4793 toStdInitializerList = S.isStdInitializerList(ToType, &X); 4794 if (!X.isNull()) { 4795 for (unsigned i = 0, e = From->getNumInits(); i < e; ++i) { 4796 Expr *Init = From->getInit(i); 4797 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 4798 TryCopyInitialization(S, Init, X, SuppressUserConversions, 4799 InOverloadResolution, 4800 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 4801 // If a single element isn't convertible, fail. 4802 if (ICS.isBad()) { 4803 Result = ICS; 4804 break; 4805 } 4806 // Otherwise, look for the worst conversion. 4807 if (Result.isBad() || 4808 CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, From->getLocStart(), ICS, 4809 Result) == 4810 ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse) 4811 Result = ICS; 4812 } 4813 4814 // For an empty list, we won't have computed any conversion sequence. 4815 // Introduce the identity conversion sequence. 4816 if (From->getNumInits() == 0) { 4817 Result.setStandard(); 4818 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 4819 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType); 4820 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 4821 } 4822 4823 Result.setStdInitializerListElement(toStdInitializerList); 4824 return Result; 4825 } 4826 4827 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p4: 4828 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p3: 4829 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a non-aggregate class X and overload 4830 // resolution chooses a single best constructor [...] the implicit 4831 // conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. If multiple 4832 // constructors are viable but none is better than the others, the 4833 // implicit conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. 4834 if (ToType->isRecordType() && !ToType->isAggregateType()) { 4835 // This function can deal with initializer lists. 4836 return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions, 4837 /*AllowExplicit=*/false, 4838 InOverloadResolution, /*CStyle=*/false, 4839 AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 4840 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 4841 } 4842 4843 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p5: 4844 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p4: 4845 // Otherwise, if the parameter has an aggregate type which can be 4846 // initialized from the initializer list [...] the implicit conversion 4847 // sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. 4848 if (ToType->isAggregateType()) { 4849 // Type is an aggregate, argument is an init list. At this point it comes 4850 // down to checking whether the initialization works. 4851 // FIXME: Find out whether this parameter is consumed or not. 4852 // FIXME: Expose SemaInit's aggregate initialization code so that we don't 4853 // need to call into the initialization code here; overload resolution 4854 // should not be doing that. 4855 InitializedEntity Entity = 4856 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType, 4857 /*Consumed=*/false); 4858 if (S.CanPerformCopyInitialization(Entity, From)) { 4859 Result.setUserDefined(); 4860 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAsIdentityConversion(); 4861 // Initializer lists don't have a type. 4862 Result.UserDefined.Before.setFromType(QualType()); 4863 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAllToTypes(QualType()); 4864 4865 Result.UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion(); 4866 Result.UserDefined.After.setFromType(ToType); 4867 Result.UserDefined.After.setAllToTypes(ToType); 4868 Result.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = nullptr; 4869 } 4870 return Result; 4871 } 4872 4873 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p6: 4874 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p5: 4875 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a reference, see 13.3.3.1.4. 4876 if (ToType->isReferenceType()) { 4877 // The standard is notoriously unclear here, since 13.3.3.1.4 doesn't 4878 // mention initializer lists in any way. So we go by what list- 4879 // initialization would do and try to extrapolate from that. 4880 4881 QualType T1 = ToType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType(); 4882 4883 // If the initializer list has a single element that is reference-related 4884 // to the parameter type, we initialize the reference from that. 4885 if (From->getNumInits() == 1) { 4886 Expr *Init = From->getInit(0); 4887 4888 QualType T2 = Init->getType(); 4889 4890 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try 4891 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the 4892 // type of the resulting function. 4893 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 4894 DeclAccessPair Found; 4895 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction( 4896 Init, ToType, false, Found)) 4897 T2 = Fn->getType(); 4898 } 4899 4900 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer. 4901 bool dummy1 = false; 4902 bool dummy2 = false; 4903 bool dummy3 = false; 4904 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship 4905 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(From->getLocStart(), T1, T2, dummy1, 4906 dummy2, dummy3); 4907 4908 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related) { 4909 return TryReferenceInit(S, Init, ToType, /*FIXME*/From->getLocStart(), 4910 SuppressUserConversions, 4911 /*AllowExplicit=*/false); 4912 } 4913 } 4914 4915 // Otherwise, we bind the reference to a temporary created from the 4916 // initializer list. 4917 Result = TryListConversion(S, From, T1, SuppressUserConversions, 4918 InOverloadResolution, 4919 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 4920 if (Result.isFailure()) 4921 return Result; 4922 assert(!Result.isEllipsis() && 4923 "Sub-initialization cannot result in ellipsis conversion."); 4924 4925 // Can we even bind to a temporary? 4926 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() || 4927 (T1.isConstQualified() && !T1.isVolatileQualified())) { 4928 StandardConversionSequence &SCS = Result.isStandard() ? Result.Standard : 4929 Result.UserDefined.After; 4930 SCS.ReferenceBinding = true; 4931 SCS.IsLvalueReference = ToType->isLValueReferenceType(); 4932 SCS.BindsToRvalue = true; 4933 SCS.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 4934 SCS.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false; 4935 SCS.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false; 4936 } else 4937 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, 4938 From, ToType); 4939 return Result; 4940 } 4941 4942 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p7: 4943 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p6: 4944 // Otherwise, if the parameter type is not a class: 4945 if (!ToType->isRecordType()) { 4946 // - if the initializer list has one element that is not itself an 4947 // initializer list, the implicit conversion sequence is the one 4948 // required to convert the element to the parameter type. 4949 unsigned NumInits = From->getNumInits(); 4950 if (NumInits == 1 && !isa<InitListExpr>(From->getInit(0))) 4951 Result = TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType, 4952 SuppressUserConversions, 4953 InOverloadResolution, 4954 AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 4955 // - if the initializer list has no elements, the implicit conversion 4956 // sequence is the identity conversion. 4957 else if (NumInits == 0) { 4958 Result.setStandard(); 4959 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 4960 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType); 4961 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType); 4962 } 4963 return Result; 4964 } 4965 4966 // C++14 [over.ics.list]p8: 4967 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p7: 4968 // In all cases other than those enumerated above, no conversion is possible 4969 return Result; 4970 } 4971 4972 /// TryCopyInitialization - Try to copy-initialize a value of type 4973 /// ToType from the expression From. Return the implicit conversion 4974 /// sequence required to pass this argument, which may be a bad 4975 /// conversion sequence (meaning that the argument cannot be passed to 4976 /// a parameter of this type). If @p SuppressUserConversions, then we 4977 /// do not permit any user-defined conversion sequences. 4978 static ImplicitConversionSequence 4979 TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 4980 bool SuppressUserConversions, 4981 bool InOverloadResolution, 4982 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 4983 bool AllowExplicit) { 4984 if (InitListExpr *FromInitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From)) 4985 return TryListConversion(S, FromInitList, ToType, SuppressUserConversions, 4986 InOverloadResolution,AllowObjCWritebackConversion); 4987 4988 if (ToType->isReferenceType()) 4989 return TryReferenceInit(S, From, ToType, 4990 /*FIXME:*/From->getLocStart(), 4991 SuppressUserConversions, 4992 AllowExplicit); 4993 4994 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, ToType, 4995 SuppressUserConversions, 4996 /*AllowExplicit=*/false, 4997 InOverloadResolution, 4998 /*CStyle=*/false, 4999 AllowObjCWritebackConversion, 5000 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 5001 } 5002 5003 static bool TryCopyInitialization(const CanQualType FromQTy, 5004 const CanQualType ToQTy, 5005 Sema &S, 5006 SourceLocation Loc, 5007 ExprValueKind FromVK) { 5008 OpaqueValueExpr TmpExpr(Loc, FromQTy, FromVK); 5009 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 5010 TryCopyInitialization(S, &TmpExpr, ToQTy, true, true, false); 5011 5012 return !ICS.isBad(); 5013 } 5014 5015 /// TryObjectArgumentInitialization - Try to initialize the object 5016 /// parameter of the given member function (@c Method) from the 5017 /// expression @p From. 5018 static ImplicitConversionSequence 5019 TryObjectArgumentInitialization(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType FromType, 5020 Expr::Classification FromClassification, 5021 CXXMethodDecl *Method, 5022 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext) { 5023 QualType ClassType = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(ActingContext); 5024 // [class.dtor]p2: A destructor can be invoked for a const, volatile or 5025 // const volatile object. 5026 unsigned Quals = isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(Method) ? 5027 Qualifiers::Const | Qualifiers::Volatile : Method->getTypeQualifiers(); 5028 QualType ImplicitParamType = S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(ClassType, Quals); 5029 5030 // Set up the conversion sequence as a "bad" conversion, to allow us 5031 // to exit early. 5032 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS; 5033 5034 // We need to have an object of class type. 5035 if (const PointerType *PT = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 5036 FromType = PT->getPointeeType(); 5037 5038 // When we had a pointer, it's implicitly dereferenced, so we 5039 // better have an lvalue. 5040 assert(FromClassification.isLValue()); 5041 } 5042 5043 assert(FromType->isRecordType()); 5044 5045 // C++0x [over.match.funcs]p4: 5046 // For non-static member functions, the type of the implicit object 5047 // parameter is 5048 // 5049 // - "lvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared without a 5050 // ref-qualifier or with the & ref-qualifier 5051 // - "rvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared with the && 5052 // ref-qualifier 5053 // 5054 // where X is the class of which the function is a member and cv is the 5055 // cv-qualification on the member function declaration. 5056 // 5057 // However, when finding an implicit conversion sequence for the argument, we 5058 // are not allowed to perform user-defined conversions 5059 // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5). We perform a simplified version of 5060 // reference binding here, that allows class rvalues to bind to 5061 // non-constant references. 5062 5063 // First check the qualifiers. 5064 QualType FromTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType); 5065 if (ImplicitParamType.getCVRQualifiers() 5066 != FromTypeCanon.getLocalCVRQualifiers() && 5067 !ImplicitParamType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTypeCanon)) { 5068 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers, 5069 FromType, ImplicitParamType); 5070 return ICS; 5071 } 5072 5073 // Check that we have either the same type or a derived type. It 5074 // affects the conversion rank. 5075 QualType ClassTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType); 5076 ImplicitConversionKind SecondKind; 5077 if (ClassTypeCanon == FromTypeCanon.getLocalUnqualifiedType()) { 5078 SecondKind = ICK_Identity; 5079 } else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromType, ClassType)) 5080 SecondKind = ICK_Derived_To_Base; 5081 else { 5082 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class, 5083 FromType, ImplicitParamType); 5084 return ICS; 5085 } 5086 5087 // Check the ref-qualifier. 5088 switch (Method->getRefQualifier()) { 5089 case RQ_None: 5090 // Do nothing; we don't care about lvalueness or rvalueness. 5091 break; 5092 5093 case RQ_LValue: 5094 if (!FromClassification.isLValue() && Quals != Qualifiers::Const) { 5095 // non-const lvalue reference cannot bind to an rvalue 5096 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, FromType, 5097 ImplicitParamType); 5098 return ICS; 5099 } 5100 break; 5101 5102 case RQ_RValue: 5103 if (!FromClassification.isRValue()) { 5104 // rvalue reference cannot bind to an lvalue 5105 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue, FromType, 5106 ImplicitParamType); 5107 return ICS; 5108 } 5109 break; 5110 } 5111 5112 // Success. Mark this as a reference binding. 5113 ICS.setStandard(); 5114 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion(); 5115 ICS.Standard.Second = SecondKind; 5116 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType); 5117 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ImplicitParamType); 5118 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true; 5119 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true; 5120 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = Method->getRefQualifier() != RQ_RValue; 5121 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false; 5122 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = FromClassification.isRValue(); 5123 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier 5124 = (Method->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None); 5125 return ICS; 5126 } 5127 5128 /// PerformObjectArgumentInitialization - Perform initialization of 5129 /// the implicit object parameter for the given Method with the given 5130 /// expression. 5131 ExprResult 5132 Sema::PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Expr *From, 5133 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier, 5134 NamedDecl *FoundDecl, 5135 CXXMethodDecl *Method) { 5136 QualType FromRecordType, DestType; 5137 QualType ImplicitParamRecordType = 5138 Method->getThisType(Context)->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 5139 5140 Expr::Classification FromClassification; 5141 if (const PointerType *PT = From->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) { 5142 FromRecordType = PT->getPointeeType(); 5143 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context); 5144 FromClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(); 5145 } else { 5146 FromRecordType = From->getType(); 5147 DestType = ImplicitParamRecordType; 5148 FromClassification = From->Classify(Context); 5149 } 5150 5151 // Note that we always use the true parent context when performing 5152 // the actual argument initialization. 5153 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryObjectArgumentInitialization( 5154 *this, From->getLocStart(), From->getType(), FromClassification, Method, 5155 Method->getParent()); 5156 if (ICS.isBad()) { 5157 switch (ICS.Bad.Kind) { 5158 case BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers: { 5159 Qualifiers FromQs = FromRecordType.getQualifiers(); 5160 Qualifiers ToQs = DestType.getQualifiers(); 5161 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers(); 5162 if (CVR) { 5163 Diag(From->getLocStart(), 5164 diag::err_member_function_call_bad_cvr) 5165 << Method->getDeclName() << FromRecordType << (CVR - 1) 5166 << From->getSourceRange(); 5167 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 5168 << Method->getDeclName(); 5169 return ExprError(); 5170 } 5171 break; 5172 } 5173 5174 case BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue: 5175 case BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue: { 5176 bool IsRValueQualified = 5177 Method->getRefQualifier() == RefQualifierKind::RQ_RValue; 5178 Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_member_function_call_bad_ref) 5179 << Method->getDeclName() << FromClassification.isRValue() 5180 << IsRValueQualified; 5181 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 5182 << Method->getDeclName(); 5183 return ExprError(); 5184 } 5185 5186 case BadConversionSequence::no_conversion: 5187 case BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class: 5188 break; 5189 } 5190 5191 return Diag(From->getLocStart(), 5192 diag::err_member_function_call_bad_type) 5193 << ImplicitParamRecordType << FromRecordType << From->getSourceRange(); 5194 } 5195 5196 if (ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) { 5197 ExprResult FromRes = 5198 PerformObjectMemberConversion(From, Qualifier, FoundDecl, Method); 5199 if (FromRes.isInvalid()) 5200 return ExprError(); 5201 From = FromRes.get(); 5202 } 5203 5204 if (!Context.hasSameType(From->getType(), DestType)) 5205 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_NoOp, 5206 From->getValueKind()).get(); 5207 return From; 5208 } 5209 5210 /// TryContextuallyConvertToBool - Attempt to contextually convert the 5211 /// expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3). 5212 static ImplicitConversionSequence 5213 TryContextuallyConvertToBool(Sema &S, Expr *From) { 5214 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, S.Context.BoolTy, 5215 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 5216 /*AllowExplicit=*/true, 5217 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 5218 /*CStyle=*/false, 5219 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false, 5220 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 5221 } 5222 5223 /// PerformContextuallyConvertToBool - Perform a contextual conversion 5224 /// of the expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3). 5225 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *From) { 5226 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From)) 5227 return ExprError(); 5228 5229 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, From); 5230 if (!ICS.isBad()) 5231 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Context.BoolTy, ICS, AA_Converting); 5232 5233 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, Context.BoolTy)) 5234 return Diag(From->getLocStart(), 5235 diag::err_typecheck_bool_condition) 5236 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange(); 5237 return ExprError(); 5238 } 5239 5240 /// Check that the specified conversion is permitted in a converted constant 5241 /// expression, according to C++11 [expr.const]p3. Return true if the conversion 5242 /// is acceptable. 5243 static bool CheckConvertedConstantConversions(Sema &S, 5244 StandardConversionSequence &SCS) { 5245 // Since we know that the target type is an integral or unscoped enumeration 5246 // type, most conversion kinds are impossible. All possible First and Third 5247 // conversions are fine. 5248 switch (SCS.Second) { 5249 case ICK_Identity: 5250 case ICK_Function_Conversion: 5251 case ICK_Integral_Promotion: 5252 case ICK_Integral_Conversion: // Narrowing conversions are checked elsewhere. 5253 case ICK_Zero_Queue_Conversion: 5254 return true; 5255 5256 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion: 5257 // Conversion from an integral or unscoped enumeration type to bool is 5258 // classified as ICK_Boolean_Conversion, but it's also arguably an integral 5259 // conversion, so we allow it in a converted constant expression. 5260 // 5261 // FIXME: Per core issue 1407, we should not allow this, but that breaks 5262 // a lot of popular code. We should at least add a warning for this 5263 // (non-conforming) extension. 5264 return SCS.getFromType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() && 5265 SCS.getToType(2)->isBooleanType(); 5266 5267 case ICK_Pointer_Conversion: 5268 case ICK_Pointer_Member: 5269 // C++1z: null pointer conversions and null member pointer conversions are 5270 // only permitted if the source type is std::nullptr_t. 5271 return SCS.getFromType()->isNullPtrType(); 5272 5273 case ICK_Floating_Promotion: 5274 case ICK_Complex_Promotion: 5275 case ICK_Floating_Conversion: 5276 case ICK_Complex_Conversion: 5277 case ICK_Floating_Integral: 5278 case ICK_Compatible_Conversion: 5279 case ICK_Derived_To_Base: 5280 case ICK_Vector_Conversion: 5281 case ICK_Vector_Splat: 5282 case ICK_Complex_Real: 5283 case ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion: 5284 case ICK_TransparentUnionConversion: 5285 case ICK_Writeback_Conversion: 5286 case ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion: 5287 case ICK_C_Only_Conversion: 5288 case ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion: 5289 return false; 5290 5291 case ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue: 5292 case ICK_Array_To_Pointer: 5293 case ICK_Function_To_Pointer: 5294 llvm_unreachable("found a first conversion kind in Second"); 5295 5296 case ICK_Qualification: 5297 llvm_unreachable("found a third conversion kind in Second"); 5298 5299 case ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds: 5300 break; 5301 } 5302 5303 llvm_unreachable("unknown conversion kind"); 5304 } 5305 5306 /// CheckConvertedConstantExpression - Check that the expression From is a 5307 /// converted constant expression of type T, perform the conversion and produce 5308 /// the converted expression, per C++11 [expr.const]p3. 5309 static ExprResult CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Sema &S, Expr *From, 5310 QualType T, APValue &Value, 5311 Sema::CCEKind CCE, 5312 bool RequireInt) { 5313 assert(S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && 5314 "converted constant expression outside C++11"); 5315 5316 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, From)) 5317 return ExprError(); 5318 5319 // C++1z [expr.const]p3: 5320 // A converted constant expression of type T is an expression, 5321 // implicitly converted to type T, where the converted 5322 // expression is a constant expression and the implicit conversion 5323 // sequence contains only [... list of conversions ...]. 5324 // C++1z [stmt.if]p2: 5325 // If the if statement is of the form if constexpr, the value of the 5326 // condition shall be a contextually converted constant expression of type 5327 // bool. 5328 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 5329 CCE == Sema::CCEK_ConstexprIf 5330 ? TryContextuallyConvertToBool(S, From) 5331 : TryCopyInitialization(S, From, T, 5332 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 5333 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 5334 /*AllowObjcWritebackConversion=*/false, 5335 /*AllowExplicit=*/false); 5336 StandardConversionSequence *SCS = nullptr; 5337 switch (ICS.getKind()) { 5338 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion: 5339 SCS = &ICS.Standard; 5340 break; 5341 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion: 5342 // We are converting to a non-class type, so the Before sequence 5343 // must be trivial. 5344 SCS = &ICS.UserDefined.After; 5345 break; 5346 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion: 5347 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion: 5348 if (!S.DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, T)) 5349 return S.Diag(From->getLocStart(), 5350 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression) 5351 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T; 5352 return ExprError(); 5353 5354 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion: 5355 llvm_unreachable("ellipsis conversion in converted constant expression"); 5356 } 5357 5358 // Check that we would only use permitted conversions. 5359 if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(S, *SCS)) { 5360 return S.Diag(From->getLocStart(), 5361 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed) 5362 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T; 5363 } 5364 // [...] and where the reference binding (if any) binds directly. 5365 if (SCS->ReferenceBinding && !SCS->DirectBinding) { 5366 return S.Diag(From->getLocStart(), 5367 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_indirect) 5368 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T; 5369 } 5370 5371 ExprResult Result = 5372 S.PerformImplicitConversion(From, T, ICS, Sema::AA_Converting); 5373 if (Result.isInvalid()) 5374 return Result; 5375 5376 // Check for a narrowing implicit conversion. 5377 APValue PreNarrowingValue; 5378 QualType PreNarrowingType; 5379 switch (SCS->getNarrowingKind(S.Context, Result.get(), PreNarrowingValue, 5380 PreNarrowingType)) { 5381 case NK_Dependent_Narrowing: 5382 // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, but the expression is 5383 // value-dependent so we can't tell whether it's actually narrowing. 5384 case NK_Variable_Narrowing: 5385 // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, and the value is not a constant 5386 // expression. We'll diagnose this in a moment. 5387 case NK_Not_Narrowing: 5388 break; 5389 5390 case NK_Constant_Narrowing: 5391 S.Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::ext_cce_narrowing) 5392 << CCE << /*Constant*/1 5393 << PreNarrowingValue.getAsString(S.Context, PreNarrowingType) << T; 5394 break; 5395 5396 case NK_Type_Narrowing: 5397 S.Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::ext_cce_narrowing) 5398 << CCE << /*Constant*/0 << From->getType() << T; 5399 break; 5400 } 5401 5402 if (Result.get()->isValueDependent()) { 5403 Value = APValue(); 5404 return Result; 5405 } 5406 5407 // Check the expression is a constant expression. 5408 SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes; 5409 Expr::EvalResult Eval; 5410 Eval.Diag = &Notes; 5411 Expr::ConstExprUsage Usage = CCE == Sema::CCEK_TemplateArg 5412 ? Expr::EvaluateForMangling 5413 : Expr::EvaluateForCodeGen; 5414 5415 if (!Result.get()->EvaluateAsConstantExpr(Eval, Usage, S.Context) || 5416 (RequireInt && !Eval.Val.isInt())) { 5417 // The expression can't be folded, so we can't keep it at this position in 5418 // the AST. 5419 Result = ExprError(); 5420 } else { 5421 Value = Eval.Val; 5422 5423 if (Notes.empty()) { 5424 // It's a constant expression. 5425 return Result; 5426 } 5427 } 5428 5429 // It's not a constant expression. Produce an appropriate diagnostic. 5430 if (Notes.size() == 1 && 5431 Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr) 5432 S.Diag(Notes[0].first, diag::err_expr_not_cce) << CCE; 5433 else { 5434 S.Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_expr_not_cce) 5435 << CCE << From->getSourceRange(); 5436 for (unsigned I = 0; I < Notes.size(); ++I) 5437 S.Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second); 5438 } 5439 return ExprError(); 5440 } 5441 5442 ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T, 5443 APValue &Value, CCEKind CCE) { 5444 return ::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(*this, From, T, Value, CCE, false); 5445 } 5446 5447 ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T, 5448 llvm::APSInt &Value, 5449 CCEKind CCE) { 5450 assert(T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && "unexpected converted const type"); 5451 5452 APValue V; 5453 auto R = ::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(*this, From, T, V, CCE, true); 5454 if (!R.isInvalid() && !R.get()->isValueDependent()) 5455 Value = V.getInt(); 5456 return R; 5457 } 5458 5459 5460 /// dropPointerConversions - If the given standard conversion sequence 5461 /// involves any pointer conversions, remove them. This may change 5462 /// the result type of the conversion sequence. 5463 static void dropPointerConversion(StandardConversionSequence &SCS) { 5464 if (SCS.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) { 5465 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity; 5466 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity; 5467 SCS.ToTypePtrs[2] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[1] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[0]; 5468 } 5469 } 5470 5471 /// TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Attempt to contextually 5472 /// convert the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type. 5473 static ImplicitConversionSequence 5474 TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Sema &S, Expr *From) { 5475 // Do an implicit conversion to 'id'. 5476 QualType Ty = S.Context.getObjCIdType(); 5477 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS 5478 = TryImplicitConversion(S, From, Ty, 5479 // FIXME: Are these flags correct? 5480 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 5481 /*AllowExplicit=*/true, 5482 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 5483 /*CStyle=*/false, 5484 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false, 5485 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/true); 5486 5487 // Strip off any final conversions to 'id'. 5488 switch (ICS.getKind()) { 5489 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion: 5490 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion: 5491 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion: 5492 break; 5493 5494 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion: 5495 dropPointerConversion(ICS.UserDefined.After); 5496 break; 5497 5498 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion: 5499 dropPointerConversion(ICS.Standard); 5500 break; 5501 } 5502 5503 return ICS; 5504 } 5505 5506 /// PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Perform a contextual 5507 /// conversion of the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type. 5508 /// Returns a valid but null ExprResult if no conversion sequence exists. 5509 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Expr *From) { 5510 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From)) 5511 return ExprError(); 5512 5513 QualType Ty = Context.getObjCIdType(); 5514 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 5515 TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(*this, From); 5516 if (!ICS.isBad()) 5517 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Ty, ICS, AA_Converting); 5518 return ExprResult(); 5519 } 5520 5521 /// Determine whether the provided type is an integral type, or an enumeration 5522 /// type of a permitted flavor. 5523 bool Sema::ICEConvertDiagnoser::match(QualType T) { 5524 return AllowScopedEnumerations ? T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() 5525 : T->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType(); 5526 } 5527 5528 static ExprResult 5529 diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From, 5530 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, 5531 QualType T, UnresolvedSetImpl &ViableConversions) { 5532 5533 if (Converter.Suppress) 5534 return ExprError(); 5535 5536 Converter.diagnoseAmbiguous(SemaRef, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange(); 5537 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) { 5538 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = 5539 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ViableConversions[I]->getUnderlyingDecl()); 5540 QualType ConvTy = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 5541 Converter.noteAmbiguous(SemaRef, Conv, ConvTy); 5542 } 5543 return From; 5544 } 5545 5546 static bool 5547 diagnoseNoViableConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&From, 5548 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, 5549 QualType T, bool HadMultipleCandidates, 5550 UnresolvedSetImpl &ExplicitConversions) { 5551 if (ExplicitConversions.size() == 1 && !Converter.Suppress) { 5552 DeclAccessPair Found = ExplicitConversions[0]; 5553 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion = 5554 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl()); 5555 5556 // The user probably meant to invoke the given explicit 5557 // conversion; use it. 5558 QualType ConvTy = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 5559 std::string TypeStr; 5560 ConvTy.getAsStringInternal(TypeStr, SemaRef.getPrintingPolicy()); 5561 5562 Converter.diagnoseExplicitConv(SemaRef, Loc, T, ConvTy) 5563 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(From->getLocStart(), 5564 "static_cast<" + TypeStr + ">(") 5565 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion( 5566 SemaRef.getLocForEndOfToken(From->getLocEnd()), ")"); 5567 Converter.noteExplicitConv(SemaRef, Conversion, ConvTy); 5568 5569 // If we aren't in a SFINAE context, build a call to the 5570 // explicit conversion function. 5571 if (SemaRef.isSFINAEContext()) 5572 return true; 5573 5574 SemaRef.CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, nullptr, Found); 5575 ExprResult Result = SemaRef.BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion, 5576 HadMultipleCandidates); 5577 if (Result.isInvalid()) 5578 return true; 5579 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast. 5580 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(SemaRef.Context, Result.get()->getType(), 5581 CK_UserDefinedConversion, Result.get(), 5582 nullptr, Result.get()->getValueKind()); 5583 } 5584 return false; 5585 } 5586 5587 static bool recordConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&From, 5588 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, 5589 QualType T, bool HadMultipleCandidates, 5590 DeclAccessPair &Found) { 5591 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion = 5592 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl()); 5593 SemaRef.CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, nullptr, Found); 5594 5595 QualType ToType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 5596 if (!Converter.SuppressConversion) { 5597 if (SemaRef.isSFINAEContext()) 5598 return true; 5599 5600 Converter.diagnoseConversion(SemaRef, Loc, T, ToType) 5601 << From->getSourceRange(); 5602 } 5603 5604 ExprResult Result = SemaRef.BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion, 5605 HadMultipleCandidates); 5606 if (Result.isInvalid()) 5607 return true; 5608 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast. 5609 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(SemaRef.Context, Result.get()->getType(), 5610 CK_UserDefinedConversion, Result.get(), 5611 nullptr, Result.get()->getValueKind()); 5612 return false; 5613 } 5614 5615 static ExprResult finishContextualImplicitConversion( 5616 Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From, 5617 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter) { 5618 if (!Converter.match(From->getType()) && !Converter.Suppress) 5619 Converter.diagnoseNoMatch(SemaRef, Loc, From->getType()) 5620 << From->getSourceRange(); 5621 5622 return SemaRef.DefaultLvalueConversion(From); 5623 } 5624 5625 static void 5626 collectViableConversionCandidates(Sema &SemaRef, Expr *From, QualType ToType, 5627 UnresolvedSetImpl &ViableConversions, 5628 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) { 5629 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) { 5630 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = ViableConversions[I]; 5631 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl(); 5632 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()); 5633 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 5634 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 5635 5636 CXXConversionDecl *Conv; 5637 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate; 5638 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))) 5639 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()); 5640 else 5641 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 5642 5643 if (ConvTemplate) 5644 SemaRef.AddTemplateConversionCandidate( 5645 ConvTemplate, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, ToType, CandidateSet, 5646 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 5647 else 5648 SemaRef.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, 5649 ToType, CandidateSet, 5650 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false); 5651 } 5652 } 5653 5654 /// Attempt to convert the given expression to a type which is accepted 5655 /// by the given converter. 5656 /// 5657 /// This routine will attempt to convert an expression of class type to a 5658 /// type accepted by the specified converter. In C++11 and before, the class 5659 /// must have a single non-explicit conversion function converting to a matching 5660 /// type. In C++1y, there can be multiple such conversion functions, but only 5661 /// one target type. 5662 /// 5663 /// \param Loc The source location of the construct that requires the 5664 /// conversion. 5665 /// 5666 /// \param From The expression we're converting from. 5667 /// 5668 /// \param Converter Used to control and diagnose the conversion process. 5669 /// 5670 /// \returns The expression, converted to an integral or enumeration type if 5671 /// successful. 5672 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextualImplicitConversion( 5673 SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From, ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter) { 5674 // We can't perform any more checking for type-dependent expressions. 5675 if (From->isTypeDependent()) 5676 return From; 5677 5678 // Process placeholders immediately. 5679 if (From->hasPlaceholderType()) { 5680 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(From); 5681 if (result.isInvalid()) 5682 return result; 5683 From = result.get(); 5684 } 5685 5686 // If the expression already has a matching type, we're golden. 5687 QualType T = From->getType(); 5688 if (Converter.match(T)) 5689 return DefaultLvalueConversion(From); 5690 5691 // FIXME: Check for missing '()' if T is a function type? 5692 5693 // We can only perform contextual implicit conversions on objects of class 5694 // type. 5695 const RecordType *RecordTy = T->getAs<RecordType>(); 5696 if (!RecordTy || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 5697 if (!Converter.Suppress) 5698 Converter.diagnoseNoMatch(*this, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange(); 5699 return From; 5700 } 5701 5702 // We must have a complete class type. 5703 struct TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag : TypeDiagnoser { 5704 ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter; 5705 Expr *From; 5706 5707 TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag(ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, Expr *From) 5708 : Converter(Converter), From(From) {} 5709 5710 void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override { 5711 Converter.diagnoseIncomplete(S, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange(); 5712 } 5713 } IncompleteDiagnoser(Converter, From); 5714 5715 if (Converter.Suppress ? !isCompleteType(Loc, T) 5716 : RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, IncompleteDiagnoser)) 5717 return From; 5718 5719 // Look for a conversion to an integral or enumeration type. 5720 UnresolvedSet<4> 5721 ViableConversions; // These are *potentially* viable in C++1y. 5722 UnresolvedSet<4> ExplicitConversions; 5723 const auto &Conversions = 5724 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordTy->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 5725 5726 bool HadMultipleCandidates = 5727 (std::distance(Conversions.begin(), Conversions.end()) > 1); 5728 5729 // To check that there is only one target type, in C++1y: 5730 QualType ToType; 5731 bool HasUniqueTargetType = true; 5732 5733 // Collect explicit or viable (potentially in C++1y) conversions. 5734 for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) { 5735 NamedDecl *D = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl(); 5736 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion; 5737 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D); 5738 if (ConvTemplate) { 5739 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) 5740 Conversion = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()); 5741 else 5742 continue; // C++11 does not consider conversion operator templates(?). 5743 } else 5744 Conversion = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 5745 5746 assert((!ConvTemplate || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) && 5747 "Conversion operator templates are considered potentially " 5748 "viable in C++1y"); 5749 5750 QualType CurToType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 5751 if (Converter.match(CurToType) || ConvTemplate) { 5752 5753 if (Conversion->isExplicit()) { 5754 // FIXME: For C++1y, do we need this restriction? 5755 // cf. diagnoseNoViableConversion() 5756 if (!ConvTemplate) 5757 ExplicitConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess()); 5758 } else { 5759 if (!ConvTemplate && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) { 5760 if (ToType.isNull()) 5761 ToType = CurToType.getUnqualifiedType(); 5762 else if (HasUniqueTargetType && 5763 (CurToType.getUnqualifiedType() != ToType)) 5764 HasUniqueTargetType = false; 5765 } 5766 ViableConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess()); 5767 } 5768 } 5769 } 5770 5771 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) { 5772 // C++1y [conv]p6: 5773 // ... An expression e of class type E appearing in such a context 5774 // is said to be contextually implicitly converted to a specified 5775 // type T and is well-formed if and only if e can be implicitly 5776 // converted to a type T that is determined as follows: E is searched 5777 // for conversion functions whose return type is cv T or reference to 5778 // cv T such that T is allowed by the context. There shall be 5779 // exactly one such T. 5780 5781 // If no unique T is found: 5782 if (ToType.isNull()) { 5783 if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 5784 HadMultipleCandidates, 5785 ExplicitConversions)) 5786 return ExprError(); 5787 return finishContextualImplicitConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter); 5788 } 5789 5790 // If more than one unique Ts are found: 5791 if (!HasUniqueTargetType) 5792 return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 5793 ViableConversions); 5794 5795 // If one unique T is found: 5796 // First, build a candidate set from the previously recorded 5797 // potentially viable conversions. 5798 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 5799 collectViableConversionCandidates(*this, From, ToType, ViableConversions, 5800 CandidateSet); 5801 5802 // Then, perform overload resolution over the candidate set. 5803 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 5804 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Loc, Best)) { 5805 case OR_Success: { 5806 // Apply this conversion. 5807 DeclAccessPair Found = 5808 DeclAccessPair::make(Best->Function, Best->FoundDecl.getAccess()); 5809 if (recordConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 5810 HadMultipleCandidates, Found)) 5811 return ExprError(); 5812 break; 5813 } 5814 case OR_Ambiguous: 5815 return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 5816 ViableConversions); 5817 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 5818 if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 5819 HadMultipleCandidates, 5820 ExplicitConversions)) 5821 return ExprError(); 5822 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 5823 case OR_Deleted: 5824 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type. 5825 break; 5826 } 5827 } else { 5828 switch (ViableConversions.size()) { 5829 case 0: { 5830 if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 5831 HadMultipleCandidates, 5832 ExplicitConversions)) 5833 return ExprError(); 5834 5835 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type. 5836 break; 5837 } 5838 case 1: { 5839 // Apply this conversion. 5840 DeclAccessPair Found = ViableConversions[0]; 5841 if (recordConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 5842 HadMultipleCandidates, Found)) 5843 return ExprError(); 5844 break; 5845 } 5846 default: 5847 return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T, 5848 ViableConversions); 5849 } 5850 } 5851 5852 return finishContextualImplicitConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter); 5853 } 5854 5855 /// IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate - Determine whether Fn is 5856 /// an acceptable non-member overloaded operator for a call whose 5857 /// arguments have types T1 (and, if non-empty, T2). This routine 5858 /// implements the check in C++ [over.match.oper]p3b2 concerning 5859 /// enumeration types. 5860 static bool IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate(ASTContext &Context, 5861 FunctionDecl *Fn, 5862 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) { 5863 QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType(); 5864 QualType T2 = Args.size() > 1 ? Args[1]->getType() : QualType(); 5865 5866 if (T1->isDependentType() || (!T2.isNull() && T2->isDependentType())) 5867 return true; 5868 5869 if (T1->isRecordType() || (!T2.isNull() && T2->isRecordType())) 5870 return true; 5871 5872 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 5873 if (Proto->getNumParams() < 1) 5874 return false; 5875 5876 if (T1->isEnumeralType()) { 5877 QualType ArgType = Proto->getParamType(0).getNonReferenceType(); 5878 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, ArgType)) 5879 return true; 5880 } 5881 5882 if (Proto->getNumParams() < 2) 5883 return false; 5884 5885 if (!T2.isNull() && T2->isEnumeralType()) { 5886 QualType ArgType = Proto->getParamType(1).getNonReferenceType(); 5887 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T2, ArgType)) 5888 return true; 5889 } 5890 5891 return false; 5892 } 5893 5894 /// AddOverloadCandidate - Adds the given function to the set of 5895 /// candidate functions, using the given function call arguments. If 5896 /// @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't allow user-defined 5897 /// conversions via constructors or conversion operators. 5898 /// 5899 /// \param PartialOverloading true if we are performing "partial" overloading 5900 /// based on an incomplete set of function arguments. This feature is used by 5901 /// code completion. 5902 void 5903 Sema::AddOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Function, 5904 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 5905 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 5906 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 5907 bool SuppressUserConversions, 5908 bool PartialOverloading, 5909 bool AllowExplicit, 5910 ConversionSequenceList EarlyConversions) { 5911 const FunctionProtoType *Proto 5912 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()); 5913 assert(Proto && "Functions without a prototype cannot be overloaded"); 5914 assert(!Function->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() && 5915 "Use AddTemplateOverloadCandidate for function templates"); 5916 5917 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) { 5918 if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method)) { 5919 // If we get here, it's because we're calling a member function 5920 // that is named without a member access expression (e.g., 5921 // "this->f") that was either written explicitly or created 5922 // implicitly. This can happen with a qualified call to a member 5923 // function, e.g., X::f(). We use an empty type for the implied 5924 // object argument (C++ [over.call.func]p3), and the acting context 5925 // is irrelevant. 5926 AddMethodCandidate(Method, FoundDecl, Method->getParent(), QualType(), 5927 Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(), Args, 5928 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 5929 PartialOverloading, EarlyConversions); 5930 return; 5931 } 5932 // We treat a constructor like a non-member function, since its object 5933 // argument doesn't participate in overload resolution. 5934 } 5935 5936 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Function)) 5937 return; 5938 5939 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 5940 // if no operand has a class type, only those non-member functions in the 5941 // lookup set that have a first parameter of type T1 or "reference to 5942 // (possibly cv-qualified) T1", when T1 is an enumeration type, or (if there 5943 // is a right operand) a second parameter of type T2 or "reference to 5944 // (possibly cv-qualified) T2", when T2 is an enumeration type, are 5945 // candidate functions. 5946 if (CandidateSet.getKind() == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator && 5947 !IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate(Context, Function, Args)) 5948 return; 5949 5950 // C++11 [class.copy]p11: [DR1402] 5951 // A defaulted move constructor that is defined as deleted is ignored by 5952 // overload resolution. 5953 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function); 5954 if (Constructor && Constructor->isDefaulted() && Constructor->isDeleted() && 5955 Constructor->isMoveConstructor()) 5956 return; 5957 5958 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 5959 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 5960 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 5961 5962 // Add this candidate 5963 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = 5964 CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size(), EarlyConversions); 5965 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 5966 Candidate.Function = Function; 5967 Candidate.Viable = true; 5968 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 5969 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 5970 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 5971 5972 if (Function->isMultiVersion() && 5973 !Function->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion()) { 5974 Candidate.Viable = false; 5975 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_non_default_multiversion_function; 5976 return; 5977 } 5978 5979 if (Constructor) { 5980 // C++ [class.copy]p3: 5981 // A member function template is never instantiated to perform the copy 5982 // of a class object to an object of its class type. 5983 QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Constructor->getParent()); 5984 if (Args.size() == 1 && Constructor->isSpecializationCopyingObject() && 5985 (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ClassType, Args[0]->getType()) || 5986 IsDerivedFrom(Args[0]->getLocStart(), Args[0]->getType(), 5987 ClassType))) { 5988 Candidate.Viable = false; 5989 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_illegal_constructor; 5990 return; 5991 } 5992 5993 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p8: (proposed DR resolution) 5994 // A constructor inherited from class type C that has a first parameter 5995 // of type "reference to P" (including such a constructor instantiated 5996 // from a template) is excluded from the set of candidate functions when 5997 // constructing an object of type cv D if the argument list has exactly 5998 // one argument and D is reference-related to P and P is reference-related 5999 // to C. 6000 auto *Shadow = dyn_cast<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl.getDecl()); 6001 if (Shadow && Args.size() == 1 && Constructor->getNumParams() >= 1 && 6002 Constructor->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->isReferenceType()) { 6003 QualType P = Constructor->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->getPointeeType(); 6004 QualType C = Context.getRecordType(Constructor->getParent()); 6005 QualType D = Context.getRecordType(Shadow->getParent()); 6006 SourceLocation Loc = Args.front()->getExprLoc(); 6007 if ((Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(P, C) || IsDerivedFrom(Loc, P, C)) && 6008 (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(D, P) || IsDerivedFrom(Loc, D, P))) { 6009 Candidate.Viable = false; 6010 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_inhctor_slice; 6011 return; 6012 } 6013 } 6014 } 6015 6016 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 6017 6018 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m 6019 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter 6020 // list (8.3.5). 6021 if (TooManyArguments(NumParams, Args.size(), PartialOverloading) && 6022 !Proto->isVariadic()) { 6023 Candidate.Viable = false; 6024 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 6025 return; 6026 } 6027 6028 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters 6029 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument 6030 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the 6031 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are 6032 // exactly m parameters. 6033 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Function->getMinRequiredArguments(); 6034 if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) { 6035 // Not enough arguments. 6036 Candidate.Viable = false; 6037 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments; 6038 return; 6039 } 6040 6041 // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets. 6042 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) 6043 if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext)) 6044 // Skip the check for callers that are implicit members, because in this 6045 // case we may not yet know what the member's target is; the target is 6046 // inferred for the member automatically, based on the bases and fields of 6047 // the class. 6048 if (!Caller->isImplicit() && !IsAllowedCUDACall(Caller, Function)) { 6049 Candidate.Viable = false; 6050 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target; 6051 return; 6052 } 6053 6054 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 6055 // arguments. 6056 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) { 6057 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isInitialized()) { 6058 // We already formed a conversion sequence for this parameter during 6059 // template argument deduction. 6060 } else if (ArgIdx < NumParams) { 6061 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall 6062 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence 6063 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding 6064 // parameter of F. 6065 QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx); 6066 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx] 6067 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType, 6068 SuppressUserConversions, 6069 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 6070 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 6071 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount, 6072 AllowExplicit); 6073 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) { 6074 Candidate.Viable = false; 6075 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 6076 return; 6077 } 6078 } else { 6079 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any 6080 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is 6081 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3). 6082 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].setEllipsis(); 6083 } 6084 } 6085 6086 if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = CheckEnableIf(Function, Args)) { 6087 Candidate.Viable = false; 6088 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if; 6089 Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr; 6090 return; 6091 } 6092 6093 if (LangOpts.OpenCL && isOpenCLDisabledDecl(Function)) { 6094 Candidate.Viable = false; 6095 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_ext_disabled; 6096 return; 6097 } 6098 } 6099 6100 ObjCMethodDecl * 6101 Sema::SelectBestMethod(Selector Sel, MultiExprArg Args, bool IsInstance, 6102 SmallVectorImpl<ObjCMethodDecl *> &Methods) { 6103 if (Methods.size() <= 1) 6104 return nullptr; 6105 6106 for (unsigned b = 0, e = Methods.size(); b < e; b++) { 6107 bool Match = true; 6108 ObjCMethodDecl *Method = Methods[b]; 6109 unsigned NumNamedArgs = Sel.getNumArgs(); 6110 // Method might have more arguments than selector indicates. This is due 6111 // to addition of c-style arguments in method. 6112 if (Method->param_size() > NumNamedArgs) 6113 NumNamedArgs = Method->param_size(); 6114 if (Args.size() < NumNamedArgs) 6115 continue; 6116 6117 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumNamedArgs; i++) { 6118 // We can't do any type-checking on a type-dependent argument. 6119 if (Args[i]->isTypeDependent()) { 6120 Match = false; 6121 break; 6122 } 6123 6124 ParmVarDecl *param = Method->parameters()[i]; 6125 Expr *argExpr = Args[i]; 6126 assert(argExpr && "SelectBestMethod(): missing expression"); 6127 6128 // Strip the unbridged-cast placeholder expression off unless it's 6129 // a consumed argument. 6130 if (argExpr->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast) && 6131 !param->hasAttr<CFConsumedAttr>()) 6132 argExpr = stripARCUnbridgedCast(argExpr); 6133 6134 // If the parameter is __unknown_anytype, move on to the next method. 6135 if (param->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 6136 Match = false; 6137 break; 6138 } 6139 6140 ImplicitConversionSequence ConversionState 6141 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, argExpr, param->getType(), 6142 /*SuppressUserConversions*/false, 6143 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 6144 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 6145 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount, 6146 /*AllowExplicit*/false); 6147 // This function looks for a reasonably-exact match, so we consider 6148 // incompatible pointer conversions to be a failure here. 6149 if (ConversionState.isBad() || 6150 (ConversionState.isStandard() && 6151 ConversionState.Standard.Second == 6152 ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion)) { 6153 Match = false; 6154 break; 6155 } 6156 } 6157 // Promote additional arguments to variadic methods. 6158 if (Match && Method->isVariadic()) { 6159 for (unsigned i = NumNamedArgs, e = Args.size(); i < e; ++i) { 6160 if (Args[i]->isTypeDependent()) { 6161 Match = false; 6162 break; 6163 } 6164 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod, 6165 nullptr); 6166 if (Arg.isInvalid()) { 6167 Match = false; 6168 break; 6169 } 6170 } 6171 } else { 6172 // Check for extra arguments to non-variadic methods. 6173 if (Args.size() != NumNamedArgs) 6174 Match = false; 6175 else if (Match && NumNamedArgs == 0 && Methods.size() > 1) { 6176 // Special case when selectors have no argument. In this case, select 6177 // one with the most general result type of 'id'. 6178 for (unsigned b = 0, e = Methods.size(); b < e; b++) { 6179 QualType ReturnT = Methods[b]->getReturnType(); 6180 if (ReturnT->isObjCIdType()) 6181 return Methods[b]; 6182 } 6183 } 6184 } 6185 6186 if (Match) 6187 return Method; 6188 } 6189 return nullptr; 6190 } 6191 6192 static bool 6193 convertArgsForAvailabilityChecks(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Function, Expr *ThisArg, 6194 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, Sema::SFINAETrap &Trap, 6195 bool MissingImplicitThis, Expr *&ConvertedThis, 6196 SmallVectorImpl<Expr *> &ConvertedArgs) { 6197 if (ThisArg) { 6198 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function); 6199 assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) && 6200 "Shouldn't have `this` for ctors!"); 6201 assert(!Method->isStatic() && "Shouldn't have `this` for static methods!"); 6202 ExprResult R = S.PerformObjectArgumentInitialization( 6203 ThisArg, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, Method, Method); 6204 if (R.isInvalid()) 6205 return false; 6206 ConvertedThis = R.get(); 6207 } else { 6208 if (auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) { 6209 (void)MD; 6210 assert((MissingImplicitThis || MD->isStatic() || 6211 isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD)) && 6212 "Expected `this` for non-ctor instance methods"); 6213 } 6214 ConvertedThis = nullptr; 6215 } 6216 6217 // Ignore any variadic arguments. Converting them is pointless, since the 6218 // user can't refer to them in the function condition. 6219 unsigned ArgSizeNoVarargs = std::min(Function->param_size(), Args.size()); 6220 6221 // Convert the arguments. 6222 for (unsigned I = 0; I != ArgSizeNoVarargs; ++I) { 6223 ExprResult R; 6224 R = S.PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 6225 S.Context, Function->getParamDecl(I)), 6226 SourceLocation(), Args[I]); 6227 6228 if (R.isInvalid()) 6229 return false; 6230 6231 ConvertedArgs.push_back(R.get()); 6232 } 6233 6234 if (Trap.hasErrorOccurred()) 6235 return false; 6236 6237 // Push default arguments if needed. 6238 if (!Function->isVariadic() && Args.size() < Function->getNumParams()) { 6239 for (unsigned i = Args.size(), e = Function->getNumParams(); i != e; ++i) { 6240 ParmVarDecl *P = Function->getParamDecl(i); 6241 Expr *DefArg = P->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg() 6242 ? P->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg() 6243 : P->getDefaultArg(); 6244 // This can only happen in code completion, i.e. when PartialOverloading 6245 // is true. 6246 if (!DefArg) 6247 return false; 6248 ExprResult R = 6249 S.PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 6250 S.Context, Function->getParamDecl(i)), 6251 SourceLocation(), DefArg); 6252 if (R.isInvalid()) 6253 return false; 6254 ConvertedArgs.push_back(R.get()); 6255 } 6256 6257 if (Trap.hasErrorOccurred()) 6258 return false; 6259 } 6260 return true; 6261 } 6262 6263 EnableIfAttr *Sema::CheckEnableIf(FunctionDecl *Function, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6264 bool MissingImplicitThis) { 6265 auto EnableIfAttrs = Function->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>(); 6266 6267 if (EnableIfAttrs.begin() == EnableIfAttrs.end()) 6268 return nullptr; 6269 6270 SFINAETrap Trap(*this); 6271 SmallVector<Expr *, 16> ConvertedArgs; 6272 // FIXME: We should look into making enable_if late-parsed. 6273 Expr *DiscardedThis; 6274 if (!convertArgsForAvailabilityChecks( 6275 *this, Function, /*ThisArg=*/nullptr, Args, Trap, 6276 /*MissingImplicitThis=*/true, DiscardedThis, ConvertedArgs)) 6277 return *EnableIfAttrs.begin(); 6278 6279 for (auto *EIA : EnableIfAttrs) { 6280 APValue Result; 6281 // FIXME: This doesn't consider value-dependent cases, because doing so is 6282 // very difficult. Ideally, we should handle them more gracefully. 6283 if (!EIA->getCond()->EvaluateWithSubstitution( 6284 Result, Context, Function, llvm::makeArrayRef(ConvertedArgs))) 6285 return EIA; 6286 6287 if (!Result.isInt() || !Result.getInt().getBoolValue()) 6288 return EIA; 6289 } 6290 return nullptr; 6291 } 6292 6293 template <typename CheckFn> 6294 static bool diagnoseDiagnoseIfAttrsWith(Sema &S, const NamedDecl *ND, 6295 bool ArgDependent, SourceLocation Loc, 6296 CheckFn &&IsSuccessful) { 6297 SmallVector<const DiagnoseIfAttr *, 8> Attrs; 6298 for (const auto *DIA : ND->specific_attrs<DiagnoseIfAttr>()) { 6299 if (ArgDependent == DIA->getArgDependent()) 6300 Attrs.push_back(DIA); 6301 } 6302 6303 // Common case: No diagnose_if attributes, so we can quit early. 6304 if (Attrs.empty()) 6305 return false; 6306 6307 auto WarningBegin = std::stable_partition( 6308 Attrs.begin(), Attrs.end(), 6309 [](const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA) { return DIA->isError(); }); 6310 6311 // Note that diagnose_if attributes are late-parsed, so they appear in the 6312 // correct order (unlike enable_if attributes). 6313 auto ErrAttr = llvm::find_if(llvm::make_range(Attrs.begin(), WarningBegin), 6314 IsSuccessful); 6315 if (ErrAttr != WarningBegin) { 6316 const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA = *ErrAttr; 6317 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_diagnose_if_succeeded) << DIA->getMessage(); 6318 S.Diag(DIA->getLocation(), diag::note_from_diagnose_if) 6319 << DIA->getParent() << DIA->getCond()->getSourceRange(); 6320 return true; 6321 } 6322 6323 for (const auto *DIA : llvm::make_range(WarningBegin, Attrs.end())) 6324 if (IsSuccessful(DIA)) { 6325 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_diagnose_if_succeeded) << DIA->getMessage(); 6326 S.Diag(DIA->getLocation(), diag::note_from_diagnose_if) 6327 << DIA->getParent() << DIA->getCond()->getSourceRange(); 6328 } 6329 6330 return false; 6331 } 6332 6333 bool Sema::diagnoseArgDependentDiagnoseIfAttrs(const FunctionDecl *Function, 6334 const Expr *ThisArg, 6335 ArrayRef<const Expr *> Args, 6336 SourceLocation Loc) { 6337 return diagnoseDiagnoseIfAttrsWith( 6338 *this, Function, /*ArgDependent=*/true, Loc, 6339 [&](const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA) { 6340 APValue Result; 6341 // It's sane to use the same Args for any redecl of this function, since 6342 // EvaluateWithSubstitution only cares about the position of each 6343 // argument in the arg list, not the ParmVarDecl* it maps to. 6344 if (!DIA->getCond()->EvaluateWithSubstitution( 6345 Result, Context, cast<FunctionDecl>(DIA->getParent()), Args, ThisArg)) 6346 return false; 6347 return Result.isInt() && Result.getInt().getBoolValue(); 6348 }); 6349 } 6350 6351 bool Sema::diagnoseArgIndependentDiagnoseIfAttrs(const NamedDecl *ND, 6352 SourceLocation Loc) { 6353 return diagnoseDiagnoseIfAttrsWith( 6354 *this, ND, /*ArgDependent=*/false, Loc, 6355 [&](const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA) { 6356 bool Result; 6357 return DIA->getCond()->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(Result, Context) && 6358 Result; 6359 }); 6360 } 6361 6362 /// Add all of the function declarations in the given function set to 6363 /// the overload candidate set. 6364 void Sema::AddFunctionCandidates(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, 6365 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6366 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 6367 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 6368 bool SuppressUserConversions, 6369 bool PartialOverloading, 6370 bool FirstArgumentIsBase) { 6371 for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) { 6372 NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl(); 6373 ArrayRef<Expr *> FunctionArgs = Args; 6374 6375 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D); 6376 FunctionDecl *FD = 6377 FunTmpl ? FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl() : cast<FunctionDecl>(D); 6378 6379 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic()) { 6380 QualType ObjectType; 6381 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification; 6382 if (Args.size() > 0) { 6383 if (Expr *E = Args[0]) { 6384 // Use the explicit base to restrict the lookup: 6385 ObjectType = E->getType(); 6386 ObjectClassification = E->Classify(Context); 6387 } // .. else there is an implicit base. 6388 FunctionArgs = Args.slice(1); 6389 } 6390 if (FunTmpl) { 6391 AddMethodTemplateCandidate( 6392 FunTmpl, F.getPair(), 6393 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FunTmpl->getDeclContext()), 6394 ExplicitTemplateArgs, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, 6395 FunctionArgs, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, 6396 PartialOverloading); 6397 } else { 6398 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD), F.getPair(), 6399 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->getParent(), ObjectType, 6400 ObjectClassification, FunctionArgs, CandidateSet, 6401 SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading); 6402 } 6403 } else { 6404 // This branch handles both standalone functions and static methods. 6405 6406 // Slice the first argument (which is the base) when we access 6407 // static method as non-static. 6408 if (Args.size() > 0 && 6409 (!Args[0] || (FirstArgumentIsBase && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && 6410 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD)))) { 6411 assert(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic()); 6412 FunctionArgs = Args.slice(1); 6413 } 6414 if (FunTmpl) { 6415 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate( 6416 FunTmpl, F.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, FunctionArgs, 6417 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading); 6418 } else { 6419 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), FunctionArgs, CandidateSet, 6420 SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading); 6421 } 6422 } 6423 } 6424 } 6425 6426 /// AddMethodCandidate - Adds a named decl (which is some kind of 6427 /// method) as a method candidate to the given overload set. 6428 void Sema::AddMethodCandidate(DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 6429 QualType ObjectType, 6430 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, 6431 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6432 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 6433 bool SuppressUserConversions) { 6434 NamedDecl *Decl = FoundDecl.getDecl(); 6435 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Decl->getDeclContext()); 6436 6437 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)) 6438 Decl = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)->getTargetDecl(); 6439 6440 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Decl)) { 6441 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl()) && 6442 "Expected a member function template"); 6443 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(TD, FoundDecl, ActingContext, 6444 /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr, ObjectType, 6445 ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet, 6446 SuppressUserConversions); 6447 } else { 6448 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl), FoundDecl, ActingContext, 6449 ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet, 6450 SuppressUserConversions); 6451 } 6452 } 6453 6454 /// AddMethodCandidate - Adds the given C++ member function to the set 6455 /// of candidate functions, using the given function call arguments 6456 /// and the object argument (@c Object). For example, in a call 6457 /// @c o.f(a1,a2), @c Object will contain @c o and @c Args will contain 6458 /// both @c a1 and @c a2. If @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't 6459 /// allow user-defined conversions via constructors or conversion 6460 /// operators. 6461 void 6462 Sema::AddMethodCandidate(CXXMethodDecl *Method, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 6463 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType, 6464 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, 6465 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6466 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 6467 bool SuppressUserConversions, 6468 bool PartialOverloading, 6469 ConversionSequenceList EarlyConversions) { 6470 const FunctionProtoType *Proto 6471 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()); 6472 assert(Proto && "Methods without a prototype cannot be overloaded"); 6473 assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) && 6474 "Use AddOverloadCandidate for constructors"); 6475 6476 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Method)) 6477 return; 6478 6479 // C++11 [class.copy]p23: [DR1402] 6480 // A defaulted move assignment operator that is defined as deleted is 6481 // ignored by overload resolution. 6482 if (Method->isDefaulted() && Method->isDeleted() && 6483 Method->isMoveAssignmentOperator()) 6484 return; 6485 6486 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 6487 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 6488 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 6489 6490 // Add this candidate 6491 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = 6492 CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1, EarlyConversions); 6493 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 6494 Candidate.Function = Method; 6495 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 6496 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 6497 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 6498 6499 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 6500 6501 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m 6502 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter 6503 // list (8.3.5). 6504 if (TooManyArguments(NumParams, Args.size(), PartialOverloading) && 6505 !Proto->isVariadic()) { 6506 Candidate.Viable = false; 6507 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 6508 return; 6509 } 6510 6511 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters 6512 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument 6513 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the 6514 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are 6515 // exactly m parameters. 6516 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Method->getMinRequiredArguments(); 6517 if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) { 6518 // Not enough arguments. 6519 Candidate.Viable = false; 6520 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments; 6521 return; 6522 } 6523 6524 Candidate.Viable = true; 6525 6526 if (Method->isStatic() || ObjectType.isNull()) 6527 // The implicit object argument is ignored. 6528 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = true; 6529 else { 6530 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the object 6531 // parameter. 6532 Candidate.Conversions[0] = TryObjectArgumentInitialization( 6533 *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), ObjectType, ObjectClassification, 6534 Method, ActingContext); 6535 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) { 6536 Candidate.Viable = false; 6537 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 6538 return; 6539 } 6540 } 6541 6542 // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets. 6543 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) 6544 if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext)) 6545 if (!IsAllowedCUDACall(Caller, Method)) { 6546 Candidate.Viable = false; 6547 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target; 6548 return; 6549 } 6550 6551 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 6552 // arguments. 6553 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) { 6554 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isInitialized()) { 6555 // We already formed a conversion sequence for this parameter during 6556 // template argument deduction. 6557 } else if (ArgIdx < NumParams) { 6558 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall 6559 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence 6560 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding 6561 // parameter of F. 6562 QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx); 6563 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1] 6564 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType, 6565 SuppressUserConversions, 6566 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 6567 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 6568 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 6569 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) { 6570 Candidate.Viable = false; 6571 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 6572 return; 6573 } 6574 } else { 6575 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any 6576 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is 6577 // considered to "match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3). 6578 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis(); 6579 } 6580 } 6581 6582 if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = CheckEnableIf(Method, Args, true)) { 6583 Candidate.Viable = false; 6584 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if; 6585 Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr; 6586 return; 6587 } 6588 6589 if (Method->isMultiVersion() && 6590 !Method->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion()) { 6591 Candidate.Viable = false; 6592 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_non_default_multiversion_function; 6593 } 6594 } 6595 6596 /// Add a C++ member function template as a candidate to the candidate 6597 /// set, using template argument deduction to produce an appropriate member 6598 /// function template specialization. 6599 void 6600 Sema::AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *MethodTmpl, 6601 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 6602 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, 6603 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 6604 QualType ObjectType, 6605 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, 6606 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6607 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 6608 bool SuppressUserConversions, 6609 bool PartialOverloading) { 6610 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(MethodTmpl)) 6611 return; 6612 6613 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7: 6614 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate 6615 // function template specializations are generated using template argument 6616 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as 6617 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one 6618 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template 6619 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each 6620 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate 6621 // functions. 6622 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation()); 6623 FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr; 6624 ConversionSequenceList Conversions; 6625 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result = DeduceTemplateArguments( 6626 MethodTmpl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, Specialization, Info, 6627 PartialOverloading, [&](ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes) { 6628 return CheckNonDependentConversions( 6629 MethodTmpl, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, Conversions, 6630 SuppressUserConversions, ActingContext, ObjectType, 6631 ObjectClassification); 6632 })) { 6633 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = 6634 CandidateSet.addCandidate(Conversions.size(), Conversions); 6635 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 6636 Candidate.Function = MethodTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(); 6637 Candidate.Viable = false; 6638 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 6639 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = 6640 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Candidate.Function)->isStatic() || 6641 ObjectType.isNull(); 6642 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 6643 if (Result == TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure) 6644 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 6645 else { 6646 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction; 6647 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, 6648 Info); 6649 } 6650 return; 6651 } 6652 6653 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument 6654 // deduction as a candidate. 6655 assert(Specialization && "Missing member function template specialization?"); 6656 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization) && 6657 "Specialization is not a member function?"); 6658 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization), FoundDecl, 6659 ActingContext, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, 6660 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading, 6661 Conversions); 6662 } 6663 6664 /// Add a C++ function template specialization as a candidate 6665 /// in the candidate set, using template argument deduction to produce 6666 /// an appropriate function template specialization. 6667 void 6668 Sema::AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, 6669 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 6670 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 6671 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 6672 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 6673 bool SuppressUserConversions, 6674 bool PartialOverloading) { 6675 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate)) 6676 return; 6677 6678 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7: 6679 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate 6680 // function template specializations are generated using template argument 6681 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as 6682 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one 6683 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template 6684 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each 6685 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate 6686 // functions. 6687 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation()); 6688 FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr; 6689 ConversionSequenceList Conversions; 6690 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result = DeduceTemplateArguments( 6691 FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, Specialization, Info, 6692 PartialOverloading, [&](ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes) { 6693 return CheckNonDependentConversions(FunctionTemplate, ParamTypes, 6694 Args, CandidateSet, Conversions, 6695 SuppressUserConversions); 6696 })) { 6697 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = 6698 CandidateSet.addCandidate(Conversions.size(), Conversions); 6699 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 6700 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(); 6701 Candidate.Viable = false; 6702 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 6703 // Ignore the object argument if there is one, since we don't have an object 6704 // type. 6705 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = 6706 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Candidate.Function) && 6707 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Candidate.Function); 6708 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 6709 if (Result == TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure) 6710 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 6711 else { 6712 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction; 6713 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, 6714 Info); 6715 } 6716 return; 6717 } 6718 6719 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument 6720 // deduction as a candidate. 6721 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?"); 6722 AddOverloadCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, 6723 SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading, 6724 /*AllowExplicit*/false, Conversions); 6725 } 6726 6727 /// Check that implicit conversion sequences can be formed for each argument 6728 /// whose corresponding parameter has a non-dependent type, per DR1391's 6729 /// [temp.deduct.call]p10. 6730 bool Sema::CheckNonDependentConversions( 6731 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes, 6732 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 6733 ConversionSequenceList &Conversions, bool SuppressUserConversions, 6734 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType, 6735 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification) { 6736 // FIXME: The cases in which we allow explicit conversions for constructor 6737 // arguments never consider calling a constructor template. It's not clear 6738 // that is correct. 6739 const bool AllowExplicit = false; 6740 6741 auto *FD = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(); 6742 auto *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD); 6743 bool HasThisConversion = Method && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method); 6744 unsigned ThisConversions = HasThisConversion ? 1 : 0; 6745 6746 Conversions = 6747 CandidateSet.allocateConversionSequences(ThisConversions + Args.size()); 6748 6749 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 6750 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 6751 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 6752 6753 // For a method call, check the 'this' conversion here too. DR1391 doesn't 6754 // require that, but this check should never result in a hard error, and 6755 // overload resolution is permitted to sidestep instantiations. 6756 if (HasThisConversion && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic() && 6757 !ObjectType.isNull()) { 6758 Conversions[0] = TryObjectArgumentInitialization( 6759 *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), ObjectType, ObjectClassification, 6760 Method, ActingContext); 6761 if (Conversions[0].isBad()) 6762 return true; 6763 } 6764 6765 for (unsigned I = 0, N = std::min(ParamTypes.size(), Args.size()); I != N; 6766 ++I) { 6767 QualType ParamType = ParamTypes[I]; 6768 if (!ParamType->isDependentType()) { 6769 Conversions[ThisConversions + I] 6770 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[I], ParamType, 6771 SuppressUserConversions, 6772 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 6773 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 6774 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount, 6775 AllowExplicit); 6776 if (Conversions[ThisConversions + I].isBad()) 6777 return true; 6778 } 6779 } 6780 6781 return false; 6782 } 6783 6784 /// Determine whether this is an allowable conversion from the result 6785 /// of an explicit conversion operator to the expected type, per C++ 6786 /// [over.match.conv]p1 and [over.match.ref]p1. 6787 /// 6788 /// \param ConvType The return type of the conversion function. 6789 /// 6790 /// \param ToType The type we are converting to. 6791 /// 6792 /// \param AllowObjCPointerConversion Allow a conversion from one 6793 /// Objective-C pointer to another. 6794 /// 6795 /// \returns true if the conversion is allowable, false otherwise. 6796 static bool isAllowableExplicitConversion(Sema &S, 6797 QualType ConvType, QualType ToType, 6798 bool AllowObjCPointerConversion) { 6799 QualType ToNonRefType = ToType.getNonReferenceType(); 6800 6801 // Easy case: the types are the same. 6802 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ConvType, ToNonRefType)) 6803 return true; 6804 6805 // Allow qualification conversions. 6806 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion; 6807 if (S.IsQualificationConversion(ConvType, ToNonRefType, /*CStyle*/false, 6808 ObjCLifetimeConversion)) 6809 return true; 6810 6811 // If we're not allowed to consider Objective-C pointer conversions, 6812 // we're done. 6813 if (!AllowObjCPointerConversion) 6814 return false; 6815 6816 // Is this an Objective-C pointer conversion? 6817 bool IncompatibleObjC = false; 6818 QualType ConvertedType; 6819 return S.isObjCPointerConversion(ConvType, ToNonRefType, ConvertedType, 6820 IncompatibleObjC); 6821 } 6822 6823 /// AddConversionCandidate - Add a C++ conversion function as a 6824 /// candidate in the candidate set (C++ [over.match.conv], 6825 /// C++ [over.match.copy]). From is the expression we're converting from, 6826 /// and ToType is the type that we're eventually trying to convert to 6827 /// (which may or may not be the same type as the type that the 6828 /// conversion function produces). 6829 void 6830 Sema::AddConversionCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion, 6831 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 6832 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, 6833 Expr *From, QualType ToType, 6834 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 6835 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit, 6836 bool AllowResultConversion) { 6837 assert(!Conversion->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() && 6838 "Conversion function templates use AddTemplateConversionCandidate"); 6839 QualType ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 6840 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion)) 6841 return; 6842 6843 // If the conversion function has an undeduced return type, trigger its 6844 // deduction now. 6845 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && ConvType->isUndeducedType()) { 6846 if (DeduceReturnType(Conversion, From->getExprLoc())) 6847 return; 6848 ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 6849 } 6850 6851 // If we don't allow any conversion of the result type, ignore conversion 6852 // functions that don't convert to exactly (possibly cv-qualified) T. 6853 if (!AllowResultConversion && 6854 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Conversion->getConversionType(), ToType)) 6855 return; 6856 6857 // Per C++ [over.match.conv]p1, [over.match.ref]p1, an explicit conversion 6858 // operator is only a candidate if its return type is the target type or 6859 // can be converted to the target type with a qualification conversion. 6860 if (Conversion->isExplicit() && 6861 !isAllowableExplicitConversion(*this, ConvType, ToType, 6862 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit)) 6863 return; 6864 6865 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 6866 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 6867 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 6868 6869 // Add this candidate 6870 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(1); 6871 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 6872 Candidate.Function = Conversion; 6873 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 6874 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 6875 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAsIdentityConversion(); 6876 Candidate.FinalConversion.setFromType(ConvType); 6877 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAllToTypes(ToType); 6878 Candidate.Viable = true; 6879 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1; 6880 6881 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p4: 6882 // For conversion functions, the function is considered to be a member of 6883 // the class of the implicit implied object argument for the purpose of 6884 // defining the type of the implicit object parameter. 6885 // 6886 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit 6887 // object parameter. 6888 QualType ImplicitParamType = From->getType(); 6889 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = ImplicitParamType->getAs<PointerType>()) 6890 ImplicitParamType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(); 6891 CXXRecordDecl *ConversionContext 6892 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ImplicitParamType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()); 6893 6894 Candidate.Conversions[0] = TryObjectArgumentInitialization( 6895 *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), From->getType(), 6896 From->Classify(Context), Conversion, ConversionContext); 6897 6898 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) { 6899 Candidate.Viable = false; 6900 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 6901 return; 6902 } 6903 6904 // We won't go through a user-defined type conversion function to convert a 6905 // derived to base as such conversions are given Conversion Rank. They only 6906 // go through a copy constructor. 13.3.3.1.2-p4 [over.ics.user] 6907 QualType FromCanon 6908 = Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType()); 6909 QualType ToCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType(); 6910 if (FromCanon == ToCanon || 6911 IsDerivedFrom(CandidateSet.getLocation(), FromCanon, ToCanon)) { 6912 Candidate.Viable = false; 6913 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_trivial_conversion; 6914 return; 6915 } 6916 6917 // To determine what the conversion from the result of calling the 6918 // conversion function to the type we're eventually trying to 6919 // convert to (ToType), we need to synthesize a call to the 6920 // conversion function and attempt copy initialization from it. This 6921 // makes sure that we get the right semantics with respect to 6922 // lvalues/rvalues and the type. Fortunately, we can allocate this 6923 // call on the stack and we don't need its arguments to be 6924 // well-formed. 6925 DeclRefExpr ConversionRef(Conversion, false, Conversion->getType(), 6926 VK_LValue, From->getLocStart()); 6927 ImplicitCastExpr ConversionFn(ImplicitCastExpr::OnStack, 6928 Context.getPointerType(Conversion->getType()), 6929 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay, 6930 &ConversionRef, VK_RValue); 6931 6932 QualType ConversionType = Conversion->getConversionType(); 6933 if (!isCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ConversionType)) { 6934 Candidate.Viable = false; 6935 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion; 6936 return; 6937 } 6938 6939 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ConversionType); 6940 6941 // Note that it is safe to allocate CallExpr on the stack here because 6942 // there are 0 arguments (i.e., nothing is allocated using ASTContext's 6943 // allocator). 6944 QualType CallResultType = ConversionType.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 6945 CallExpr Call(Context, &ConversionFn, None, CallResultType, VK, 6946 From->getLocStart()); 6947 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 6948 TryCopyInitialization(*this, &Call, ToType, 6949 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true, 6950 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 6951 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false); 6952 6953 switch (ICS.getKind()) { 6954 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion: 6955 Candidate.FinalConversion = ICS.Standard; 6956 6957 // C++ [over.ics.user]p3: 6958 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a specialization of a 6959 // conversion function template, the second standard conversion sequence 6960 // shall have exact match rank. 6961 if (Conversion->getPrimaryTemplate() && 6962 GetConversionRank(ICS.Standard.Second) != ICR_Exact_Match) { 6963 Candidate.Viable = false; 6964 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact; 6965 return; 6966 } 6967 6968 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5: 6969 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference and 6970 // the second standard conversion sequence of the user-defined 6971 // conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, the 6972 // program is ill-formed. 6973 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() && 6974 ICS.Standard.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) { 6975 Candidate.Viable = false; 6976 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion; 6977 return; 6978 } 6979 break; 6980 6981 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion: 6982 Candidate.Viable = false; 6983 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion; 6984 return; 6985 6986 default: 6987 llvm_unreachable( 6988 "Can only end up with a standard conversion sequence or failure"); 6989 } 6990 6991 if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = CheckEnableIf(Conversion, None)) { 6992 Candidate.Viable = false; 6993 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if; 6994 Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr; 6995 return; 6996 } 6997 6998 if (Conversion->isMultiVersion() && 6999 !Conversion->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion()) { 7000 Candidate.Viable = false; 7001 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_non_default_multiversion_function; 7002 } 7003 } 7004 7005 /// Adds a conversion function template specialization 7006 /// candidate to the overload set, using template argument deduction 7007 /// to deduce the template arguments of the conversion function 7008 /// template from the type that we are converting to (C++ 7009 /// [temp.deduct.conv]). 7010 void 7011 Sema::AddTemplateConversionCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, 7012 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 7013 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC, 7014 Expr *From, QualType ToType, 7015 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 7016 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit, 7017 bool AllowResultConversion) { 7018 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()) && 7019 "Only conversion function templates permitted here"); 7020 7021 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate)) 7022 return; 7023 7024 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation()); 7025 CXXConversionDecl *Specialization = nullptr; 7026 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result 7027 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ToType, 7028 Specialization, Info)) { 7029 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(); 7030 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 7031 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(); 7032 Candidate.Viable = false; 7033 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction; 7034 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 7035 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 7036 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1; 7037 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, 7038 Info); 7039 return; 7040 } 7041 7042 // Add the conversion function template specialization produced by 7043 // template argument deduction as a candidate. 7044 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?"); 7045 AddConversionCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, ActingDC, From, ToType, 7046 CandidateSet, AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit, 7047 AllowResultConversion); 7048 } 7049 7050 /// AddSurrogateCandidate - Adds a "surrogate" candidate function that 7051 /// converts the given @c Object to a function pointer via the 7052 /// conversion function @c Conversion, and then attempts to call it 7053 /// with the given arguments (C++ [over.call.object]p2-4). Proto is 7054 /// the type of function that we'll eventually be calling. 7055 void Sema::AddSurrogateCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion, 7056 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 7057 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, 7058 const FunctionProtoType *Proto, 7059 Expr *Object, 7060 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 7061 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) { 7062 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion)) 7063 return; 7064 7065 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 7066 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 7067 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 7068 7069 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1); 7070 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl; 7071 Candidate.Function = nullptr; 7072 Candidate.Surrogate = Conversion; 7073 Candidate.Viable = true; 7074 Candidate.IsSurrogate = true; 7075 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 7076 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 7077 7078 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit 7079 // object parameter. 7080 ImplicitConversionSequence ObjectInit = TryObjectArgumentInitialization( 7081 *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), Object->getType(), 7082 Object->Classify(Context), Conversion, ActingContext); 7083 if (ObjectInit.isBad()) { 7084 Candidate.Viable = false; 7085 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 7086 Candidate.Conversions[0] = ObjectInit; 7087 return; 7088 } 7089 7090 // The first conversion is actually a user-defined conversion whose 7091 // first conversion is ObjectInit's standard conversion (which is 7092 // effectively a reference binding). Record it as such. 7093 Candidate.Conversions[0].setUserDefined(); 7094 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before = ObjectInit.Standard; 7095 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false; 7096 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = false; 7097 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Conversion; 7098 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = FoundDecl; 7099 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After 7100 = Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before; 7101 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion(); 7102 7103 // Find the 7104 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 7105 7106 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m 7107 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter 7108 // list (8.3.5). 7109 if (Args.size() > NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic()) { 7110 Candidate.Viable = false; 7111 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 7112 return; 7113 } 7114 7115 // Function types don't have any default arguments, so just check if 7116 // we have enough arguments. 7117 if (Args.size() < NumParams) { 7118 // Not enough arguments. 7119 Candidate.Viable = false; 7120 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments; 7121 return; 7122 } 7123 7124 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 7125 // arguments. 7126 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 7127 if (ArgIdx < NumParams) { 7128 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall 7129 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence 7130 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding 7131 // parameter of F. 7132 QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx); 7133 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1] 7134 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType, 7135 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 7136 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 7137 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 7138 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 7139 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) { 7140 Candidate.Viable = false; 7141 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 7142 return; 7143 } 7144 } else { 7145 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any 7146 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is 7147 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3). 7148 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis(); 7149 } 7150 } 7151 7152 if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = CheckEnableIf(Conversion, None)) { 7153 Candidate.Viable = false; 7154 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if; 7155 Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr; 7156 return; 7157 } 7158 } 7159 7160 /// Add overload candidates for overloaded operators that are 7161 /// member functions. 7162 /// 7163 /// Add the overloaded operator candidates that are member functions 7164 /// for the operator Op that was used in an operator expression such 7165 /// as "x Op y". , Args/NumArgs provides the operator arguments, and 7166 /// CandidateSet will store the added overload candidates. (C++ 7167 /// [over.match.oper]). 7168 void Sema::AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op, 7169 SourceLocation OpLoc, 7170 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 7171 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 7172 SourceRange OpRange) { 7173 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 7174 7175 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 7176 // For a unary operator @ with an operand of a type whose 7177 // cv-unqualified version is T1, and for a binary operator @ with 7178 // a left operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T1 and 7179 // a right operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T2, 7180 // three sets of candidate functions, designated member 7181 // candidates, non-member candidates and built-in candidates, are 7182 // constructed as follows: 7183 QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType(); 7184 7185 // -- If T1 is a complete class type or a class currently being 7186 // defined, the set of member candidates is the result of the 7187 // qualified lookup of T1::operator@ (13.3.1.1.1); otherwise, 7188 // the set of member candidates is empty. 7189 if (const RecordType *T1Rec = T1->getAs<RecordType>()) { 7190 // Complete the type if it can be completed. 7191 if (!isCompleteType(OpLoc, T1) && !T1Rec->isBeingDefined()) 7192 return; 7193 // If the type is neither complete nor being defined, bail out now. 7194 if (!T1Rec->getDecl()->getDefinition()) 7195 return; 7196 7197 LookupResult Operators(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 7198 LookupQualifiedName(Operators, T1Rec->getDecl()); 7199 Operators.suppressDiagnostics(); 7200 7201 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = Operators.begin(), 7202 OperEnd = Operators.end(); 7203 Oper != OperEnd; 7204 ++Oper) 7205 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Args[0]->getType(), 7206 Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args.slice(1), 7207 CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false); 7208 } 7209 } 7210 7211 /// AddBuiltinCandidate - Add a candidate for a built-in 7212 /// operator. ResultTy and ParamTys are the result and parameter types 7213 /// of the built-in candidate, respectively. Args and NumArgs are the 7214 /// arguments being passed to the candidate. IsAssignmentOperator 7215 /// should be true when this built-in candidate is an assignment 7216 /// operator. NumContextualBoolArguments is the number of arguments 7217 /// (at the beginning of the argument list) that will be contextually 7218 /// converted to bool. 7219 void Sema::AddBuiltinCandidate(QualType *ParamTys, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 7220 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 7221 bool IsAssignmentOperator, 7222 unsigned NumContextualBoolArguments) { 7223 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context. 7224 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 7225 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 7226 7227 // Add this candidate 7228 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size()); 7229 Candidate.FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(nullptr, AS_none); 7230 Candidate.Function = nullptr; 7231 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false; 7232 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false; 7233 std::copy(ParamTys, ParamTys + Args.size(), Candidate.BuiltinParamTypes); 7234 7235 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the 7236 // arguments. 7237 Candidate.Viable = true; 7238 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size(); 7239 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 7240 // C++ [over.match.oper]p4: 7241 // For the built-in assignment operators, conversions of the 7242 // left operand are restricted as follows: 7243 // -- no temporaries are introduced to hold the left operand, and 7244 // -- no user-defined conversions are applied to the left 7245 // operand to achieve a type match with the left-most 7246 // parameter of a built-in candidate. 7247 // 7248 // We block these conversions by turning off user-defined 7249 // conversions, since that is the only way that initialization of 7250 // a reference to a non-class type can occur from something that 7251 // is not of the same type. 7252 if (ArgIdx < NumContextualBoolArguments) { 7253 assert(ParamTys[ArgIdx] == Context.BoolTy && 7254 "Contextual conversion to bool requires bool type"); 7255 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx] 7256 = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, Args[ArgIdx]); 7257 } else { 7258 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx] 7259 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTys[ArgIdx], 7260 ArgIdx == 0 && IsAssignmentOperator, 7261 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 7262 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 7263 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 7264 } 7265 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) { 7266 Candidate.Viable = false; 7267 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion; 7268 break; 7269 } 7270 } 7271 } 7272 7273 namespace { 7274 7275 /// BuiltinCandidateTypeSet - A set of types that will be used for the 7276 /// candidate operator functions for built-in operators (C++ 7277 /// [over.built]). The types are separated into pointer types and 7278 /// enumeration types. 7279 class BuiltinCandidateTypeSet { 7280 /// TypeSet - A set of types. 7281 typedef llvm::SetVector<QualType, SmallVector<QualType, 8>, 7282 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8>> TypeSet; 7283 7284 /// PointerTypes - The set of pointer types that will be used in the 7285 /// built-in candidates. 7286 TypeSet PointerTypes; 7287 7288 /// MemberPointerTypes - The set of member pointer types that will be 7289 /// used in the built-in candidates. 7290 TypeSet MemberPointerTypes; 7291 7292 /// EnumerationTypes - The set of enumeration types that will be 7293 /// used in the built-in candidates. 7294 TypeSet EnumerationTypes; 7295 7296 /// The set of vector types that will be used in the built-in 7297 /// candidates. 7298 TypeSet VectorTypes; 7299 7300 /// A flag indicating non-record types are viable candidates 7301 bool HasNonRecordTypes; 7302 7303 /// A flag indicating whether either arithmetic or enumeration types 7304 /// were present in the candidate set. 7305 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; 7306 7307 /// A flag indicating whether the nullptr type was present in the 7308 /// candidate set. 7309 bool HasNullPtrType; 7310 7311 /// Sema - The semantic analysis instance where we are building the 7312 /// candidate type set. 7313 Sema &SemaRef; 7314 7315 /// Context - The AST context in which we will build the type sets. 7316 ASTContext &Context; 7317 7318 bool AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty, 7319 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals); 7320 bool AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty); 7321 7322 public: 7323 /// iterator - Iterates through the types that are part of the set. 7324 typedef TypeSet::iterator iterator; 7325 7326 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(Sema &SemaRef) 7327 : HasNonRecordTypes(false), 7328 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(false), 7329 HasNullPtrType(false), 7330 SemaRef(SemaRef), 7331 Context(SemaRef.Context) { } 7332 7333 void AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty, 7334 SourceLocation Loc, 7335 bool AllowUserConversions, 7336 bool AllowExplicitConversions, 7337 const Qualifiers &VisibleTypeConversionsQuals); 7338 7339 /// pointer_begin - First pointer type found; 7340 iterator pointer_begin() { return PointerTypes.begin(); } 7341 7342 /// pointer_end - Past the last pointer type found; 7343 iterator pointer_end() { return PointerTypes.end(); } 7344 7345 /// member_pointer_begin - First member pointer type found; 7346 iterator member_pointer_begin() { return MemberPointerTypes.begin(); } 7347 7348 /// member_pointer_end - Past the last member pointer type found; 7349 iterator member_pointer_end() { return MemberPointerTypes.end(); } 7350 7351 /// enumeration_begin - First enumeration type found; 7352 iterator enumeration_begin() { return EnumerationTypes.begin(); } 7353 7354 /// enumeration_end - Past the last enumeration type found; 7355 iterator enumeration_end() { return EnumerationTypes.end(); } 7356 7357 iterator vector_begin() { return VectorTypes.begin(); } 7358 iterator vector_end() { return VectorTypes.end(); } 7359 7360 bool hasNonRecordTypes() { return HasNonRecordTypes; } 7361 bool hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes() { return HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; } 7362 bool hasNullPtrType() const { return HasNullPtrType; } 7363 }; 7364 7365 } // end anonymous namespace 7366 7367 /// AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty to 7368 /// the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of 7369 /// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine 7370 /// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const 7371 /// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of 7372 /// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded, 7373 /// false otherwise. 7374 /// 7375 /// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers? 7376 bool 7377 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty, 7378 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) { 7379 7380 // Insert this type. 7381 if (!PointerTypes.insert(Ty)) 7382 return false; 7383 7384 QualType PointeeTy; 7385 const PointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<PointerType>(); 7386 bool buildObjCPtr = false; 7387 if (!PointerTy) { 7388 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = Ty->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 7389 PointeeTy = PTy->getPointeeType(); 7390 buildObjCPtr = true; 7391 } else { 7392 PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType(); 7393 } 7394 7395 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed 7396 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the 7397 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int, 7398 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway. 7399 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType()) 7400 return true; 7401 7402 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers(); 7403 bool hasVolatile = VisibleQuals.hasVolatile(); 7404 bool hasRestrict = VisibleQuals.hasRestrict(); 7405 7406 // Iterate through all strict supersets of BaseCVR. 7407 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) { 7408 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue; 7409 // Skip over volatile if no volatile found anywhere in the types. 7410 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Volatile) && !hasVolatile) continue; 7411 7412 // Skip over restrict if no restrict found anywhere in the types, or if 7413 // the type cannot be restrict-qualified. 7414 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Restrict) && 7415 (!hasRestrict || 7416 (!(PointeeTy->isAnyPointerType() || PointeeTy->isReferenceType())))) 7417 continue; 7418 7419 // Build qualified pointee type. 7420 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR); 7421 7422 // Build qualified pointer type. 7423 QualType QPointerTy; 7424 if (!buildObjCPtr) 7425 QPointerTy = Context.getPointerType(QPointeeTy); 7426 else 7427 QPointerTy = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QPointeeTy); 7428 7429 // Insert qualified pointer type. 7430 PointerTypes.insert(QPointerTy); 7431 } 7432 7433 return true; 7434 } 7435 7436 /// AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty 7437 /// to the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of 7438 /// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine 7439 /// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const 7440 /// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of 7441 /// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded, 7442 /// false otherwise. 7443 /// 7444 /// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers? 7445 bool 7446 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants( 7447 QualType Ty) { 7448 // Insert this type. 7449 if (!MemberPointerTypes.insert(Ty)) 7450 return false; 7451 7452 const MemberPointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>(); 7453 assert(PointerTy && "type was not a member pointer type!"); 7454 7455 QualType PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType(); 7456 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed 7457 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the 7458 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int, 7459 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway. 7460 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType()) 7461 return true; 7462 const Type *ClassTy = PointerTy->getClass(); 7463 7464 // Iterate through all strict supersets of the pointee type's CVR 7465 // qualifiers. 7466 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers(); 7467 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) { 7468 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue; 7469 7470 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR); 7471 MemberPointerTypes.insert( 7472 Context.getMemberPointerType(QPointeeTy, ClassTy)); 7473 } 7474 7475 return true; 7476 } 7477 7478 /// AddTypesConvertedFrom - Add each of the types to which the type @p 7479 /// Ty can be implicit converted to the given set of @p Types. We're 7480 /// primarily interested in pointer types and enumeration types. We also 7481 /// take member pointer types, for the conditional operator. 7482 /// AllowUserConversions is true if we should look at the conversion 7483 /// functions of a class type, and AllowExplicitConversions if we 7484 /// should also include the explicit conversion functions of a class 7485 /// type. 7486 void 7487 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty, 7488 SourceLocation Loc, 7489 bool AllowUserConversions, 7490 bool AllowExplicitConversions, 7491 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) { 7492 // Only deal with canonical types. 7493 Ty = Context.getCanonicalType(Ty); 7494 7495 // Look through reference types; they aren't part of the type of an 7496 // expression for the purposes of conversions. 7497 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Ty->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 7498 Ty = RefTy->getPointeeType(); 7499 7500 // If we're dealing with an array type, decay to the pointer. 7501 if (Ty->isArrayType()) 7502 Ty = SemaRef.Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty); 7503 7504 // Otherwise, we don't care about qualifiers on the type. 7505 Ty = Ty.getLocalUnqualifiedType(); 7506 7507 // Flag if we ever add a non-record type. 7508 const RecordType *TyRec = Ty->getAs<RecordType>(); 7509 HasNonRecordTypes = HasNonRecordTypes || !TyRec; 7510 7511 // Flag if we encounter an arithmetic type. 7512 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = 7513 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes || Ty->isArithmeticType(); 7514 7515 if (Ty->isObjCIdType() || Ty->isObjCClassType()) 7516 PointerTypes.insert(Ty); 7517 else if (Ty->getAs<PointerType>() || Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 7518 // Insert our type, and its more-qualified variants, into the set 7519 // of types. 7520 if (!AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty, VisibleQuals)) 7521 return; 7522 } else if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) { 7523 // Member pointers are far easier, since the pointee can't be converted. 7524 if (!AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty)) 7525 return; 7526 } else if (Ty->isEnumeralType()) { 7527 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true; 7528 EnumerationTypes.insert(Ty); 7529 } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) { 7530 // We treat vector types as arithmetic types in many contexts as an 7531 // extension. 7532 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true; 7533 VectorTypes.insert(Ty); 7534 } else if (Ty->isNullPtrType()) { 7535 HasNullPtrType = true; 7536 } else if (AllowUserConversions && TyRec) { 7537 // No conversion functions in incomplete types. 7538 if (!SemaRef.isCompleteType(Loc, Ty)) 7539 return; 7540 7541 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl()); 7542 for (NamedDecl *D : ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions()) { 7543 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 7544 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 7545 7546 // Skip conversion function templates; they don't tell us anything 7547 // about which builtin types we can convert to. 7548 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)) 7549 continue; 7550 7551 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 7552 if (AllowExplicitConversions || !Conv->isExplicit()) { 7553 AddTypesConvertedFrom(Conv->getConversionType(), Loc, false, false, 7554 VisibleQuals); 7555 } 7556 } 7557 } 7558 } 7559 7560 /// Helper function for AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates() that adds 7561 /// the volatile- and non-volatile-qualified assignment operators for the 7562 /// given type to the candidate set. 7563 static void AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(Sema &S, 7564 QualType T, 7565 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 7566 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) { 7567 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 7568 7569 // T& operator=(T&, T) 7570 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T); 7571 ParamTypes[1] = T; 7572 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 7573 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true); 7574 7575 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(T).isVolatileQualified()) { 7576 // volatile T& operator=(volatile T&, T) 7577 ParamTypes[0] 7578 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(T)); 7579 ParamTypes[1] = T; 7580 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 7581 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true); 7582 } 7583 } 7584 7585 /// CollectVRQualifiers - This routine returns Volatile/Restrict qualifiers, 7586 /// if any, found in visible type conversion functions found in ArgExpr's type. 7587 static Qualifiers CollectVRQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, Expr* ArgExpr) { 7588 Qualifiers VRQuals; 7589 const RecordType *TyRec; 7590 if (const MemberPointerType *RHSMPType = 7591 ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 7592 TyRec = RHSMPType->getClass()->getAs<RecordType>(); 7593 else 7594 TyRec = ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<RecordType>(); 7595 if (!TyRec) { 7596 // Just to be safe, assume the worst case. 7597 VRQuals.addVolatile(); 7598 VRQuals.addRestrict(); 7599 return VRQuals; 7600 } 7601 7602 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl()); 7603 if (!ClassDecl->hasDefinition()) 7604 return VRQuals; 7605 7606 for (NamedDecl *D : ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions()) { 7607 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 7608 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 7609 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conv = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D)) { 7610 QualType CanTy = Context.getCanonicalType(Conv->getConversionType()); 7611 if (const ReferenceType *ResTypeRef = CanTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 7612 CanTy = ResTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 7613 // Need to go down the pointer/mempointer chain and add qualifiers 7614 // as see them. 7615 bool done = false; 7616 while (!done) { 7617 if (CanTy.isRestrictQualified()) 7618 VRQuals.addRestrict(); 7619 if (const PointerType *ResTypePtr = CanTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 7620 CanTy = ResTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 7621 else if (const MemberPointerType *ResTypeMPtr = 7622 CanTy->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 7623 CanTy = ResTypeMPtr->getPointeeType(); 7624 else 7625 done = true; 7626 if (CanTy.isVolatileQualified()) 7627 VRQuals.addVolatile(); 7628 if (VRQuals.hasRestrict() && VRQuals.hasVolatile()) 7629 return VRQuals; 7630 } 7631 } 7632 } 7633 return VRQuals; 7634 } 7635 7636 namespace { 7637 7638 /// Helper class to manage the addition of builtin operator overload 7639 /// candidates. It provides shared state and utility methods used throughout 7640 /// the process, as well as a helper method to add each group of builtin 7641 /// operator overloads from the standard to a candidate set. 7642 class BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder { 7643 // Common instance state available to all overload candidate addition methods. 7644 Sema &S; 7645 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args; 7646 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals; 7647 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType; 7648 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes; 7649 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet; 7650 7651 static constexpr int ArithmeticTypesCap = 24; 7652 SmallVector<CanQualType, ArithmeticTypesCap> ArithmeticTypes; 7653 7654 // Define some indices used to iterate over the arithemetic types in 7655 // ArithmeticTypes. The "promoted arithmetic types" are the arithmetic 7656 // types are that preserved by promotion (C++ [over.built]p2). 7657 unsigned FirstIntegralType, 7658 LastIntegralType; 7659 unsigned FirstPromotedIntegralType, 7660 LastPromotedIntegralType; 7661 unsigned FirstPromotedArithmeticType, 7662 LastPromotedArithmeticType; 7663 unsigned NumArithmeticTypes; 7664 7665 void InitArithmeticTypes() { 7666 // Start of promoted types. 7667 FirstPromotedArithmeticType = 0; 7668 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.FloatTy); 7669 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.DoubleTy); 7670 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.LongDoubleTy); 7671 if (S.Context.getTargetInfo().hasFloat128Type()) 7672 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Float128Ty); 7673 7674 // Start of integral types. 7675 FirstIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size(); 7676 FirstPromotedIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size(); 7677 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.IntTy); 7678 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.LongTy); 7679 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.LongLongTy); 7680 if (S.Context.getTargetInfo().hasInt128Type()) 7681 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Int128Ty); 7682 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedIntTy); 7683 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedLongTy); 7684 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy); 7685 if (S.Context.getTargetInfo().hasInt128Type()) 7686 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedInt128Ty); 7687 LastPromotedIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size(); 7688 LastPromotedArithmeticType = ArithmeticTypes.size(); 7689 // End of promoted types. 7690 7691 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.BoolTy); 7692 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.CharTy); 7693 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.WCharTy); 7694 if (S.Context.getLangOpts().Char8) 7695 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Char8Ty); 7696 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Char16Ty); 7697 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Char32Ty); 7698 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.SignedCharTy); 7699 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.ShortTy); 7700 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedCharTy); 7701 ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedShortTy); 7702 LastIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size(); 7703 NumArithmeticTypes = ArithmeticTypes.size(); 7704 // End of integral types. 7705 // FIXME: What about complex? What about half? 7706 7707 assert(ArithmeticTypes.size() <= ArithmeticTypesCap && 7708 "Enough inline storage for all arithmetic types."); 7709 } 7710 7711 /// Helper method to factor out the common pattern of adding overloads 7712 /// for '++' and '--' builtin operators. 7713 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(QualType CandidateTy, 7714 bool HasVolatile, 7715 bool HasRestrict) { 7716 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { 7717 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(CandidateTy), 7718 S.Context.IntTy 7719 }; 7720 7721 // Non-volatile version. 7722 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 7723 7724 // Use a heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set: 7725 // add volatile version only if there are conversions to a volatile type. 7726 if (HasVolatile) { 7727 ParamTypes[0] = 7728 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 7729 S.Context.getVolatileType(CandidateTy)); 7730 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 7731 } 7732 7733 // Add restrict version only if there are conversions to a restrict type 7734 // and our candidate type is a non-restrict-qualified pointer. 7735 if (HasRestrict && CandidateTy->isAnyPointerType() && 7736 !CandidateTy.isRestrictQualified()) { 7737 ParamTypes[0] 7738 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 7739 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy, Qualifiers::Restrict)); 7740 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 7741 7742 if (HasVolatile) { 7743 ParamTypes[0] 7744 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 7745 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy, 7746 (Qualifiers::Volatile | 7747 Qualifiers::Restrict))); 7748 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 7749 } 7750 } 7751 7752 } 7753 7754 public: 7755 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder( 7756 Sema &S, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 7757 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals, 7758 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType, 7759 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes, 7760 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) 7761 : S(S), Args(Args), 7762 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals(VisibleTypeConversionsQuals), 7763 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType( 7764 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType), 7765 CandidateTypes(CandidateTypes), 7766 CandidateSet(CandidateSet) { 7767 7768 InitArithmeticTypes(); 7769 } 7770 7771 // Increment is deprecated for bool since C++17. 7772 // 7773 // C++ [over.built]p3: 7774 // 7775 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other 7776 // than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist 7777 // candidate operator functions of the form 7778 // 7779 // VQ T& operator++(VQ T&); 7780 // T operator++(VQ T&, int); 7781 // 7782 // C++ [over.built]p4: 7783 // 7784 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other 7785 // than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist 7786 // candidate operator functions of the form 7787 // 7788 // VQ T& operator--(VQ T&); 7789 // T operator--(VQ T&, int); 7790 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) { 7791 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 7792 return; 7793 7794 for (unsigned Arith = 0; Arith < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Arith) { 7795 const auto TypeOfT = ArithmeticTypes[Arith]; 7796 if (TypeOfT == S.Context.BoolTy) { 7797 if (Op == OO_MinusMinus) 7798 continue; 7799 if (Op == OO_PlusPlus && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17) 7800 continue; 7801 } 7802 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads( 7803 TypeOfT, 7804 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile(), 7805 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()); 7806 } 7807 } 7808 7809 // C++ [over.built]p5: 7810 // 7811 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or 7812 // cv-unqualified object type, and VQ is either volatile or 7813 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 7814 // 7815 // T*VQ& operator++(T*VQ&); 7816 // T*VQ& operator--(T*VQ&); 7817 // T* operator++(T*VQ&, int); 7818 // T* operator--(T*VQ&, int); 7819 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads() { 7820 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 7821 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 7822 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 7823 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 7824 // Skip pointer types that aren't pointers to object types. 7825 if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType()) 7826 continue; 7827 7828 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(*Ptr, 7829 (!(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() && 7830 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()), 7831 (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() && 7832 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict())); 7833 } 7834 } 7835 7836 // C++ [over.built]p6: 7837 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T, there 7838 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 7839 // 7840 // T& operator*(T*); 7841 // 7842 // C++ [over.built]p7: 7843 // For every function type T that does not have cv-qualifiers or a 7844 // ref-qualifier, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 7845 // T& operator*(T*); 7846 void addUnaryStarPointerOverloads() { 7847 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 7848 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 7849 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 7850 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 7851 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr; 7852 QualType PointeeTy = ParamTy->getPointeeType(); 7853 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType() && !PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) 7854 continue; 7855 7856 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto =PointeeTy->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 7857 if (Proto->getTypeQuals() || Proto->getRefQualifier()) 7858 continue; 7859 7860 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet); 7861 } 7862 } 7863 7864 // C++ [over.built]p9: 7865 // For every promoted arithmetic type T, there exist candidate 7866 // operator functions of the form 7867 // 7868 // T operator+(T); 7869 // T operator-(T); 7870 void addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads() { 7871 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 7872 return; 7873 7874 for (unsigned Arith = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 7875 Arith < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Arith) { 7876 QualType ArithTy = ArithmeticTypes[Arith]; 7877 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ArithTy, Args, CandidateSet); 7878 } 7879 7880 // Extension: We also add these operators for vector types. 7881 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 7882 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(), 7883 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end(); 7884 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) { 7885 QualType VecTy = *Vec; 7886 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&VecTy, Args, CandidateSet); 7887 } 7888 } 7889 7890 // C++ [over.built]p8: 7891 // For every type T, there exist candidate operator functions of 7892 // the form 7893 // 7894 // T* operator+(T*); 7895 void addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads() { 7896 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 7897 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 7898 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 7899 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 7900 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr; 7901 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet); 7902 } 7903 } 7904 7905 // C++ [over.built]p10: 7906 // For every promoted integral type T, there exist candidate 7907 // operator functions of the form 7908 // 7909 // T operator~(T); 7910 void addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads() { 7911 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 7912 return; 7913 7914 for (unsigned Int = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 7915 Int < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Int) { 7916 QualType IntTy = ArithmeticTypes[Int]; 7917 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&IntTy, Args, CandidateSet); 7918 } 7919 7920 // Extension: We also add this operator for vector types. 7921 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 7922 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(), 7923 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end(); 7924 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) { 7925 QualType VecTy = *Vec; 7926 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&VecTy, Args, CandidateSet); 7927 } 7928 } 7929 7930 // C++ [over.match.oper]p16: 7931 // For every pointer to member type T or type std::nullptr_t, there 7932 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 7933 // 7934 // bool operator==(T,T); 7935 // bool operator!=(T,T); 7936 void addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOrNullptrOverloads() { 7937 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 7938 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 7939 7940 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 7941 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 7942 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(), 7943 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end(); 7944 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; 7945 ++MemPtr) { 7946 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice. 7947 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)).second) 7948 continue; 7949 7950 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr }; 7951 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 7952 } 7953 7954 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNullPtrType()) { 7955 CanQualType NullPtrTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(S.Context.NullPtrTy); 7956 if (AddedTypes.insert(NullPtrTy).second) { 7957 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { NullPtrTy, NullPtrTy }; 7958 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 7959 } 7960 } 7961 } 7962 } 7963 7964 // C++ [over.built]p15: 7965 // 7966 // For every T, where T is an enumeration type or a pointer type, 7967 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form 7968 // 7969 // bool operator<(T, T); 7970 // bool operator>(T, T); 7971 // bool operator<=(T, T); 7972 // bool operator>=(T, T); 7973 // bool operator==(T, T); 7974 // bool operator!=(T, T); 7975 // R operator<=>(T, T) 7976 void addGenericBinaryPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() { 7977 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 7978 // [...]the built-in candidates include all of the candidate operator 7979 // functions defined in 13.6 that, compared to the given operator, [...] 7980 // do not have the same parameter-type-list as any non-template non-member 7981 // candidate. 7982 // 7983 // Note that in practice, this only affects enumeration types because there 7984 // aren't any built-in candidates of record type, and a user-defined operator 7985 // must have an operand of record or enumeration type. Also, the only other 7986 // overloaded operator with enumeration arguments, operator=, 7987 // cannot be overloaded for enumeration types, so this is the only place 7988 // where we must suppress candidates like this. 7989 llvm::DenseSet<std::pair<CanQualType, CanQualType> > 7990 UserDefinedBinaryOperators; 7991 7992 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 7993 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin() != 7994 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end()) { 7995 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator C = CandidateSet.begin(), 7996 CEnd = CandidateSet.end(); 7997 C != CEnd; ++C) { 7998 if (!C->Viable || !C->Function || C->Function->getNumParams() != 2) 7999 continue; 8000 8001 if (C->Function->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization()) 8002 continue; 8003 8004 QualType FirstParamType = 8005 C->Function->getParamDecl(0)->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 8006 QualType SecondParamType = 8007 C->Function->getParamDecl(1)->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 8008 8009 // Skip if either parameter isn't of enumeral type. 8010 if (!FirstParamType->isEnumeralType() || 8011 !SecondParamType->isEnumeralType()) 8012 continue; 8013 8014 // Add this operator to the set of known user-defined operators. 8015 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.insert( 8016 std::make_pair(S.Context.getCanonicalType(FirstParamType), 8017 S.Context.getCanonicalType(SecondParamType))); 8018 } 8019 } 8020 } 8021 8022 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 8023 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 8024 8025 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 8026 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8027 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(), 8028 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end(); 8029 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8030 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice. 8031 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)).second) 8032 continue; 8033 8034 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr }; 8035 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8036 } 8037 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8038 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(), 8039 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end(); 8040 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) { 8041 CanQualType CanonType = S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum); 8042 8043 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice, or if a user defined 8044 // candidate exists. 8045 if (!AddedTypes.insert(CanonType).second || 8046 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(CanonType, 8047 CanonType))) 8048 continue; 8049 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum }; 8050 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8051 } 8052 } 8053 } 8054 8055 // C++ [over.built]p13: 8056 // 8057 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T 8058 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8059 // 8060 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); 8061 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); [BELOW] 8062 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); 8063 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); 8064 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); [BELOW] 8065 // 8066 // C++ [over.built]p14: 8067 // 8068 // For every T, where T is a pointer to object type, there 8069 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 8070 // 8071 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T); 8072 void addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) { 8073 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 8074 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 8075 8076 for (int Arg = 0; Arg < 2; ++Arg) { 8077 QualType AsymmetricParamTypes[2] = { 8078 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), 8079 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), 8080 }; 8081 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8082 Ptr = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_begin(), 8083 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_end(); 8084 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8085 QualType PointeeTy = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType(); 8086 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType()) 8087 continue; 8088 8089 AsymmetricParamTypes[Arg] = *Ptr; 8090 if (Arg == 0 || Op == OO_Plus) { 8091 // operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t) or operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t) 8092 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); 8093 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(AsymmetricParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8094 } 8095 if (Op == OO_Minus) { 8096 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T); 8097 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)).second) 8098 continue; 8099 8100 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr }; 8101 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8102 } 8103 } 8104 } 8105 } 8106 8107 // C++ [over.built]p12: 8108 // 8109 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there 8110 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 8111 // 8112 // LR operator*(L, R); 8113 // LR operator/(L, R); 8114 // LR operator+(L, R); 8115 // LR operator-(L, R); 8116 // bool operator<(L, R); 8117 // bool operator>(L, R); 8118 // bool operator<=(L, R); 8119 // bool operator>=(L, R); 8120 // bool operator==(L, R); 8121 // bool operator!=(L, R); 8122 // 8123 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions 8124 // between types L and R. 8125 // 8126 // C++ [over.built]p24: 8127 // 8128 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there exist 8129 // candidate operator functions of the form 8130 // 8131 // LR operator?(bool, L, R); 8132 // 8133 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions 8134 // between types L and R. 8135 // Our candidates ignore the first parameter. 8136 void addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads() { 8137 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8138 return; 8139 8140 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 8141 Left < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Left) { 8142 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 8143 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) { 8144 QualType LandR[2] = { ArithmeticTypes[Left], 8145 ArithmeticTypes[Right] }; 8146 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet); 8147 } 8148 } 8149 8150 // Extension: Add the binary operators ==, !=, <, <=, >=, >, *, /, and the 8151 // conditional operator for vector types. 8152 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8153 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(), 8154 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end(); 8155 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) { 8156 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8157 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(), 8158 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end(); 8159 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) { 8160 QualType LandR[2] = { *Vec1, *Vec2 }; 8161 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet); 8162 } 8163 } 8164 } 8165 8166 // C++2a [over.built]p14: 8167 // 8168 // For every integral type T there exists a candidate operator function 8169 // of the form 8170 // 8171 // std::strong_ordering operator<=>(T, T) 8172 // 8173 // C++2a [over.built]p15: 8174 // 8175 // For every pair of floating-point types L and R, there exists a candidate 8176 // operator function of the form 8177 // 8178 // std::partial_ordering operator<=>(L, R); 8179 // 8180 // FIXME: The current specification for integral types doesn't play nice with 8181 // the direction of p0946r0, which allows mixed integral and unscoped-enum 8182 // comparisons. Under the current spec this can lead to ambiguity during 8183 // overload resolution. For example: 8184 // 8185 // enum A : int {a}; 8186 // auto x = (a <=> (long)42); 8187 // 8188 // error: call is ambiguous for arguments 'A' and 'long'. 8189 // note: candidate operator<=>(int, int) 8190 // note: candidate operator<=>(long, long) 8191 // 8192 // To avoid this error, this function deviates from the specification and adds 8193 // the mixed overloads `operator<=>(L, R)` where L and R are promoted 8194 // arithmetic types (the same as the generic relational overloads). 8195 // 8196 // For now this function acts as a placeholder. 8197 void addThreeWayArithmeticOverloads() { 8198 addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 8199 } 8200 8201 // C++ [over.built]p17: 8202 // 8203 // For every pair of promoted integral types L and R, there 8204 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 8205 // 8206 // LR operator%(L, R); 8207 // LR operator&(L, R); 8208 // LR operator^(L, R); 8209 // LR operator|(L, R); 8210 // L operator<<(L, R); 8211 // L operator>>(L, R); 8212 // 8213 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions 8214 // between types L and R. 8215 void addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) { 8216 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8217 return; 8218 8219 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 8220 Left < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Left) { 8221 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 8222 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) { 8223 QualType LandR[2] = { ArithmeticTypes[Left], 8224 ArithmeticTypes[Right] }; 8225 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet); 8226 } 8227 } 8228 } 8229 8230 // C++ [over.built]p20: 8231 // 8232 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an enumeration or 8233 // pointer to member type and VQ is either volatile or 8234 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8235 // 8236 // VQ T& operator=(VQ T&, T); 8237 void addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() { 8238 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 8239 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 8240 8241 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) { 8242 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8243 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(), 8244 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end(); 8245 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) { 8246 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)).second) 8247 continue; 8248 8249 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *Enum, Args, CandidateSet); 8250 } 8251 8252 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8253 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(), 8254 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end(); 8255 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) { 8256 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)).second) 8257 continue; 8258 8259 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *MemPtr, Args, CandidateSet); 8260 } 8261 } 8262 } 8263 8264 // C++ [over.built]p19: 8265 // 8266 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is any type and VQ is either 8267 // volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator functions 8268 // of the form 8269 // 8270 // T*VQ& operator=(T*VQ&, T*); 8271 // 8272 // C++ [over.built]p21: 8273 // 8274 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or 8275 // cv-unqualified object type and VQ is either volatile or 8276 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8277 // 8278 // T*VQ& operator+=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t); 8279 // T*VQ& operator-=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t); 8280 void addAssignmentPointerOverloads(bool isEqualOp) { 8281 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 8282 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 8283 8284 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8285 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 8286 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 8287 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8288 // If this is operator=, keep track of the builtin candidates we added. 8289 if (isEqualOp) 8290 AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)); 8291 else if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType()) 8292 continue; 8293 8294 // non-volatile version 8295 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { 8296 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr), 8297 isEqualOp ? *Ptr : S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), 8298 }; 8299 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8300 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/ isEqualOp); 8301 8302 bool NeedVolatile = !(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() && 8303 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile(); 8304 if (NeedVolatile) { 8305 // volatile version 8306 ParamTypes[0] = 8307 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr)); 8308 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8309 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8310 } 8311 8312 if (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() && 8313 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) { 8314 // restrict version 8315 ParamTypes[0] 8316 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(*Ptr)); 8317 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8318 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8319 8320 if (NeedVolatile) { 8321 // volatile restrict version 8322 ParamTypes[0] 8323 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 8324 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(*Ptr, 8325 (Qualifiers::Volatile | 8326 Qualifiers::Restrict))); 8327 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8328 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8329 } 8330 } 8331 } 8332 8333 if (isEqualOp) { 8334 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8335 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(), 8336 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end(); 8337 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8338 // Make sure we don't add the same candidate twice. 8339 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)).second) 8340 continue; 8341 8342 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { 8343 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr), 8344 *Ptr, 8345 }; 8346 8347 // non-volatile version 8348 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8349 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true); 8350 8351 bool NeedVolatile = !(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() && 8352 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile(); 8353 if (NeedVolatile) { 8354 // volatile version 8355 ParamTypes[0] = 8356 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr)); 8357 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8358 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true); 8359 } 8360 8361 if (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() && 8362 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) { 8363 // restrict version 8364 ParamTypes[0] 8365 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(*Ptr)); 8366 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8367 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true); 8368 8369 if (NeedVolatile) { 8370 // volatile restrict version 8371 ParamTypes[0] 8372 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType( 8373 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(*Ptr, 8374 (Qualifiers::Volatile | 8375 Qualifiers::Restrict))); 8376 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8377 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true); 8378 } 8379 } 8380 } 8381 } 8382 } 8383 8384 // C++ [over.built]p18: 8385 // 8386 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an arithmetic type, 8387 // VQ is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted 8388 // arithmetic type, there exist candidate operator functions of 8389 // the form 8390 // 8391 // VQ L& operator=(VQ L&, R); 8392 // VQ L& operator*=(VQ L&, R); 8393 // VQ L& operator/=(VQ L&, R); 8394 // VQ L& operator+=(VQ L&, R); 8395 // VQ L& operator-=(VQ L&, R); 8396 void addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(bool isEqualOp) { 8397 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8398 return; 8399 8400 for (unsigned Left = 0; Left < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Left) { 8401 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType; 8402 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) { 8403 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 8404 ParamTypes[1] = ArithmeticTypes[Right]; 8405 8406 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty). 8407 ParamTypes[0] = 8408 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ArithmeticTypes[Left]); 8409 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8410 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8411 8412 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile'). 8413 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) { 8414 ParamTypes[0] = 8415 S.Context.getVolatileType(ArithmeticTypes[Left]); 8416 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]); 8417 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8418 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8419 } 8420 } 8421 } 8422 8423 // Extension: Add the binary operators =, +=, -=, *=, /= for vector types. 8424 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8425 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(), 8426 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end(); 8427 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) { 8428 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8429 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(), 8430 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end(); 8431 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) { 8432 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 8433 ParamTypes[1] = *Vec2; 8434 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty). 8435 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Vec1); 8436 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8437 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8438 8439 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile'). 8440 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) { 8441 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(*Vec1); 8442 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]); 8443 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8444 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp); 8445 } 8446 } 8447 } 8448 } 8449 8450 // C++ [over.built]p22: 8451 // 8452 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an integral type, VQ 8453 // is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted integral 8454 // type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8455 // 8456 // VQ L& operator%=(VQ L&, R); 8457 // VQ L& operator<<=(VQ L&, R); 8458 // VQ L& operator>>=(VQ L&, R); 8459 // VQ L& operator&=(VQ L&, R); 8460 // VQ L& operator^=(VQ L&, R); 8461 // VQ L& operator|=(VQ L&, R); 8462 void addAssignmentIntegralOverloads() { 8463 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType) 8464 return; 8465 8466 for (unsigned Left = FirstIntegralType; Left < LastIntegralType; ++Left) { 8467 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType; 8468 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) { 8469 QualType ParamTypes[2]; 8470 ParamTypes[1] = ArithmeticTypes[Right]; 8471 8472 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty). 8473 ParamTypes[0] = 8474 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ArithmeticTypes[Left]); 8475 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8476 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) { 8477 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile'). 8478 ParamTypes[0] = ArithmeticTypes[Left]; 8479 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(ParamTypes[0]); 8480 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]); 8481 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8482 } 8483 } 8484 } 8485 } 8486 8487 // C++ [over.operator]p23: 8488 // 8489 // There also exist candidate operator functions of the form 8490 // 8491 // bool operator!(bool); 8492 // bool operator&&(bool, bool); 8493 // bool operator||(bool, bool); 8494 void addExclaimOverload() { 8495 QualType ParamTy = S.Context.BoolTy; 8496 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet, 8497 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false, 8498 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/1); 8499 } 8500 void addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload() { 8501 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.BoolTy, S.Context.BoolTy }; 8502 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, 8503 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false, 8504 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/2); 8505 } 8506 8507 // C++ [over.built]p13: 8508 // 8509 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T there 8510 // exist candidate operator functions of the form 8511 // 8512 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE] 8513 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); 8514 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE] 8515 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); [ABOVE] 8516 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); 8517 void addSubscriptOverloads() { 8518 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8519 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 8520 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 8521 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8522 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, S.Context.getPointerDiffType() }; 8523 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType(); 8524 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType()) 8525 continue; 8526 8527 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t) 8528 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8529 } 8530 8531 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8532 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(), 8533 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end(); 8534 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8535 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), *Ptr }; 8536 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType(); 8537 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType()) 8538 continue; 8539 8540 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*) 8541 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8542 } 8543 } 8544 8545 // C++ [over.built]p11: 8546 // For every quintuple (C1, C2, T, CV1, CV2), where C2 is a class type, 8547 // C1 is the same type as C2 or is a derived class of C2, T is an object 8548 // type or a function type, and CV1 and CV2 are cv-qualifier-seqs, 8549 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8550 // 8551 // CV12 T& operator->*(CV1 C1*, CV2 T C2::*); 8552 // 8553 // where CV12 is the union of CV1 and CV2. 8554 void addArrowStarOverloads() { 8555 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8556 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(), 8557 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end(); 8558 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8559 QualType C1Ty = (*Ptr); 8560 QualType C1; 8561 QualifierCollector Q1; 8562 C1 = QualType(Q1.strip(C1Ty->getPointeeType()), 0); 8563 if (!isa<RecordType>(C1)) 8564 continue; 8565 // heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set. 8566 // Add volatile/restrict version only if there are conversions to a 8567 // volatile/restrict type. 8568 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && Q1.hasVolatile()) 8569 continue; 8570 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && Q1.hasRestrict()) 8571 continue; 8572 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8573 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_begin(), 8574 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_end(); 8575 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) { 8576 const MemberPointerType *mptr = cast<MemberPointerType>(*MemPtr); 8577 QualType C2 = QualType(mptr->getClass(), 0); 8578 C2 = C2.getUnqualifiedType(); 8579 if (C1 != C2 && !S.IsDerivedFrom(CandidateSet.getLocation(), C1, C2)) 8580 break; 8581 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *MemPtr }; 8582 // build CV12 T& 8583 QualType T = mptr->getPointeeType(); 8584 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && 8585 T.isVolatileQualified()) 8586 continue; 8587 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && 8588 T.isRestrictQualified()) 8589 continue; 8590 T = Q1.apply(S.Context, T); 8591 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8592 } 8593 } 8594 } 8595 8596 // Note that we don't consider the first argument, since it has been 8597 // contextually converted to bool long ago. The candidates below are 8598 // therefore added as binary. 8599 // 8600 // C++ [over.built]p25: 8601 // For every type T, where T is a pointer, pointer-to-member, or scoped 8602 // enumeration type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form 8603 // 8604 // T operator?(bool, T, T); 8605 // 8606 void addConditionalOperatorOverloads() { 8607 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled. 8608 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes; 8609 8610 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) { 8611 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8612 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(), 8613 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end(); 8614 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) { 8615 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)).second) 8616 continue; 8617 8618 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr }; 8619 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8620 } 8621 8622 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8623 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(), 8624 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end(); 8625 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) { 8626 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)).second) 8627 continue; 8628 8629 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr }; 8630 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8631 } 8632 8633 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) { 8634 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator 8635 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(), 8636 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end(); 8637 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) { 8638 if (!(*Enum)->getAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->isScoped()) 8639 continue; 8640 8641 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)).second) 8642 continue; 8643 8644 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum }; 8645 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet); 8646 } 8647 } 8648 } 8649 } 8650 }; 8651 8652 } // end anonymous namespace 8653 8654 /// AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates - Add the appropriate built-in 8655 /// operator overloads to the candidate set (C++ [over.built]), based 8656 /// on the operator @p Op and the arguments given. For example, if the 8657 /// operator is a binary '+', this routine might add "int 8658 /// operator+(int, int)" to cover integer addition. 8659 void Sema::AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op, 8660 SourceLocation OpLoc, 8661 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 8662 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) { 8663 // Find all of the types that the arguments can convert to, but only 8664 // if the operator we're looking at has built-in operator candidates 8665 // that make use of these types. Also record whether we encounter non-record 8666 // candidate types or either arithmetic or enumeral candidate types. 8667 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals; 8668 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.addConst(); 8669 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) 8670 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals += CollectVRQualifiers(Context, Args[ArgIdx]); 8671 8672 bool HasNonRecordCandidateType = false; 8673 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = false; 8674 SmallVector<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet, 2> CandidateTypes; 8675 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 8676 CandidateTypes.emplace_back(*this); 8677 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].AddTypesConvertedFrom(Args[ArgIdx]->getType(), 8678 OpLoc, 8679 true, 8680 (Op == OO_Exclaim || 8681 Op == OO_AmpAmp || 8682 Op == OO_PipePipe), 8683 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals); 8684 HasNonRecordCandidateType = HasNonRecordCandidateType || 8685 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNonRecordTypes(); 8686 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = 8687 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType || 8688 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(); 8689 } 8690 8691 // Exit early when no non-record types have been added to the candidate set 8692 // for any of the arguments to the operator. 8693 // 8694 // We can't exit early for !, ||, or &&, since there we have always have 8695 // 'bool' overloads. 8696 if (!HasNonRecordCandidateType && 8697 !(Op == OO_Exclaim || Op == OO_AmpAmp || Op == OO_PipePipe)) 8698 return; 8699 8700 // Setup an object to manage the common state for building overloads. 8701 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder OpBuilder(*this, Args, 8702 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals, 8703 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType, 8704 CandidateTypes, CandidateSet); 8705 8706 // Dispatch over the operation to add in only those overloads which apply. 8707 switch (Op) { 8708 case OO_None: 8709 case NUM_OVERLOADED_OPERATORS: 8710 llvm_unreachable("Expected an overloaded operator"); 8711 8712 case OO_New: 8713 case OO_Delete: 8714 case OO_Array_New: 8715 case OO_Array_Delete: 8716 case OO_Call: 8717 llvm_unreachable( 8718 "Special operators don't use AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates"); 8719 8720 case OO_Comma: 8721 case OO_Arrow: 8722 case OO_Coawait: 8723 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 8724 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', the 8725 // operator '->', or the operator 'co_await', the 8726 // built-in candidates set is empty. 8727 break; 8728 8729 case OO_Plus: // '+' is either unary or binary 8730 if (Args.size() == 1) 8731 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads(); 8732 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 8733 8734 case OO_Minus: // '-' is either unary or binary 8735 if (Args.size() == 1) { 8736 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads(); 8737 } else { 8738 OpBuilder.addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(Op); 8739 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 8740 } 8741 break; 8742 8743 case OO_Star: // '*' is either unary or binary 8744 if (Args.size() == 1) 8745 OpBuilder.addUnaryStarPointerOverloads(); 8746 else 8747 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 8748 break; 8749 8750 case OO_Slash: 8751 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 8752 break; 8753 8754 case OO_PlusPlus: 8755 case OO_MinusMinus: 8756 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(Op); 8757 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads(); 8758 break; 8759 8760 case OO_EqualEqual: 8761 case OO_ExclaimEqual: 8762 OpBuilder.addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOrNullptrOverloads(); 8763 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 8764 8765 case OO_Less: 8766 case OO_Greater: 8767 case OO_LessEqual: 8768 case OO_GreaterEqual: 8769 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryPointerOrEnumeralOverloads(); 8770 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 8771 break; 8772 8773 case OO_Spaceship: 8774 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryPointerOrEnumeralOverloads(); 8775 OpBuilder.addThreeWayArithmeticOverloads(); 8776 break; 8777 8778 case OO_Percent: 8779 case OO_Caret: 8780 case OO_Pipe: 8781 case OO_LessLess: 8782 case OO_GreaterGreater: 8783 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op); 8784 break; 8785 8786 case OO_Amp: // '&' is either unary or binary 8787 if (Args.size() == 1) 8788 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3: 8789 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the 8790 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty. 8791 break; 8792 8793 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op); 8794 break; 8795 8796 case OO_Tilde: 8797 OpBuilder.addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads(); 8798 break; 8799 8800 case OO_Equal: 8801 OpBuilder.addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads(); 8802 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 8803 8804 case OO_PlusEqual: 8805 case OO_MinusEqual: 8806 OpBuilder.addAssignmentPointerOverloads(Op == OO_Equal); 8807 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 8808 8809 case OO_StarEqual: 8810 case OO_SlashEqual: 8811 OpBuilder.addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(Op == OO_Equal); 8812 break; 8813 8814 case OO_PercentEqual: 8815 case OO_LessLessEqual: 8816 case OO_GreaterGreaterEqual: 8817 case OO_AmpEqual: 8818 case OO_CaretEqual: 8819 case OO_PipeEqual: 8820 OpBuilder.addAssignmentIntegralOverloads(); 8821 break; 8822 8823 case OO_Exclaim: 8824 OpBuilder.addExclaimOverload(); 8825 break; 8826 8827 case OO_AmpAmp: 8828 case OO_PipePipe: 8829 OpBuilder.addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload(); 8830 break; 8831 8832 case OO_Subscript: 8833 OpBuilder.addSubscriptOverloads(); 8834 break; 8835 8836 case OO_ArrowStar: 8837 OpBuilder.addArrowStarOverloads(); 8838 break; 8839 8840 case OO_Conditional: 8841 OpBuilder.addConditionalOperatorOverloads(); 8842 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(); 8843 break; 8844 } 8845 } 8846 8847 /// Add function candidates found via argument-dependent lookup 8848 /// to the set of overloading candidates. 8849 /// 8850 /// This routine performs argument-dependent name lookup based on the 8851 /// given function name (which may also be an operator name) and adds 8852 /// all of the overload candidates found by ADL to the overload 8853 /// candidate set (C++ [basic.lookup.argdep]). 8854 void 8855 Sema::AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(DeclarationName Name, 8856 SourceLocation Loc, 8857 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 8858 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 8859 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet, 8860 bool PartialOverloading) { 8861 ADLResult Fns; 8862 8863 // FIXME: This approach for uniquing ADL results (and removing 8864 // redundant candidates from the set) relies on pointer-equality, 8865 // which means we need to key off the canonical decl. However, 8866 // always going back to the canonical decl might not get us the 8867 // right set of default arguments. What default arguments are 8868 // we supposed to consider on ADL candidates, anyway? 8869 8870 // FIXME: Pass in the explicit template arguments? 8871 ArgumentDependentLookup(Name, Loc, Args, Fns); 8872 8873 // Erase all of the candidates we already knew about. 8874 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(), 8875 CandEnd = CandidateSet.end(); 8876 Cand != CandEnd; ++Cand) 8877 if (Cand->Function) { 8878 Fns.erase(Cand->Function); 8879 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Cand->Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) 8880 Fns.erase(FunTmpl); 8881 } 8882 8883 // For each of the ADL candidates we found, add it to the overload 8884 // set. 8885 for (ADLResult::iterator I = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); I != E; ++I) { 8886 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(*I, AS_none); 8887 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*I)) { 8888 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) 8889 continue; 8890 8891 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, false, 8892 PartialOverloading); 8893 } else 8894 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*I), 8895 FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, 8896 Args, CandidateSet, PartialOverloading); 8897 } 8898 } 8899 8900 namespace { 8901 enum class Comparison { Equal, Better, Worse }; 8902 } 8903 8904 /// Compares the enable_if attributes of two FunctionDecls, for the purposes of 8905 /// overload resolution. 8906 /// 8907 /// Cand1's set of enable_if attributes are said to be "better" than Cand2's iff 8908 /// Cand1's first N enable_if attributes have precisely the same conditions as 8909 /// Cand2's first N enable_if attributes (where N = the number of enable_if 8910 /// attributes on Cand2), and Cand1 has more than N enable_if attributes. 8911 /// 8912 /// Note that you can have a pair of candidates such that Cand1's enable_if 8913 /// attributes are worse than Cand2's, and Cand2's enable_if attributes are 8914 /// worse than Cand1's. 8915 static Comparison compareEnableIfAttrs(const Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *Cand1, 8916 const FunctionDecl *Cand2) { 8917 // Common case: One (or both) decls don't have enable_if attrs. 8918 bool Cand1Attr = Cand1->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>(); 8919 bool Cand2Attr = Cand2->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>(); 8920 if (!Cand1Attr || !Cand2Attr) { 8921 if (Cand1Attr == Cand2Attr) 8922 return Comparison::Equal; 8923 return Cand1Attr ? Comparison::Better : Comparison::Worse; 8924 } 8925 8926 auto Cand1Attrs = Cand1->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>(); 8927 auto Cand2Attrs = Cand2->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>(); 8928 8929 auto Cand1I = Cand1Attrs.begin(); 8930 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID Cand1ID, Cand2ID; 8931 for (auto Cand2A : Cand2Attrs) { 8932 Cand1ID.clear(); 8933 Cand2ID.clear(); 8934 8935 // It's impossible for Cand1 to be better than (or equal to) Cand2 if Cand1 8936 // has fewer enable_if attributes than Cand2. 8937 if (Cand1I == Cand1Attrs.end()) 8938 return Comparison::Worse; 8939 auto Cand1A = Cand1I++; 8940 8941 Cand1A->getCond()->Profile(Cand1ID, S.getASTContext(), true); 8942 Cand2A->getCond()->Profile(Cand2ID, S.getASTContext(), true); 8943 if (Cand1ID != Cand2ID) 8944 return Comparison::Worse; 8945 } 8946 8947 return Cand1I == Cand1Attrs.end() ? Comparison::Equal : Comparison::Better; 8948 } 8949 8950 /// isBetterOverloadCandidate - Determines whether the first overload 8951 /// candidate is a better candidate than the second (C++ 13.3.3p1). 8952 bool clang::isBetterOverloadCandidate( 8953 Sema &S, const OverloadCandidate &Cand1, const OverloadCandidate &Cand2, 8954 SourceLocation Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind Kind) { 8955 // Define viable functions to be better candidates than non-viable 8956 // functions. 8957 if (!Cand2.Viable) 8958 return Cand1.Viable; 8959 else if (!Cand1.Viable) 8960 return false; 8961 8962 // C++ [over.match.best]p1: 8963 // 8964 // -- if F is a static member function, ICS1(F) is defined such 8965 // that ICS1(F) is neither better nor worse than ICS1(G) for 8966 // any function G, and, symmetrically, ICS1(G) is neither 8967 // better nor worse than ICS1(F). 8968 unsigned StartArg = 0; 8969 if (Cand1.IgnoreObjectArgument || Cand2.IgnoreObjectArgument) 8970 StartArg = 1; 8971 8972 auto IsIllFormedConversion = [&](const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS) { 8973 // We don't allow incompatible pointer conversions in C++. 8974 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 8975 return ICS.isStandard() && 8976 ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion; 8977 8978 // The only ill-formed conversion we allow in C++ is the string literal to 8979 // char* conversion, which is only considered ill-formed after C++11. 8980 return S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && !S.getLangOpts().WritableStrings && 8981 hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS); 8982 }; 8983 8984 // Define functions that don't require ill-formed conversions for a given 8985 // argument to be better candidates than functions that do. 8986 unsigned NumArgs = Cand1.Conversions.size(); 8987 assert(Cand2.Conversions.size() == NumArgs && "Overload candidate mismatch"); 8988 bool HasBetterConversion = false; 8989 for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 8990 bool Cand1Bad = IsIllFormedConversion(Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx]); 8991 bool Cand2Bad = IsIllFormedConversion(Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx]); 8992 if (Cand1Bad != Cand2Bad) { 8993 if (Cand1Bad) 8994 return false; 8995 HasBetterConversion = true; 8996 } 8997 } 8998 8999 if (HasBetterConversion) 9000 return true; 9001 9002 // C++ [over.match.best]p1: 9003 // A viable function F1 is defined to be a better function than another 9004 // viable function F2 if for all arguments i, ICSi(F1) is not a worse 9005 // conversion sequence than ICSi(F2), and then... 9006 for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) { 9007 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, Loc, 9008 Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx], 9009 Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx])) { 9010 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better: 9011 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence. 9012 HasBetterConversion = true; 9013 break; 9014 9015 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse: 9016 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2. 9017 return false; 9018 9019 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable: 9020 // Do nothing. 9021 break; 9022 } 9023 } 9024 9025 // -- for some argument j, ICSj(F1) is a better conversion sequence than 9026 // ICSj(F2), or, if not that, 9027 if (HasBetterConversion) 9028 return true; 9029 9030 // -- the context is an initialization by user-defined conversion 9031 // (see 8.5, 13.3.1.5) and the standard conversion sequence 9032 // from the return type of F1 to the destination type (i.e., 9033 // the type of the entity being initialized) is a better 9034 // conversion sequence than the standard conversion sequence 9035 // from the return type of F2 to the destination type. 9036 if (Kind == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion && 9037 Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function && 9038 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) && 9039 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand2.Function)) { 9040 // First check whether we prefer one of the conversion functions over the 9041 // other. This only distinguishes the results in non-standard, extension 9042 // cases such as the conversion from a lambda closure type to a function 9043 // pointer or block. 9044 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result = 9045 compareConversionFunctions(S, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function); 9046 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable) 9047 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, Loc, 9048 Cand1.FinalConversion, 9049 Cand2.FinalConversion); 9050 9051 if (Result != ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable) 9052 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better; 9053 9054 // FIXME: Compare kind of reference binding if conversion functions 9055 // convert to a reference type used in direct reference binding, per 9056 // C++14 [over.match.best]p1 section 2 bullet 3. 9057 } 9058 9059 // FIXME: Work around a defect in the C++17 guaranteed copy elision wording, 9060 // as combined with the resolution to CWG issue 243. 9061 // 9062 // When the context is initialization by constructor ([over.match.ctor] or 9063 // either phase of [over.match.list]), a constructor is preferred over 9064 // a conversion function. 9065 if (Kind == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByConstructor && NumArgs == 1 && 9066 Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function && 9067 isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand1.Function) != 9068 isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand2.Function)) 9069 return isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand1.Function); 9070 9071 // -- F1 is a non-template function and F2 is a function template 9072 // specialization, or, if not that, 9073 bool Cand1IsSpecialization = Cand1.Function && 9074 Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(); 9075 bool Cand2IsSpecialization = Cand2.Function && 9076 Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(); 9077 if (Cand1IsSpecialization != Cand2IsSpecialization) 9078 return Cand2IsSpecialization; 9079 9080 // -- F1 and F2 are function template specializations, and the function 9081 // template for F1 is more specialized than the template for F2 9082 // according to the partial ordering rules described in 14.5.5.2, or, 9083 // if not that, 9084 if (Cand1IsSpecialization && Cand2IsSpecialization) { 9085 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *BetterTemplate 9086 = S.getMoreSpecializedTemplate(Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(), 9087 Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(), 9088 Loc, 9089 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function)? TPOC_Conversion 9090 : TPOC_Call, 9091 Cand1.ExplicitCallArguments, 9092 Cand2.ExplicitCallArguments)) 9093 return BetterTemplate == Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(); 9094 } 9095 9096 // FIXME: Work around a defect in the C++17 inheriting constructor wording. 9097 // A derived-class constructor beats an (inherited) base class constructor. 9098 bool Cand1IsInherited = 9099 dyn_cast_or_null<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(Cand1.FoundDecl.getDecl()); 9100 bool Cand2IsInherited = 9101 dyn_cast_or_null<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(Cand2.FoundDecl.getDecl()); 9102 if (Cand1IsInherited != Cand2IsInherited) 9103 return Cand2IsInherited; 9104 else if (Cand1IsInherited) { 9105 assert(Cand2IsInherited); 9106 auto *Cand1Class = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Cand1.Function->getDeclContext()); 9107 auto *Cand2Class = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Cand2.Function->getDeclContext()); 9108 if (Cand1Class->isDerivedFrom(Cand2Class)) 9109 return true; 9110 if (Cand2Class->isDerivedFrom(Cand1Class)) 9111 return false; 9112 // Inherited from sibling base classes: still ambiguous. 9113 } 9114 9115 // Check C++17 tie-breakers for deduction guides. 9116 { 9117 auto *Guide1 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXDeductionGuideDecl>(Cand1.Function); 9118 auto *Guide2 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXDeductionGuideDecl>(Cand2.Function); 9119 if (Guide1 && Guide2) { 9120 // -- F1 is generated from a deduction-guide and F2 is not 9121 if (Guide1->isImplicit() != Guide2->isImplicit()) 9122 return Guide2->isImplicit(); 9123 9124 // -- F1 is the copy deduction candidate(16.3.1.8) and F2 is not 9125 if (Guide1->isCopyDeductionCandidate()) 9126 return true; 9127 } 9128 } 9129 9130 // Check for enable_if value-based overload resolution. 9131 if (Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function) { 9132 Comparison Cmp = compareEnableIfAttrs(S, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function); 9133 if (Cmp != Comparison::Equal) 9134 return Cmp == Comparison::Better; 9135 } 9136 9137 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function) { 9138 FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext); 9139 return S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand1.Function) > 9140 S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand2.Function); 9141 } 9142 9143 bool HasPS1 = Cand1.Function != nullptr && 9144 functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Cand1.Function); 9145 bool HasPS2 = Cand2.Function != nullptr && 9146 functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Cand2.Function); 9147 return HasPS1 != HasPS2 && HasPS1; 9148 } 9149 9150 /// Determine whether two declarations are "equivalent" for the purposes of 9151 /// name lookup and overload resolution. This applies when the same internal/no 9152 /// linkage entity is defined by two modules (probably by textually including 9153 /// the same header). In such a case, we don't consider the declarations to 9154 /// declare the same entity, but we also don't want lookups with both 9155 /// declarations visible to be ambiguous in some cases (this happens when using 9156 /// a modularized libstdc++). 9157 bool Sema::isEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclaration(const NamedDecl *A, 9158 const NamedDecl *B) { 9159 auto *VA = dyn_cast_or_null<ValueDecl>(A); 9160 auto *VB = dyn_cast_or_null<ValueDecl>(B); 9161 if (!VA || !VB) 9162 return false; 9163 9164 // The declarations must be declaring the same name as an internal linkage 9165 // entity in different modules. 9166 if (!VA->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->Equals( 9167 VB->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()) || 9168 getOwningModule(const_cast<ValueDecl *>(VA)) == 9169 getOwningModule(const_cast<ValueDecl *>(VB)) || 9170 VA->isExternallyVisible() || VB->isExternallyVisible()) 9171 return false; 9172 9173 // Check that the declarations appear to be equivalent. 9174 // 9175 // FIXME: Checking the type isn't really enough to resolve the ambiguity. 9176 // For constants and functions, we should check the initializer or body is 9177 // the same. For non-constant variables, we shouldn't allow it at all. 9178 if (Context.hasSameType(VA->getType(), VB->getType())) 9179 return true; 9180 9181 // Enum constants within unnamed enumerations will have different types, but 9182 // may still be similar enough to be interchangeable for our purposes. 9183 if (auto *EA = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(VA)) { 9184 if (auto *EB = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(VB)) { 9185 // Only handle anonymous enums. If the enumerations were named and 9186 // equivalent, they would have been merged to the same type. 9187 auto *EnumA = cast<EnumDecl>(EA->getDeclContext()); 9188 auto *EnumB = cast<EnumDecl>(EB->getDeclContext()); 9189 if (EnumA->hasNameForLinkage() || EnumB->hasNameForLinkage() || 9190 !Context.hasSameType(EnumA->getIntegerType(), 9191 EnumB->getIntegerType())) 9192 return false; 9193 // Allow this only if the value is the same for both enumerators. 9194 return llvm::APSInt::isSameValue(EA->getInitVal(), EB->getInitVal()); 9195 } 9196 } 9197 9198 // Nothing else is sufficiently similar. 9199 return false; 9200 } 9201 9202 void Sema::diagnoseEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclarations( 9203 SourceLocation Loc, const NamedDecl *D, ArrayRef<const NamedDecl *> Equiv) { 9204 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_equivalent_internal_linkage_decl_in_modules) << D; 9205 9206 Module *M = getOwningModule(const_cast<NamedDecl*>(D)); 9207 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_equivalent_internal_linkage_decl) 9208 << !M << (M ? M->getFullModuleName() : ""); 9209 9210 for (auto *E : Equiv) { 9211 Module *M = getOwningModule(const_cast<NamedDecl*>(E)); 9212 Diag(E->getLocation(), diag::note_equivalent_internal_linkage_decl) 9213 << !M << (M ? M->getFullModuleName() : ""); 9214 } 9215 } 9216 9217 /// Computes the best viable function (C++ 13.3.3) 9218 /// within an overload candidate set. 9219 /// 9220 /// \param Loc The location of the function name (or operator symbol) for 9221 /// which overload resolution occurs. 9222 /// 9223 /// \param Best If overload resolution was successful or found a deleted 9224 /// function, \p Best points to the candidate function found. 9225 /// 9226 /// \returns The result of overload resolution. 9227 OverloadingResult 9228 OverloadCandidateSet::BestViableFunction(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 9229 iterator &Best) { 9230 llvm::SmallVector<OverloadCandidate *, 16> Candidates; 9231 std::transform(begin(), end(), std::back_inserter(Candidates), 9232 [](OverloadCandidate &Cand) { return &Cand; }); 9233 9234 // [CUDA] HD->H or HD->D calls are technically not allowed by CUDA but 9235 // are accepted by both clang and NVCC. However, during a particular 9236 // compilation mode only one call variant is viable. We need to 9237 // exclude non-viable overload candidates from consideration based 9238 // only on their host/device attributes. Specifically, if one 9239 // candidate call is WrongSide and the other is SameSide, we ignore 9240 // the WrongSide candidate. 9241 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA) { 9242 const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext); 9243 bool ContainsSameSideCandidate = 9244 llvm::any_of(Candidates, [&](OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 9245 return Cand->Function && 9246 S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand->Function) == 9247 Sema::CFP_SameSide; 9248 }); 9249 if (ContainsSameSideCandidate) { 9250 auto IsWrongSideCandidate = [&](OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 9251 return Cand->Function && 9252 S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand->Function) == 9253 Sema::CFP_WrongSide; 9254 }; 9255 llvm::erase_if(Candidates, IsWrongSideCandidate); 9256 } 9257 } 9258 9259 // Find the best viable function. 9260 Best = end(); 9261 for (auto *Cand : Candidates) 9262 if (Cand->Viable) 9263 if (Best == end() || 9264 isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Cand, *Best, Loc, Kind)) 9265 Best = Cand; 9266 9267 // If we didn't find any viable functions, abort. 9268 if (Best == end()) 9269 return OR_No_Viable_Function; 9270 9271 llvm::SmallVector<const NamedDecl *, 4> EquivalentCands; 9272 9273 // Make sure that this function is better than every other viable 9274 // function. If not, we have an ambiguity. 9275 for (auto *Cand : Candidates) { 9276 if (Cand->Viable && Cand != Best && 9277 !isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Best, *Cand, Loc, Kind)) { 9278 if (S.isEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclaration(Best->Function, 9279 Cand->Function)) { 9280 EquivalentCands.push_back(Cand->Function); 9281 continue; 9282 } 9283 9284 Best = end(); 9285 return OR_Ambiguous; 9286 } 9287 } 9288 9289 // Best is the best viable function. 9290 if (Best->Function && 9291 (Best->Function->isDeleted() || 9292 S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Best->Function))) 9293 return OR_Deleted; 9294 9295 if (!EquivalentCands.empty()) 9296 S.diagnoseEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclarations(Loc, Best->Function, 9297 EquivalentCands); 9298 9299 return OR_Success; 9300 } 9301 9302 namespace { 9303 9304 enum OverloadCandidateKind { 9305 oc_function, 9306 oc_method, 9307 oc_constructor, 9308 oc_implicit_default_constructor, 9309 oc_implicit_copy_constructor, 9310 oc_implicit_move_constructor, 9311 oc_implicit_copy_assignment, 9312 oc_implicit_move_assignment, 9313 oc_inherited_constructor 9314 }; 9315 9316 enum OverloadCandidateSelect { 9317 ocs_non_template, 9318 ocs_template, 9319 ocs_described_template, 9320 }; 9321 9322 static std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> 9323 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(Sema &S, NamedDecl *Found, FunctionDecl *Fn, 9324 std::string &Description) { 9325 9326 bool isTemplate = Fn->isTemplateDecl() || Found->isTemplateDecl(); 9327 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Fn->getPrimaryTemplate()) { 9328 isTemplate = true; 9329 Description = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText( 9330 FunTmpl->getTemplateParameters(), *Fn->getTemplateSpecializationArgs()); 9331 } 9332 9333 OverloadCandidateSelect Select = [&]() { 9334 if (!Description.empty()) 9335 return ocs_described_template; 9336 return isTemplate ? ocs_template : ocs_non_template; 9337 }(); 9338 9339 OverloadCandidateKind Kind = [&]() { 9340 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) { 9341 if (!Ctor->isImplicit()) { 9342 if (isa<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(Found)) 9343 return oc_inherited_constructor; 9344 else 9345 return oc_constructor; 9346 } 9347 9348 if (Ctor->isDefaultConstructor()) 9349 return oc_implicit_default_constructor; 9350 9351 if (Ctor->isMoveConstructor()) 9352 return oc_implicit_move_constructor; 9353 9354 assert(Ctor->isCopyConstructor() && 9355 "unexpected sort of implicit constructor"); 9356 return oc_implicit_copy_constructor; 9357 } 9358 9359 if (CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) { 9360 // This actually gets spelled 'candidate function' for now, but 9361 // it doesn't hurt to split it out. 9362 if (!Meth->isImplicit()) 9363 return oc_method; 9364 9365 if (Meth->isMoveAssignmentOperator()) 9366 return oc_implicit_move_assignment; 9367 9368 if (Meth->isCopyAssignmentOperator()) 9369 return oc_implicit_copy_assignment; 9370 9371 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Meth) && "expected conversion"); 9372 return oc_method; 9373 } 9374 9375 return oc_function; 9376 }(); 9377 9378 return std::make_pair(Kind, Select); 9379 } 9380 9381 void MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(Sema &S, Decl *FoundDecl) { 9382 // FIXME: It'd be nice to only emit a note once per using-decl per overload 9383 // set. 9384 if (auto *Shadow = dyn_cast<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl)) 9385 S.Diag(FoundDecl->getLocation(), 9386 diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor) 9387 << Shadow->getNominatedBaseClass(); 9388 } 9389 9390 } // end anonymous namespace 9391 9392 static bool isFunctionAlwaysEnabled(const ASTContext &Ctx, 9393 const FunctionDecl *FD) { 9394 for (auto *EnableIf : FD->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>()) { 9395 bool AlwaysTrue; 9396 if (!EnableIf->getCond()->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(AlwaysTrue, Ctx)) 9397 return false; 9398 if (!AlwaysTrue) 9399 return false; 9400 } 9401 return true; 9402 } 9403 9404 /// Returns true if we can take the address of the function. 9405 /// 9406 /// \param Complain - If true, we'll emit a diagnostic 9407 /// \param InOverloadResolution - For the purposes of emitting a diagnostic, are 9408 /// we in overload resolution? 9409 /// \param Loc - The location of the statement we're complaining about. Ignored 9410 /// if we're not complaining, or if we're in overload resolution. 9411 static bool checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *FD, 9412 bool Complain, 9413 bool InOverloadResolution, 9414 SourceLocation Loc) { 9415 if (!isFunctionAlwaysEnabled(S.Context, FD)) { 9416 if (Complain) { 9417 if (InOverloadResolution) 9418 S.Diag(FD->getLocStart(), 9419 diag::note_addrof_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if_attr); 9420 else 9421 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_addrof_function_disabled_by_enable_if_attr) << FD; 9422 } 9423 return false; 9424 } 9425 9426 auto I = llvm::find_if(FD->parameters(), [](const ParmVarDecl *P) { 9427 return P->hasAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>(); 9428 }); 9429 if (I == FD->param_end()) 9430 return true; 9431 9432 if (Complain) { 9433 // Add one to ParamNo because it's user-facing 9434 unsigned ParamNo = std::distance(FD->param_begin(), I) + 1; 9435 if (InOverloadResolution) 9436 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), 9437 diag::note_ovl_candidate_has_pass_object_size_params) 9438 << ParamNo; 9439 else 9440 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_address_of_function_with_pass_object_size_params) 9441 << FD << ParamNo; 9442 } 9443 return false; 9444 } 9445 9446 static bool checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(Sema &S, 9447 const FunctionDecl *FD) { 9448 return checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(S, FD, /*Complain=*/true, 9449 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 9450 /*Loc=*/SourceLocation()); 9451 } 9452 9453 bool Sema::checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(const FunctionDecl *Function, 9454 bool Complain, 9455 SourceLocation Loc) { 9456 return ::checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(*this, Function, Complain, 9457 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 9458 Loc); 9459 } 9460 9461 // Notes the location of an overload candidate. 9462 void Sema::NoteOverloadCandidate(NamedDecl *Found, FunctionDecl *Fn, 9463 QualType DestType, bool TakingAddress) { 9464 if (TakingAddress && !checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(*this, Fn)) 9465 return; 9466 if (Fn->isMultiVersion() && !Fn->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion()) 9467 return; 9468 9469 std::string FnDesc; 9470 std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> KSPair = 9471 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(*this, Found, Fn, FnDesc); 9472 PartialDiagnostic PD = PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate) 9473 << (unsigned)KSPair.first << (unsigned)KSPair.second 9474 << Fn << FnDesc; 9475 9476 HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PD, Fn->getType(), DestType); 9477 Diag(Fn->getLocation(), PD); 9478 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(*this, Found); 9479 } 9480 9481 // Notes the location of all overload candidates designated through 9482 // OverloadedExpr 9483 void Sema::NoteAllOverloadCandidates(Expr *OverloadedExpr, QualType DestType, 9484 bool TakingAddress) { 9485 assert(OverloadedExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy); 9486 9487 OverloadExpr::FindResult Ovl = OverloadExpr::find(OverloadedExpr); 9488 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = Ovl.Expression; 9489 9490 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(), 9491 IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end(); 9492 I != IEnd; ++I) { 9493 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = 9494 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) { 9495 NoteOverloadCandidate(*I, FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(), DestType, 9496 TakingAddress); 9497 } else if (FunctionDecl *Fun 9498 = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) { 9499 NoteOverloadCandidate(*I, Fun, DestType, TakingAddress); 9500 } 9501 } 9502 } 9503 9504 /// Diagnoses an ambiguous conversion. The partial diagnostic is the 9505 /// "lead" diagnostic; it will be given two arguments, the source and 9506 /// target types of the conversion. 9507 void ImplicitConversionSequence::DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion( 9508 Sema &S, 9509 SourceLocation CaretLoc, 9510 const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag) const { 9511 S.Diag(CaretLoc, PDiag) 9512 << Ambiguous.getFromType() << Ambiguous.getToType(); 9513 // FIXME: The note limiting machinery is borrowed from 9514 // OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates; there's an opportunity for 9515 // refactoring here. 9516 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads(); 9517 unsigned CandsShown = 0; 9518 AmbiguousConversionSequence::const_iterator I, E; 9519 for (I = Ambiguous.begin(), E = Ambiguous.end(); I != E; ++I) { 9520 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best) 9521 break; 9522 ++CandsShown; 9523 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(I->first, I->second); 9524 } 9525 if (I != E) 9526 S.Diag(SourceLocation(), diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I); 9527 } 9528 9529 static void DiagnoseBadConversion(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 9530 unsigned I, bool TakingCandidateAddress) { 9531 const ImplicitConversionSequence &Conv = Cand->Conversions[I]; 9532 assert(Conv.isBad()); 9533 assert(Cand->Function && "for now, candidate must be a function"); 9534 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; 9535 9536 // There's a conversion slot for the object argument if this is a 9537 // non-constructor method. Note that 'I' corresponds the 9538 // conversion-slot index. 9539 bool isObjectArgument = false; 9540 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn) && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) { 9541 if (I == 0) 9542 isObjectArgument = true; 9543 else 9544 I--; 9545 } 9546 9547 std::string FnDesc; 9548 std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair = 9549 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, FnDesc); 9550 9551 Expr *FromExpr = Conv.Bad.FromExpr; 9552 QualType FromTy = Conv.Bad.getFromType(); 9553 QualType ToTy = Conv.Bad.getToType(); 9554 9555 if (FromTy == S.Context.OverloadTy) { 9556 assert(FromExpr && "overload set argument came from implicit argument?"); 9557 Expr *E = FromExpr->IgnoreParens(); 9558 if (isa<UnaryOperator>(E)) 9559 E = cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens(); 9560 DeclarationName Name = cast<OverloadExpr>(E)->getName(); 9561 9562 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_overload) 9563 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 9564 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << ToTy 9565 << Name << I + 1; 9566 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 9567 return; 9568 } 9569 9570 // Do some hand-waving analysis to see if the non-viability is due 9571 // to a qualifier mismatch. 9572 CanQualType CFromTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromTy); 9573 CanQualType CToTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToTy); 9574 if (CanQual<ReferenceType> RT = CToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 9575 CToTy = RT->getPointeeType(); 9576 else { 9577 // TODO: detect and diagnose the full richness of const mismatches. 9578 if (CanQual<PointerType> FromPT = CFromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 9579 if (CanQual<PointerType> ToPT = CToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) { 9580 CFromTy = FromPT->getPointeeType(); 9581 CToTy = ToPT->getPointeeType(); 9582 } 9583 } 9584 9585 if (CToTy.getUnqualifiedType() == CFromTy.getUnqualifiedType() && 9586 !CToTy.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(CFromTy)) { 9587 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers(); 9588 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers(); 9589 9590 if (FromQs.getAddressSpace() != ToQs.getAddressSpace()) { 9591 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace) 9592 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 9593 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 9594 << FromQs.getAddressSpaceAttributePrintValue() 9595 << ToQs.getAddressSpaceAttributePrintValue() 9596 << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1; 9597 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 9598 return; 9599 } 9600 9601 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) { 9602 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_ownership) 9603 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 9604 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 9605 << FromQs.getObjCLifetime() << ToQs.getObjCLifetime() 9606 << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1; 9607 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 9608 return; 9609 } 9610 9611 if (FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()) { 9612 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_gc) 9613 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 9614 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 9615 << FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() << ToQs.getObjCGCAttr() 9616 << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1; 9617 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 9618 return; 9619 } 9620 9621 if (FromQs.hasUnaligned() != ToQs.hasUnaligned()) { 9622 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_unaligned) 9623 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 9624 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 9625 << FromQs.hasUnaligned() << I + 1; 9626 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 9627 return; 9628 } 9629 9630 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers(); 9631 assert(CVR && "unexpected qualifiers mismatch"); 9632 9633 if (isObjectArgument) { 9634 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr_this) 9635 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 9636 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 9637 << (CVR - 1); 9638 } else { 9639 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr) 9640 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 9641 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 9642 << (CVR - 1) << I + 1; 9643 } 9644 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 9645 return; 9646 } 9647 9648 // Special diagnostic for failure to convert an initializer list, since 9649 // telling the user that it has type void is not useful. 9650 if (FromExpr && isa<InitListExpr>(FromExpr)) { 9651 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_list_argument) 9652 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 9653 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 9654 << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1; 9655 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 9656 return; 9657 } 9658 9659 // Diagnose references or pointers to incomplete types differently, 9660 // since it's far from impossible that the incompleteness triggered 9661 // the failure. 9662 QualType TempFromTy = FromTy.getNonReferenceType(); 9663 if (const PointerType *PTy = TempFromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 9664 TempFromTy = PTy->getPointeeType(); 9665 if (TempFromTy->isIncompleteType()) { 9666 // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it. 9667 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv_incomplete) 9668 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 9669 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 9670 << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1 9671 << (unsigned)(Cand->Fix.Kind); 9672 9673 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 9674 return; 9675 } 9676 9677 // Diagnose base -> derived pointer conversions. 9678 unsigned BaseToDerivedConversion = 0; 9679 if (const PointerType *FromPtrTy = FromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) { 9680 if (const PointerType *ToPtrTy = ToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) { 9681 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs( 9682 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) && 9683 !FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() && 9684 !ToPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() && 9685 S.IsDerivedFrom(SourceLocation(), ToPtrTy->getPointeeType(), 9686 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType())) 9687 BaseToDerivedConversion = 1; 9688 } 9689 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrTy 9690 = FromTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 9691 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrTy 9692 = ToTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) 9693 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *FromIface = FromPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl()) 9694 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ToIface = ToPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl()) 9695 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs( 9696 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) && 9697 FromIface->isSuperClassOf(ToIface)) 9698 BaseToDerivedConversion = 2; 9699 } else if (const ReferenceType *ToRefTy = ToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) { 9700 if (ToRefTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTy) && 9701 !FromTy->isIncompleteType() && 9702 !ToRefTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() && 9703 S.IsDerivedFrom(SourceLocation(), ToRefTy->getPointeeType(), FromTy)) { 9704 BaseToDerivedConversion = 3; 9705 } else if (ToTy->isLValueReferenceType() && !FromExpr->isLValue() && 9706 ToTy.getNonReferenceType().getCanonicalType() == 9707 FromTy.getNonReferenceType().getCanonicalType()) { 9708 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_lvalue) 9709 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 9710 << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1 9711 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()); 9712 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 9713 return; 9714 } 9715 } 9716 9717 if (BaseToDerivedConversion) { 9718 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_base_to_derived_conv) 9719 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 9720 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 9721 << (BaseToDerivedConversion - 1) << FromTy << ToTy << I + 1; 9722 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 9723 return; 9724 } 9725 9726 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(CFromTy) && 9727 isa<PointerType>(CToTy)) { 9728 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers(); 9729 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers(); 9730 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) { 9731 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_arc_conv) 9732 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second 9733 << FnDesc << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 9734 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1; 9735 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 9736 return; 9737 } 9738 } 9739 9740 if (TakingCandidateAddress && 9741 !checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(S, Cand->Function)) 9742 return; 9743 9744 // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it. 9745 PartialDiagnostic FDiag = S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv); 9746 FDiag << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 9747 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy 9748 << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1 9749 << (unsigned)(Cand->Fix.Kind); 9750 9751 // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts. 9752 for (std::vector<FixItHint>::iterator HI = Cand->Fix.Hints.begin(), 9753 HE = Cand->Fix.Hints.end(); HI != HE; ++HI) 9754 FDiag << *HI; 9755 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), FDiag); 9756 9757 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 9758 } 9759 9760 /// Additional arity mismatch diagnosis specific to a function overload 9761 /// candidates. This is not covered by the more general DiagnoseArityMismatch() 9762 /// over a candidate in any candidate set. 9763 static bool CheckArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 9764 unsigned NumArgs) { 9765 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; 9766 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments(); 9767 9768 // With invalid overloaded operators, it's possible that we think we 9769 // have an arity mismatch when in fact it looks like we have the 9770 // right number of arguments, because only overloaded operators have 9771 // the weird behavior of overloading member and non-member functions. 9772 // Just don't report anything. 9773 if (Fn->isInvalidDecl() && 9774 Fn->getDeclName().getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName) 9775 return true; 9776 9777 if (NumArgs < MinParams) { 9778 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) || 9779 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction && 9780 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments)); 9781 } else { 9782 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments) || 9783 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction && 9784 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments)); 9785 } 9786 9787 return false; 9788 } 9789 9790 /// General arity mismatch diagnosis over a candidate in a candidate set. 9791 static void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, NamedDecl *Found, Decl *D, 9792 unsigned NumFormalArgs) { 9793 assert(isa<FunctionDecl>(D) && 9794 "The templated declaration should at least be a function" 9795 " when diagnosing bad template argument deduction due to too many" 9796 " or too few arguments"); 9797 9798 FunctionDecl *Fn = cast<FunctionDecl>(D); 9799 9800 // TODO: treat calls to a missing default constructor as a special case 9801 const FunctionProtoType *FnTy = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 9802 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments(); 9803 9804 // at least / at most / exactly 9805 unsigned mode, modeCount; 9806 if (NumFormalArgs < MinParams) { 9807 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumParams() || FnTy->isVariadic() || 9808 FnTy->isTemplateVariadic()) 9809 mode = 0; // "at least" 9810 else 9811 mode = 2; // "exactly" 9812 modeCount = MinParams; 9813 } else { 9814 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumParams()) 9815 mode = 1; // "at most" 9816 else 9817 mode = 2; // "exactly" 9818 modeCount = FnTy->getNumParams(); 9819 } 9820 9821 std::string Description; 9822 std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair = 9823 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Found, Fn, Description); 9824 9825 if (modeCount == 1 && Fn->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName()) 9826 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity_one) 9827 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second 9828 << Description << mode << Fn->getParamDecl(0) << NumFormalArgs; 9829 else 9830 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity) 9831 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second 9832 << Description << mode << modeCount << NumFormalArgs; 9833 9834 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 9835 } 9836 9837 /// Arity mismatch diagnosis specific to a function overload candidate. 9838 static void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 9839 unsigned NumFormalArgs) { 9840 if (!CheckArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumFormalArgs)) 9841 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function, NumFormalArgs); 9842 } 9843 9844 static TemplateDecl *getDescribedTemplate(Decl *Templated) { 9845 if (TemplateDecl *TD = Templated->getDescribedTemplate()) 9846 return TD; 9847 llvm_unreachable("Unsupported: Getting the described template declaration" 9848 " for bad deduction diagnosis"); 9849 } 9850 9851 /// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction. 9852 static void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, NamedDecl *Found, Decl *Templated, 9853 DeductionFailureInfo &DeductionFailure, 9854 unsigned NumArgs, 9855 bool TakingCandidateAddress) { 9856 TemplateParameter Param = DeductionFailure.getTemplateParameter(); 9857 NamedDecl *ParamD; 9858 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl*>()) || 9859 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl*>()) || 9860 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl*>()); 9861 switch (DeductionFailure.Result) { 9862 case Sema::TDK_Success: 9863 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction"); 9864 9865 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: { 9866 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result"); 9867 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 9868 diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction) 9869 << ParamD->getDeclName(); 9870 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 9871 return; 9872 } 9873 9874 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: { 9875 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for bad qualifiers deduction result"); 9876 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TParam = cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD); 9877 9878 QualType Param = DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getAsType(); 9879 9880 // Param will have been canonicalized, but it should just be a 9881 // qualified version of ParamD, so move the qualifiers to that. 9882 QualifierCollector Qs; 9883 Qs.strip(Param); 9884 QualType NonCanonParam = Qs.apply(S.Context, TParam->getTypeForDecl()); 9885 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(Param, NonCanonParam)); 9886 9887 // Arg has also been canonicalized, but there's nothing we can do 9888 // about that. It also doesn't matter as much, because it won't 9889 // have any template parameters in it (because deduction isn't 9890 // done on dependent types). 9891 QualType Arg = DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getAsType(); 9892 9893 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_underqualified) 9894 << ParamD->getDeclName() << Arg << NonCanonParam; 9895 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 9896 return; 9897 } 9898 9899 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: { 9900 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for inconsistent deduction result"); 9901 int which = 0; 9902 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD)) 9903 which = 0; 9904 else if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)) { 9905 // Deduction might have failed because we deduced arguments of two 9906 // different types for a non-type template parameter. 9907 // FIXME: Use a different TDK value for this. 9908 QualType T1 = 9909 DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getNonTypeTemplateArgumentType(); 9910 QualType T2 = 9911 DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getNonTypeTemplateArgumentType(); 9912 if (!S.Context.hasSameType(T1, T2)) { 9913 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 9914 diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction_types) 9915 << ParamD->getDeclName() << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg() << T1 9916 << *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg() << T2; 9917 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 9918 return; 9919 } 9920 9921 which = 1; 9922 } else { 9923 which = 2; 9924 } 9925 9926 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 9927 diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction) 9928 << which << ParamD->getDeclName() << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg() 9929 << *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg(); 9930 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 9931 return; 9932 } 9933 9934 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 9935 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for invalid explicit arguments"); 9936 if (ParamD->getDeclName()) 9937 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 9938 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_named) 9939 << ParamD->getDeclName(); 9940 else { 9941 int index = 0; 9942 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD)) 9943 index = TTP->getIndex(); 9944 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP 9945 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)) 9946 index = NTTP->getIndex(); 9947 else 9948 index = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)->getIndex(); 9949 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 9950 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_unnamed) 9951 << (index + 1); 9952 } 9953 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 9954 return; 9955 9956 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 9957 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 9958 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Found, Templated, NumArgs); 9959 return; 9960 9961 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 9962 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 9963 diag::note_ovl_candidate_instantiation_depth); 9964 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 9965 return; 9966 9967 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: { 9968 // Format the template argument list into the argument string. 9969 SmallString<128> TemplateArgString; 9970 if (TemplateArgumentList *Args = 9971 DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList()) { 9972 TemplateArgString = " "; 9973 TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText( 9974 getDescribedTemplate(Templated)->getTemplateParameters(), *Args); 9975 } 9976 9977 // If this candidate was disabled by enable_if, say so. 9978 PartialDiagnosticAt *PDiag = DeductionFailure.getSFINAEDiagnostic(); 9979 if (PDiag && PDiag->second.getDiagID() == 9980 diag::err_typename_nested_not_found_enable_if) { 9981 // FIXME: Use the source range of the condition, and the fully-qualified 9982 // name of the enable_if template. These are both present in PDiag. 9983 S.Diag(PDiag->first, diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if) 9984 << "'enable_if'" << TemplateArgString; 9985 return; 9986 } 9987 9988 // We found a specific requirement that disabled the enable_if. 9989 if (PDiag && PDiag->second.getDiagID() == 9990 diag::err_typename_nested_not_found_requirement) { 9991 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 9992 diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_requirement) 9993 << PDiag->second.getStringArg(0) << TemplateArgString; 9994 return; 9995 } 9996 9997 // Format the SFINAE diagnostic into the argument string. 9998 // FIXME: Add a general mechanism to include a PartialDiagnostic *'s 9999 // formatted message in another diagnostic. 10000 SmallString<128> SFINAEArgString; 10001 SourceRange R; 10002 if (PDiag) { 10003 SFINAEArgString = ": "; 10004 R = SourceRange(PDiag->first, PDiag->first); 10005 PDiag->second.EmitToString(S.getDiagnostics(), SFINAEArgString); 10006 } 10007 10008 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10009 diag::note_ovl_candidate_substitution_failure) 10010 << TemplateArgString << SFINAEArgString << R; 10011 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10012 return; 10013 } 10014 10015 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 10016 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: { 10017 // Format the template argument list into the argument string. 10018 SmallString<128> TemplateArgString; 10019 if (TemplateArgumentList *Args = 10020 DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList()) { 10021 TemplateArgString = " "; 10022 TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText( 10023 getDescribedTemplate(Templated)->getTemplateParameters(), *Args); 10024 } 10025 10026 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deduced_mismatch) 10027 << (*DeductionFailure.getCallArgIndex() + 1) 10028 << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg() << *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg() 10029 << TemplateArgString 10030 << (DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested); 10031 break; 10032 } 10033 10034 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: { 10035 // FIXME: Provide a source location to indicate what we couldn't match. 10036 TemplateArgument FirstTA = *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg(); 10037 TemplateArgument SecondTA = *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg(); 10038 if (FirstTA.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Template && 10039 SecondTA.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Template) { 10040 TemplateName FirstTN = FirstTA.getAsTemplate(); 10041 TemplateName SecondTN = SecondTA.getAsTemplate(); 10042 if (FirstTN.getKind() == TemplateName::Template && 10043 SecondTN.getKind() == TemplateName::Template) { 10044 if (FirstTN.getAsTemplateDecl()->getName() == 10045 SecondTN.getAsTemplateDecl()->getName()) { 10046 // FIXME: This fixes a bad diagnostic where both templates are named 10047 // the same. This particular case is a bit difficult since: 10048 // 1) It is passed as a string to the diagnostic printer. 10049 // 2) The diagnostic printer only attempts to find a better 10050 // name for types, not decls. 10051 // Ideally, this should folded into the diagnostic printer. 10052 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10053 diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch_qualified) 10054 << FirstTN.getAsTemplateDecl() << SecondTN.getAsTemplateDecl(); 10055 return; 10056 } 10057 } 10058 } 10059 10060 if (TakingCandidateAddress && isa<FunctionDecl>(Templated) && 10061 !checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(S, cast<FunctionDecl>(Templated))) 10062 return; 10063 10064 // FIXME: For generic lambda parameters, check if the function is a lambda 10065 // call operator, and if so, emit a prettier and more informative 10066 // diagnostic that mentions 'auto' and lambda in addition to 10067 // (or instead of?) the canonical template type parameters. 10068 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10069 diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch) 10070 << FirstTA << SecondTA; 10071 return; 10072 } 10073 // TODO: diagnose these individually, then kill off 10074 // note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction, which is uselessly vague. 10075 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 10076 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction); 10077 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found); 10078 return; 10079 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 10080 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), 10081 diag::note_cuda_ovl_candidate_target_mismatch); 10082 return; 10083 } 10084 } 10085 10086 /// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction, for function calls. 10087 static void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 10088 unsigned NumArgs, 10089 bool TakingCandidateAddress) { 10090 unsigned TDK = Cand->DeductionFailure.Result; 10091 if (TDK == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments || TDK == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments) { 10092 if (CheckArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs)) 10093 return; 10094 } 10095 DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function, // pattern 10096 Cand->DeductionFailure, NumArgs, TakingCandidateAddress); 10097 } 10098 10099 /// CUDA: diagnose an invalid call across targets. 10100 static void DiagnoseBadTarget(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 10101 FunctionDecl *Caller = cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext); 10102 FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function; 10103 10104 Sema::CUDAFunctionTarget CallerTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Caller), 10105 CalleeTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee); 10106 10107 std::string FnDesc; 10108 std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair = 10109 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Callee, FnDesc); 10110 10111 S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_target) 10112 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)ocs_non_template 10113 << FnDesc /* Ignored */ 10114 << CalleeTarget << CallerTarget; 10115 10116 // This could be an implicit constructor for which we could not infer the 10117 // target due to a collsion. Diagnose that case. 10118 CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Callee); 10119 if (Meth != nullptr && Meth->isImplicit()) { 10120 CXXRecordDecl *ParentClass = Meth->getParent(); 10121 Sema::CXXSpecialMember CSM; 10122 10123 switch (FnKindPair.first) { 10124 default: 10125 return; 10126 case oc_implicit_default_constructor: 10127 CSM = Sema::CXXDefaultConstructor; 10128 break; 10129 case oc_implicit_copy_constructor: 10130 CSM = Sema::CXXCopyConstructor; 10131 break; 10132 case oc_implicit_move_constructor: 10133 CSM = Sema::CXXMoveConstructor; 10134 break; 10135 case oc_implicit_copy_assignment: 10136 CSM = Sema::CXXCopyAssignment; 10137 break; 10138 case oc_implicit_move_assignment: 10139 CSM = Sema::CXXMoveAssignment; 10140 break; 10141 }; 10142 10143 bool ConstRHS = false; 10144 if (Meth->getNumParams()) { 10145 if (const ReferenceType *RT = 10146 Meth->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->getAs<ReferenceType>()) { 10147 ConstRHS = RT->getPointeeType().isConstQualified(); 10148 } 10149 } 10150 10151 S.inferCUDATargetForImplicitSpecialMember(ParentClass, CSM, Meth, 10152 /* ConstRHS */ ConstRHS, 10153 /* Diagnose */ true); 10154 } 10155 } 10156 10157 static void DiagnoseFailedEnableIfAttr(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 10158 FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function; 10159 EnableIfAttr *Attr = static_cast<EnableIfAttr*>(Cand->DeductionFailure.Data); 10160 10161 S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), 10162 diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_function_cond_attr) 10163 << Attr->getCond()->getSourceRange() << Attr->getMessage(); 10164 } 10165 10166 static void DiagnoseOpenCLExtensionDisabled(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 10167 FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function; 10168 10169 S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), 10170 diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_extension); 10171 } 10172 10173 /// Generates a 'note' diagnostic for an overload candidate. We've 10174 /// already generated a primary error at the call site. 10175 /// 10176 /// It really does need to be a single diagnostic with its caret 10177 /// pointed at the candidate declaration. Yes, this creates some 10178 /// major challenges of technical writing. Yes, this makes pointing 10179 /// out problems with specific arguments quite awkward. It's still 10180 /// better than generating twenty screens of text for every failed 10181 /// overload. 10182 /// 10183 /// It would be great to be able to express per-candidate problems 10184 /// more richly for those diagnostic clients that cared, but we'd 10185 /// still have to be just as careful with the default diagnostics. 10186 static void NoteFunctionCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 10187 unsigned NumArgs, 10188 bool TakingCandidateAddress) { 10189 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; 10190 10191 // Note deleted candidates, but only if they're viable. 10192 if (Cand->Viable) { 10193 if (Fn->isDeleted() || S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Fn)) { 10194 std::string FnDesc; 10195 std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair = 10196 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, FnDesc); 10197 10198 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deleted) 10199 << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc 10200 << (Fn->isDeleted() ? (Fn->isDeletedAsWritten() ? 1 : 2) : 0); 10201 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10202 return; 10203 } 10204 10205 // We don't really have anything else to say about viable candidates. 10206 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Cand->FoundDecl, Fn); 10207 return; 10208 } 10209 10210 switch (Cand->FailureKind) { 10211 case ovl_fail_too_many_arguments: 10212 case ovl_fail_too_few_arguments: 10213 return DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs); 10214 10215 case ovl_fail_bad_deduction: 10216 return DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand, NumArgs, 10217 TakingCandidateAddress); 10218 10219 case ovl_fail_illegal_constructor: { 10220 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_illegal_constructor) 10221 << (Fn->getPrimaryTemplate() ? 1 : 0); 10222 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10223 return; 10224 } 10225 10226 case ovl_fail_trivial_conversion: 10227 case ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion: 10228 case ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact: 10229 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Cand->FoundDecl, Fn); 10230 10231 case ovl_fail_bad_conversion: { 10232 unsigned I = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0); 10233 for (unsigned N = Cand->Conversions.size(); I != N; ++I) 10234 if (Cand->Conversions[I].isBad()) 10235 return DiagnoseBadConversion(S, Cand, I, TakingCandidateAddress); 10236 10237 // FIXME: this currently happens when we're called from SemaInit 10238 // when user-conversion overload fails. Figure out how to handle 10239 // those conditions and diagnose them well. 10240 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Cand->FoundDecl, Fn); 10241 } 10242 10243 case ovl_fail_bad_target: 10244 return DiagnoseBadTarget(S, Cand); 10245 10246 case ovl_fail_enable_if: 10247 return DiagnoseFailedEnableIfAttr(S, Cand); 10248 10249 case ovl_fail_ext_disabled: 10250 return DiagnoseOpenCLExtensionDisabled(S, Cand); 10251 10252 case ovl_fail_inhctor_slice: 10253 // It's generally not interesting to note copy/move constructors here. 10254 if (cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)->isCopyOrMoveConstructor()) 10255 return; 10256 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), 10257 diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor_slice) 10258 << (Fn->getPrimaryTemplate() ? 1 : 0) 10259 << Fn->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->isRValueReferenceType(); 10260 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl); 10261 return; 10262 10263 case ovl_fail_addr_not_available: { 10264 bool Available = checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(S, Cand->Function); 10265 (void)Available; 10266 assert(!Available); 10267 break; 10268 } 10269 case ovl_non_default_multiversion_function: 10270 // Do nothing, these should simply be ignored. 10271 break; 10272 } 10273 } 10274 10275 static void NoteSurrogateCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 10276 // Desugar the type of the surrogate down to a function type, 10277 // retaining as many typedefs as possible while still showing 10278 // the function type (and, therefore, its parameter types). 10279 QualType FnType = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType(); 10280 bool isLValueReference = false; 10281 bool isRValueReference = false; 10282 bool isPointer = false; 10283 if (const LValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef = 10284 FnType->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) { 10285 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 10286 isLValueReference = true; 10287 } else if (const RValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef = 10288 FnType->getAs<RValueReferenceType>()) { 10289 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 10290 isRValueReference = true; 10291 } 10292 if (const PointerType *FnTypePtr = FnType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 10293 FnType = FnTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 10294 isPointer = true; 10295 } 10296 // Desugar down to a function type. 10297 FnType = QualType(FnType->getAs<FunctionType>(), 0); 10298 // Reconstruct the pointer/reference as appropriate. 10299 if (isPointer) FnType = S.Context.getPointerType(FnType); 10300 if (isRValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(FnType); 10301 if (isLValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(FnType); 10302 10303 S.Diag(Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_surrogate_cand) 10304 << FnType; 10305 } 10306 10307 static void NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(Sema &S, StringRef Opc, 10308 SourceLocation OpLoc, 10309 OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 10310 assert(Cand->Conversions.size() <= 2 && "builtin operator is not binary"); 10311 std::string TypeStr("operator"); 10312 TypeStr += Opc; 10313 TypeStr += "("; 10314 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinParamTypes[0].getAsString(); 10315 if (Cand->Conversions.size() == 1) { 10316 TypeStr += ")"; 10317 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_unary_candidate) << TypeStr; 10318 } else { 10319 TypeStr += ", "; 10320 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinParamTypes[1].getAsString(); 10321 TypeStr += ")"; 10322 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_binary_candidate) << TypeStr; 10323 } 10324 } 10325 10326 static void NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 10327 OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 10328 for (const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS : Cand->Conversions) { 10329 if (ICS.isBad()) break; // all meaningless after first invalid 10330 if (!ICS.isAmbiguous()) continue; 10331 10332 ICS.DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion( 10333 S, OpLoc, S.PDiag(diag::note_ambiguous_type_conversion)); 10334 } 10335 } 10336 10337 static SourceLocation GetLocationForCandidate(const OverloadCandidate *Cand) { 10338 if (Cand->Function) 10339 return Cand->Function->getLocation(); 10340 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) 10341 return Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(); 10342 return SourceLocation(); 10343 } 10344 10345 static unsigned RankDeductionFailure(const DeductionFailureInfo &DFI) { 10346 switch ((Sema::TemplateDeductionResult)DFI.Result) { 10347 case Sema::TDK_Success: 10348 case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure: 10349 llvm_unreachable("non-deduction failure while diagnosing bad deduction"); 10350 10351 case Sema::TDK_Invalid: 10352 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: 10353 return 1; 10354 10355 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: 10356 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: 10357 return 2; 10358 10359 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: 10360 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch: 10361 case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: 10362 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: 10363 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure: 10364 case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch: 10365 return 3; 10366 10367 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth: 10368 return 4; 10369 10370 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments: 10371 return 5; 10372 10373 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments: 10374 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments: 10375 return 6; 10376 } 10377 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled deduction result"); 10378 } 10379 10380 namespace { 10381 struct CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay { 10382 Sema &S; 10383 SourceLocation Loc; 10384 size_t NumArgs; 10385 OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK; 10386 10387 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay( 10388 Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, size_t NArgs, 10389 OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK) 10390 : S(S), NumArgs(NArgs), CSK(CSK) {} 10391 10392 bool operator()(const OverloadCandidate *L, 10393 const OverloadCandidate *R) { 10394 // Fast-path this check. 10395 if (L == R) return false; 10396 10397 // Order first by viability. 10398 if (L->Viable) { 10399 if (!R->Viable) return true; 10400 10401 // TODO: introduce a tri-valued comparison for overload 10402 // candidates. Would be more worthwhile if we had a sort 10403 // that could exploit it. 10404 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *L, *R, SourceLocation(), CSK)) 10405 return true; 10406 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *R, *L, SourceLocation(), CSK)) 10407 return false; 10408 } else if (R->Viable) 10409 return false; 10410 10411 assert(L->Viable == R->Viable); 10412 10413 // Criteria by which we can sort non-viable candidates: 10414 if (!L->Viable) { 10415 // 1. Arity mismatches come after other candidates. 10416 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments || 10417 L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) { 10418 if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments || 10419 R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) { 10420 int LDist = std::abs((int)L->getNumParams() - (int)NumArgs); 10421 int RDist = std::abs((int)R->getNumParams() - (int)NumArgs); 10422 if (LDist == RDist) { 10423 if (L->FailureKind == R->FailureKind) 10424 // Sort non-surrogates before surrogates. 10425 return !L->IsSurrogate && R->IsSurrogate; 10426 // Sort candidates requiring fewer parameters than there were 10427 // arguments given after candidates requiring more parameters 10428 // than there were arguments given. 10429 return L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments; 10430 } 10431 return LDist < RDist; 10432 } 10433 return false; 10434 } 10435 if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments || 10436 R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) 10437 return true; 10438 10439 // 2. Bad conversions come first and are ordered by the number 10440 // of bad conversions and quality of good conversions. 10441 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) { 10442 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) 10443 return true; 10444 10445 // The conversion that can be fixed with a smaller number of changes, 10446 // comes first. 10447 unsigned numLFixes = L->Fix.NumConversionsFixed; 10448 unsigned numRFixes = R->Fix.NumConversionsFixed; 10449 numLFixes = (numLFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numLFixes; 10450 numRFixes = (numRFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numRFixes; 10451 if (numLFixes != numRFixes) { 10452 return numLFixes < numRFixes; 10453 } 10454 10455 // If there's any ordering between the defined conversions... 10456 // FIXME: this might not be transitive. 10457 assert(L->Conversions.size() == R->Conversions.size()); 10458 10459 int leftBetter = 0; 10460 unsigned I = (L->IgnoreObjectArgument || R->IgnoreObjectArgument); 10461 for (unsigned E = L->Conversions.size(); I != E; ++I) { 10462 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, Loc, 10463 L->Conversions[I], 10464 R->Conversions[I])) { 10465 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better: 10466 leftBetter++; 10467 break; 10468 10469 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse: 10470 leftBetter--; 10471 break; 10472 10473 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable: 10474 break; 10475 } 10476 } 10477 if (leftBetter > 0) return true; 10478 if (leftBetter < 0) return false; 10479 10480 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) 10481 return false; 10482 10483 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) { 10484 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_deduction) 10485 return true; 10486 10487 if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result) 10488 return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure) 10489 < RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure); 10490 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) 10491 return false; 10492 10493 // TODO: others? 10494 } 10495 10496 // Sort everything else by location. 10497 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L); 10498 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R); 10499 10500 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end. 10501 if (LLoc.isInvalid()) return false; 10502 if (RLoc.isInvalid()) return true; 10503 10504 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc); 10505 } 10506 }; 10507 } 10508 10509 /// CompleteNonViableCandidate - Normally, overload resolution only 10510 /// computes up to the first bad conversion. Produces the FixIt set if 10511 /// possible. 10512 static void CompleteNonViableCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, 10513 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) { 10514 assert(!Cand->Viable); 10515 10516 // Don't do anything on failures other than bad conversion. 10517 if (Cand->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) return; 10518 10519 // We only want the FixIts if all the arguments can be corrected. 10520 bool Unfixable = false; 10521 // Use a implicit copy initialization to check conversion fixes. 10522 Cand->Fix.setConversionChecker(TryCopyInitialization); 10523 10524 // Attempt to fix the bad conversion. 10525 unsigned ConvCount = Cand->Conversions.size(); 10526 for (unsigned ConvIdx = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0); /**/; 10527 ++ConvIdx) { 10528 assert(ConvIdx != ConvCount && "no bad conversion in candidate"); 10529 if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized() && 10530 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) { 10531 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S); 10532 break; 10533 } 10534 } 10535 10536 // FIXME: this should probably be preserved from the overload 10537 // operation somehow. 10538 bool SuppressUserConversions = false; 10539 10540 unsigned ConvIdx = 0; 10541 ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes; 10542 10543 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) { 10544 QualType ConvType 10545 = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 10546 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>()) 10547 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType(); 10548 ParamTypes = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()->getParamTypes(); 10549 // Conversion 0 is 'this', which doesn't have a corresponding argument. 10550 ConvIdx = 1; 10551 } else if (Cand->Function) { 10552 ParamTypes = 10553 Cand->Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()->getParamTypes(); 10554 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Cand->Function) && 10555 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand->Function)) { 10556 // Conversion 0 is 'this', which doesn't have a corresponding argument. 10557 ConvIdx = 1; 10558 } 10559 } else { 10560 // Builtin operator. 10561 assert(ConvCount <= 3); 10562 ParamTypes = Cand->BuiltinParamTypes; 10563 } 10564 10565 // Fill in the rest of the conversions. 10566 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx, ++ArgIdx) { 10567 if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized()) { 10568 // We've already checked this conversion. 10569 } else if (ArgIdx < ParamTypes.size()) { 10570 if (ParamTypes[ArgIdx]->isDependentType()) 10571 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setAsIdentityConversion( 10572 Args[ArgIdx]->getType()); 10573 else { 10574 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx] = 10575 TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTypes[ArgIdx], 10576 SuppressUserConversions, 10577 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true, 10578 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/ 10579 S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount); 10580 // Store the FixIt in the candidate if it exists. 10581 if (!Unfixable && Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) 10582 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S); 10583 } 10584 } else 10585 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis(); 10586 } 10587 } 10588 10589 /// When overload resolution fails, prints diagnostic messages containing the 10590 /// candidates in the candidate set. 10591 void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates( 10592 Sema &S, OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 10593 StringRef Opc, SourceLocation OpLoc, 10594 llvm::function_ref<bool(OverloadCandidate &)> Filter) { 10595 // Sort the candidates by viability and position. Sorting directly would 10596 // be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers and sort those. 10597 SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 32> Cands; 10598 if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) Cands.reserve(size()); 10599 for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) { 10600 if (!Filter(*Cand)) 10601 continue; 10602 if (Cand->Viable) 10603 Cands.push_back(Cand); 10604 else if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) { 10605 CompleteNonViableCandidate(S, Cand, Args); 10606 if (Cand->Function || Cand->IsSurrogate) 10607 Cands.push_back(Cand); 10608 // Otherwise, this a non-viable builtin candidate. We do not, in general, 10609 // want to list every possible builtin candidate. 10610 } 10611 } 10612 10613 std::stable_sort(Cands.begin(), Cands.end(), 10614 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(S, OpLoc, Args.size(), Kind)); 10615 10616 bool ReportedAmbiguousConversions = false; 10617 10618 SmallVectorImpl<OverloadCandidate*>::iterator I, E; 10619 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads(); 10620 unsigned CandsShown = 0; 10621 for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) { 10622 OverloadCandidate *Cand = *I; 10623 10624 // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidate functions we'll spam 10625 // the user with. FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the 10626 // candidate list. 10627 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best) { 10628 break; 10629 } 10630 ++CandsShown; 10631 10632 if (Cand->Function) 10633 NoteFunctionCandidate(S, Cand, Args.size(), 10634 /*TakingCandidateAddress=*/false); 10635 else if (Cand->IsSurrogate) 10636 NoteSurrogateCandidate(S, Cand); 10637 else { 10638 assert(Cand->Viable && 10639 "Non-viable built-in candidates are not added to Cands."); 10640 // Generally we only see ambiguities including viable builtin 10641 // operators if overload resolution got screwed up by an 10642 // ambiguous user-defined conversion. 10643 // 10644 // FIXME: It's quite possible for different conversions to see 10645 // different ambiguities, though. 10646 if (!ReportedAmbiguousConversions) { 10647 NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(S, OpLoc, Cand); 10648 ReportedAmbiguousConversions = true; 10649 } 10650 10651 // If this is a viable builtin, print it. 10652 NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(S, Opc, OpLoc, Cand); 10653 } 10654 } 10655 10656 if (I != E) 10657 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I); 10658 } 10659 10660 static SourceLocation 10661 GetLocationForCandidate(const TemplateSpecCandidate *Cand) { 10662 return Cand->Specialization ? Cand->Specialization->getLocation() 10663 : SourceLocation(); 10664 } 10665 10666 namespace { 10667 struct CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay { 10668 Sema &S; 10669 CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S) : S(S) {} 10670 10671 bool operator()(const TemplateSpecCandidate *L, 10672 const TemplateSpecCandidate *R) { 10673 // Fast-path this check. 10674 if (L == R) 10675 return false; 10676 10677 // Assuming that both candidates are not matches... 10678 10679 // Sort by the ranking of deduction failures. 10680 if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result) 10681 return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure) < 10682 RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure); 10683 10684 // Sort everything else by location. 10685 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L); 10686 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R); 10687 10688 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end. 10689 if (LLoc.isInvalid()) 10690 return false; 10691 if (RLoc.isInvalid()) 10692 return true; 10693 10694 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc); 10695 } 10696 }; 10697 } 10698 10699 /// Diagnose a template argument deduction failure. 10700 /// We are treating these failures as overload failures due to bad 10701 /// deductions. 10702 void TemplateSpecCandidate::NoteDeductionFailure(Sema &S, 10703 bool ForTakingAddress) { 10704 DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, FoundDecl, Specialization, // pattern 10705 DeductionFailure, /*NumArgs=*/0, ForTakingAddress); 10706 } 10707 10708 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::destroyCandidates() { 10709 for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) { 10710 i->DeductionFailure.Destroy(); 10711 } 10712 } 10713 10714 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::clear() { 10715 destroyCandidates(); 10716 Candidates.clear(); 10717 } 10718 10719 /// NoteCandidates - When no template specialization match is found, prints 10720 /// diagnostic messages containing the non-matching specializations that form 10721 /// the candidate set. 10722 /// This is analoguous to OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates() with 10723 /// OCD == OCD_AllCandidates and Cand->Viable == false. 10724 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) { 10725 // Sort the candidates by position (assuming no candidate is a match). 10726 // Sorting directly would be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers 10727 // and sort those. 10728 SmallVector<TemplateSpecCandidate *, 32> Cands; 10729 Cands.reserve(size()); 10730 for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) { 10731 if (Cand->Specialization) 10732 Cands.push_back(Cand); 10733 // Otherwise, this is a non-matching builtin candidate. We do not, 10734 // in general, want to list every possible builtin candidate. 10735 } 10736 10737 llvm::sort(Cands.begin(), Cands.end(), 10738 CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay(S)); 10739 10740 // FIXME: Perhaps rename OverloadsShown and getShowOverloads() 10741 // for generalization purposes (?). 10742 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads(); 10743 10744 SmallVectorImpl<TemplateSpecCandidate *>::iterator I, E; 10745 unsigned CandsShown = 0; 10746 for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) { 10747 TemplateSpecCandidate *Cand = *I; 10748 10749 // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidates we'll spam 10750 // the user with. FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the 10751 // candidate list. 10752 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best) 10753 break; 10754 ++CandsShown; 10755 10756 assert(Cand->Specialization && 10757 "Non-matching built-in candidates are not added to Cands."); 10758 Cand->NoteDeductionFailure(S, ForTakingAddress); 10759 } 10760 10761 if (I != E) 10762 S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I); 10763 } 10764 10765 // [PossiblyAFunctionType] --> [Return] 10766 // NonFunctionType --> NonFunctionType 10767 // R (A) --> R(A) 10768 // R (*)(A) --> R (A) 10769 // R (&)(A) --> R (A) 10770 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A) 10771 QualType Sema::ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(QualType PossiblyAFunctionType) { 10772 QualType Ret = PossiblyAFunctionType; 10773 if (const PointerType *ToTypePtr = 10774 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<PointerType>()) 10775 Ret = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 10776 else if (const ReferenceType *ToTypeRef = 10777 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 10778 Ret = ToTypeRef->getPointeeType(); 10779 else if (const MemberPointerType *MemTypePtr = 10780 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) 10781 Ret = MemTypePtr->getPointeeType(); 10782 Ret = 10783 Context.getCanonicalType(Ret).getUnqualifiedType(); 10784 return Ret; 10785 } 10786 10787 static bool completeFunctionType(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *FD, SourceLocation Loc, 10788 bool Complain = true) { 10789 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() && 10790 S.DeduceReturnType(FD, Loc, Complain)) 10791 return true; 10792 10793 auto *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 10794 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 && 10795 isUnresolvedExceptionSpec(FPT->getExceptionSpecType()) && 10796 !S.ResolveExceptionSpec(Loc, FPT)) 10797 return true; 10798 10799 return false; 10800 } 10801 10802 namespace { 10803 // A helper class to help with address of function resolution 10804 // - allows us to avoid passing around all those ugly parameters 10805 class AddressOfFunctionResolver { 10806 Sema& S; 10807 Expr* SourceExpr; 10808 const QualType& TargetType; 10809 QualType TargetFunctionType; // Extracted function type from target type 10810 10811 bool Complain; 10812 //DeclAccessPair& ResultFunctionAccessPair; 10813 ASTContext& Context; 10814 10815 bool TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction; 10816 bool FoundNonTemplateFunction; 10817 bool StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer; 10818 bool HasComplained; 10819 10820 OverloadExpr::FindResult OvlExprInfo; 10821 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr; 10822 TemplateArgumentListInfo OvlExplicitTemplateArgs; 10823 SmallVector<std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl*>, 4> Matches; 10824 TemplateSpecCandidateSet FailedCandidates; 10825 10826 public: 10827 AddressOfFunctionResolver(Sema &S, Expr *SourceExpr, 10828 const QualType &TargetType, bool Complain) 10829 : S(S), SourceExpr(SourceExpr), TargetType(TargetType), 10830 Complain(Complain), Context(S.getASTContext()), 10831 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction( 10832 !!TargetType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()), 10833 FoundNonTemplateFunction(false), 10834 StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer(false), 10835 HasComplained(false), 10836 OvlExprInfo(OverloadExpr::find(SourceExpr)), 10837 OvlExpr(OvlExprInfo.Expression), 10838 FailedCandidates(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), /*ForTakingAddress=*/true) { 10839 ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType(); 10840 10841 if (TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType()) { 10842 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *UME = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(OvlExpr)) 10843 if (!UME->isImplicitAccess() && 10844 !S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(UME)) 10845 StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer = true; 10846 } else if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 10847 DeclAccessPair dap; 10848 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization( 10849 OvlExpr, false, &dap)) { 10850 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) 10851 if (!Method->isStatic()) { 10852 // If the target type is a non-function type and the function found 10853 // is a non-static member function, pretend as if that was the 10854 // target, it's the only possible type to end up with. 10855 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction = true; 10856 10857 // And skip adding the function if its not in the proper form. 10858 // We'll diagnose this due to an empty set of functions. 10859 if (!OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer) 10860 return; 10861 } 10862 10863 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(dap, Fn)); 10864 } 10865 return; 10866 } 10867 10868 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) 10869 OvlExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(OvlExplicitTemplateArgs); 10870 10871 if (FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly()) { 10872 // C++ [over.over]p4: 10873 // If more than one function is selected, [...] 10874 if (Matches.size() > 1 && !eliminiateSuboptimalOverloadCandidates()) { 10875 if (FoundNonTemplateFunction) 10876 EliminateAllTemplateMatches(); 10877 else 10878 EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate(); 10879 } 10880 } 10881 10882 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && Matches.size() > 1) 10883 EliminateSuboptimalCudaMatches(); 10884 } 10885 10886 bool hasComplained() const { return HasComplained; } 10887 10888 private: 10889 bool candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(const FunctionDecl *FD) { 10890 QualType Discard; 10891 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(TargetFunctionType, FD->getType()) || 10892 S.IsFunctionConversion(FD->getType(), TargetFunctionType, Discard); 10893 } 10894 10895 /// \return true if A is considered a better overload candidate for the 10896 /// desired type than B. 10897 bool isBetterCandidate(const FunctionDecl *A, const FunctionDecl *B) { 10898 // If A doesn't have exactly the correct type, we don't want to classify it 10899 // as "better" than anything else. This way, the user is required to 10900 // disambiguate for us if there are multiple candidates and no exact match. 10901 return candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(A) && 10902 (!candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(B) || 10903 compareEnableIfAttrs(S, A, B) == Comparison::Better); 10904 } 10905 10906 /// \return true if we were able to eliminate all but one overload candidate, 10907 /// false otherwise. 10908 bool eliminiateSuboptimalOverloadCandidates() { 10909 // Same algorithm as overload resolution -- one pass to pick the "best", 10910 // another pass to be sure that nothing is better than the best. 10911 auto Best = Matches.begin(); 10912 for (auto I = Matches.begin()+1, E = Matches.end(); I != E; ++I) 10913 if (isBetterCandidate(I->second, Best->second)) 10914 Best = I; 10915 10916 const FunctionDecl *BestFn = Best->second; 10917 auto IsBestOrInferiorToBest = [this, BestFn]( 10918 const std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl *> &Pair) { 10919 return BestFn == Pair.second || isBetterCandidate(BestFn, Pair.second); 10920 }; 10921 10922 // Note: We explicitly leave Matches unmodified if there isn't a clear best 10923 // option, so we can potentially give the user a better error 10924 if (!std::all_of(Matches.begin(), Matches.end(), IsBestOrInferiorToBest)) 10925 return false; 10926 Matches[0] = *Best; 10927 Matches.resize(1); 10928 return true; 10929 } 10930 10931 bool isTargetTypeAFunction() const { 10932 return TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType(); 10933 } 10934 10935 // [ToType] [Return] 10936 10937 // R (*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false 10938 // R (&)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false 10939 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = true 10940 void inline ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType() { 10941 TargetFunctionType = S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(TargetType); 10942 } 10943 10944 // return true if any matching specializations were found 10945 bool AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplateDecl* FunctionTemplate, 10946 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) { 10947 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method 10948 = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl())) { 10949 // Skip non-static function templates when converting to pointer, and 10950 // static when converting to member pointer. 10951 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction) 10952 return false; 10953 } 10954 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction) 10955 return false; 10956 10957 // C++ [over.over]p2: 10958 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is 10959 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the 10960 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single 10961 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of 10962 // overloaded functions considered. 10963 FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr; 10964 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(FailedCandidates.getLocation()); 10965 if (Sema::TemplateDeductionResult Result 10966 = S.DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, 10967 &OvlExplicitTemplateArgs, 10968 TargetFunctionType, Specialization, 10969 Info, /*IsAddressOfFunction*/true)) { 10970 // Make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics. 10971 FailedCandidates.addCandidate() 10972 .set(CurAccessFunPair, FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(), 10973 MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, Info)); 10974 return false; 10975 } 10976 10977 // Template argument deduction ensures that we have an exact match or 10978 // compatible pointer-to-function arguments that would be adjusted by ICS. 10979 // This function template specicalization works. 10980 assert(S.isSameOrCompatibleFunctionType( 10981 Context.getCanonicalType(Specialization->getType()), 10982 Context.getCanonicalType(TargetFunctionType))); 10983 10984 if (!S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(Specialization)) 10985 return false; 10986 10987 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair, Specialization)); 10988 return true; 10989 } 10990 10991 bool AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(NamedDecl* Fn, 10992 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) { 10993 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) { 10994 // Skip non-static functions when converting to pointer, and static 10995 // when converting to member pointer. 10996 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction) 10997 return false; 10998 } 10999 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction) 11000 return false; 11001 11002 if (FunctionDecl *FunDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Fn)) { 11003 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA) 11004 if (FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext)) 11005 if (!Caller->isImplicit() && !S.IsAllowedCUDACall(Caller, FunDecl)) 11006 return false; 11007 if (FunDecl->isMultiVersion()) { 11008 const auto *TA = FunDecl->getAttr<TargetAttr>(); 11009 assert(TA && "Multiversioned functions require a target attribute"); 11010 if (!TA->isDefaultVersion()) 11011 return false; 11012 } 11013 11014 // If any candidate has a placeholder return type, trigger its deduction 11015 // now. 11016 if (completeFunctionType(S, FunDecl, SourceExpr->getLocStart(), 11017 Complain)) { 11018 HasComplained |= Complain; 11019 return false; 11020 } 11021 11022 if (!S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FunDecl)) 11023 return false; 11024 11025 // If we're in C, we need to support types that aren't exactly identical. 11026 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || 11027 candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(FunDecl)) { 11028 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair( 11029 CurAccessFunPair, cast<FunctionDecl>(FunDecl->getCanonicalDecl()))); 11030 FoundNonTemplateFunction = true; 11031 return true; 11032 } 11033 } 11034 11035 return false; 11036 } 11037 11038 bool FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly() { 11039 bool Ret = false; 11040 11041 // If the overload expression doesn't have the form of a pointer to 11042 // member, don't try to convert it to a pointer-to-member type. 11043 if (IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction()) 11044 return false; 11045 11046 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(), 11047 E = OvlExpr->decls_end(); 11048 I != E; ++I) { 11049 // Look through any using declarations to find the underlying function. 11050 NamedDecl *Fn = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl(); 11051 11052 // C++ [over.over]p3: 11053 // Non-member functions and static member functions match 11054 // targets of type "pointer-to-function" or "reference-to-function." 11055 // Nonstatic member functions match targets of 11056 // type "pointer-to-member-function." 11057 // Note that according to DR 247, the containing class does not matter. 11058 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate 11059 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Fn)) { 11060 if (AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplate, I.getPair())) 11061 Ret = true; 11062 } 11063 // If we have explicit template arguments supplied, skip non-templates. 11064 else if (!OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() && 11065 AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(Fn, I.getPair())) 11066 Ret = true; 11067 } 11068 assert(Ret || Matches.empty()); 11069 return Ret; 11070 } 11071 11072 void EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate() { 11073 // [...] and any given function template specialization F1 is 11074 // eliminated if the set contains a second function template 11075 // specialization whose function template is more specialized 11076 // than the function template of F1 according to the partial 11077 // ordering rules of 14.5.5.2. 11078 11079 // The algorithm specified above is quadratic. We instead use a 11080 // two-pass algorithm (similar to the one used to identify the 11081 // best viable function in an overload set) that identifies the 11082 // best function template (if it exists). 11083 11084 UnresolvedSet<4> MatchesCopy; // TODO: avoid! 11085 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I) 11086 MatchesCopy.addDecl(Matches[I].second, Matches[I].first.getAccess()); 11087 11088 // TODO: It looks like FailedCandidates does not serve much purpose 11089 // here, since the no_viable diagnostic has index 0. 11090 UnresolvedSetIterator Result = S.getMostSpecialized( 11091 MatchesCopy.begin(), MatchesCopy.end(), FailedCandidates, 11092 SourceExpr->getLocStart(), S.PDiag(), 11093 S.PDiag(diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous) 11094 << Matches[0].second->getDeclName(), 11095 S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate) 11096 << (unsigned)oc_function << (unsigned)ocs_described_template, 11097 Complain, TargetFunctionType); 11098 11099 if (Result != MatchesCopy.end()) { 11100 // Make it the first and only element 11101 Matches[0].first = Matches[Result - MatchesCopy.begin()].first; 11102 Matches[0].second = cast<FunctionDecl>(*Result); 11103 Matches.resize(1); 11104 } else 11105 HasComplained |= Complain; 11106 } 11107 11108 void EliminateAllTemplateMatches() { 11109 // [...] any function template specializations in the set are 11110 // eliminated if the set also contains a non-template function, [...] 11111 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Matches.size(); I != N; ) { 11112 if (Matches[I].second->getPrimaryTemplate() == nullptr) 11113 ++I; 11114 else { 11115 Matches[I] = Matches[--N]; 11116 Matches.resize(N); 11117 } 11118 } 11119 } 11120 11121 void EliminateSuboptimalCudaMatches() { 11122 S.EraseUnwantedCUDAMatches(dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext), Matches); 11123 } 11124 11125 public: 11126 void ComplainNoMatchesFound() const { 11127 assert(Matches.empty()); 11128 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_viable) 11129 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetFunctionType 11130 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange(); 11131 if (FailedCandidates.empty()) 11132 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType, 11133 /*TakingAddress=*/true); 11134 else { 11135 // We have some deduction failure messages. Use them to diagnose 11136 // the function templates, and diagnose the non-template candidates 11137 // normally. 11138 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(), 11139 IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end(); 11140 I != IEnd; ++I) 11141 if (FunctionDecl *Fun = 11142 dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl())) 11143 if (!functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Fun)) 11144 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(*I, Fun, TargetFunctionType, 11145 /*TakingAddress=*/true); 11146 FailedCandidates.NoteCandidates(S, OvlExpr->getLocStart()); 11147 } 11148 } 11149 11150 bool IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const { 11151 return TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction && 11152 !OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer; 11153 } 11154 11155 void ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const { 11156 // TODO: Should we condition this on whether any functions might 11157 // have matched, or is it more appropriate to do that in callers? 11158 // TODO: a fixit wouldn't hurt. 11159 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_qualifier) 11160 << TargetType << OvlExpr->getSourceRange(); 11161 } 11162 11163 bool IsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer() const { 11164 return StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer; 11165 } 11166 11167 void ComplainIsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer() const { 11168 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), 11169 diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function) 11170 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange(); 11171 } 11172 11173 void ComplainOfInvalidConversion() const { 11174 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_not_func_ptrref) 11175 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetType; 11176 } 11177 11178 void ComplainMultipleMatchesFound() const { 11179 assert(Matches.size() > 1); 11180 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous) 11181 << OvlExpr->getName() 11182 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange(); 11183 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType, 11184 /*TakingAddress=*/true); 11185 } 11186 11187 bool hadMultipleCandidates() const { return (OvlExpr->getNumDecls() > 1); } 11188 11189 int getNumMatches() const { return Matches.size(); } 11190 11191 FunctionDecl* getMatchingFunctionDecl() const { 11192 if (Matches.size() != 1) return nullptr; 11193 return Matches[0].second; 11194 } 11195 11196 const DeclAccessPair* getMatchingFunctionAccessPair() const { 11197 if (Matches.size() != 1) return nullptr; 11198 return &Matches[0].first; 11199 } 11200 }; 11201 } 11202 11203 /// ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction - Try to resolve the address of 11204 /// an overloaded function (C++ [over.over]), where @p From is an 11205 /// expression with overloaded function type and @p ToType is the type 11206 /// we're trying to resolve to. For example: 11207 /// 11208 /// @code 11209 /// int f(double); 11210 /// int f(int); 11211 /// 11212 /// int (*pfd)(double) = f; // selects f(double) 11213 /// @endcode 11214 /// 11215 /// This routine returns the resulting FunctionDecl if it could be 11216 /// resolved, and NULL otherwise. When @p Complain is true, this 11217 /// routine will emit diagnostics if there is an error. 11218 FunctionDecl * 11219 Sema::ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *AddressOfExpr, 11220 QualType TargetType, 11221 bool Complain, 11222 DeclAccessPair &FoundResult, 11223 bool *pHadMultipleCandidates) { 11224 assert(AddressOfExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy); 11225 11226 AddressOfFunctionResolver Resolver(*this, AddressOfExpr, TargetType, 11227 Complain); 11228 int NumMatches = Resolver.getNumMatches(); 11229 FunctionDecl *Fn = nullptr; 11230 bool ShouldComplain = Complain && !Resolver.hasComplained(); 11231 if (NumMatches == 0 && ShouldComplain) { 11232 if (Resolver.IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction()) 11233 Resolver.ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction(); 11234 else 11235 Resolver.ComplainNoMatchesFound(); 11236 } 11237 else if (NumMatches > 1 && ShouldComplain) 11238 Resolver.ComplainMultipleMatchesFound(); 11239 else if (NumMatches == 1) { 11240 Fn = Resolver.getMatchingFunctionDecl(); 11241 assert(Fn); 11242 if (auto *FPT = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 11243 ResolveExceptionSpec(AddressOfExpr->getExprLoc(), FPT); 11244 FoundResult = *Resolver.getMatchingFunctionAccessPair(); 11245 if (Complain) { 11246 if (Resolver.IsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer()) 11247 Resolver.ComplainIsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer(); 11248 else 11249 CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(AddressOfExpr, FoundResult); 11250 } 11251 } 11252 11253 if (pHadMultipleCandidates) 11254 *pHadMultipleCandidates = Resolver.hadMultipleCandidates(); 11255 return Fn; 11256 } 11257 11258 /// Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to 11259 /// resolve that function to a single function that can have its address taken. 11260 /// This will modify `Pair` iff it returns non-null. 11261 /// 11262 /// This routine can only realistically succeed if all but one candidates in the 11263 /// overload set for SrcExpr cannot have their addresses taken. 11264 FunctionDecl * 11265 Sema::resolveAddressOfOnlyViableOverloadCandidate(Expr *E, 11266 DeclAccessPair &Pair) { 11267 OverloadExpr::FindResult R = OverloadExpr::find(E); 11268 OverloadExpr *Ovl = R.Expression; 11269 FunctionDecl *Result = nullptr; 11270 DeclAccessPair DAP; 11271 // Don't use the AddressOfResolver because we're specifically looking for 11272 // cases where we have one overload candidate that lacks 11273 // enable_if/pass_object_size/... 11274 for (auto I = Ovl->decls_begin(), E = Ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) { 11275 auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(I->getUnderlyingDecl()); 11276 if (!FD) 11277 return nullptr; 11278 11279 if (!checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD)) 11280 continue; 11281 11282 // We have more than one result; quit. 11283 if (Result) 11284 return nullptr; 11285 DAP = I.getPair(); 11286 Result = FD; 11287 } 11288 11289 if (Result) 11290 Pair = DAP; 11291 return Result; 11292 } 11293 11294 /// Given an overloaded function, tries to turn it into a non-overloaded 11295 /// function reference using resolveAddressOfOnlyViableOverloadCandidate. This 11296 /// will perform access checks, diagnose the use of the resultant decl, and, if 11297 /// requested, potentially perform a function-to-pointer decay. 11298 /// 11299 /// Returns false if resolveAddressOfOnlyViableOverloadCandidate fails. 11300 /// Otherwise, returns true. This may emit diagnostics and return true. 11301 bool Sema::resolveAndFixAddressOfOnlyViableOverloadCandidate( 11302 ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool DoFunctionPointerConverion) { 11303 Expr *E = SrcExpr.get(); 11304 assert(E->getType() == Context.OverloadTy && "SrcExpr must be an overload"); 11305 11306 DeclAccessPair DAP; 11307 FunctionDecl *Found = resolveAddressOfOnlyViableOverloadCandidate(E, DAP); 11308 if (!Found) 11309 return false; 11310 11311 // Emitting multiple diagnostics for a function that is both inaccessible and 11312 // unavailable is consistent with our behavior elsewhere. So, always check 11313 // for both. 11314 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Found, E->getExprLoc()); 11315 CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(E, DAP); 11316 Expr *Fixed = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E, DAP, Found); 11317 if (DoFunctionPointerConverion && Fixed->getType()->isFunctionType()) 11318 SrcExpr = DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Fixed, /*Diagnose=*/false); 11319 else 11320 SrcExpr = Fixed; 11321 return true; 11322 } 11323 11324 /// Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to 11325 /// resolve that overloaded function expression down to a single function. 11326 /// 11327 /// This routine can only resolve template-ids that refer to a single function 11328 /// template, where that template-id refers to a single template whose template 11329 /// arguments are either provided by the template-id or have defaults, 11330 /// as described in C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3. 11331 /// 11332 /// If no template-ids are found, no diagnostics are emitted and NULL is 11333 /// returned. 11334 FunctionDecl * 11335 Sema::ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(OverloadExpr *ovl, 11336 bool Complain, 11337 DeclAccessPair *FoundResult) { 11338 // C++ [over.over]p1: 11339 // [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the 11340 // overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ] 11341 // C++ [over.over]p1: 11342 // [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the & 11343 // operator. 11344 11345 // If we didn't actually find any template-ids, we're done. 11346 if (!ovl->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) 11347 return nullptr; 11348 11349 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitTemplateArgs; 11350 ovl->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(ExplicitTemplateArgs); 11351 TemplateSpecCandidateSet FailedCandidates(ovl->getNameLoc()); 11352 11353 // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one 11354 // whose type matches exactly. 11355 FunctionDecl *Matched = nullptr; 11356 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = ovl->decls_begin(), 11357 E = ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) { 11358 // C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3: 11359 // [...] In contexts where deduction is done and fails, or in contexts 11360 // where deduction is not done, if a template argument list is 11361 // specified and it, along with any default template arguments, 11362 // identifies a single function template specialization, then the 11363 // template-id is an lvalue for the function template specialization. 11364 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate 11365 = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()); 11366 11367 // C++ [over.over]p2: 11368 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is 11369 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the 11370 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single 11371 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of 11372 // overloaded functions considered. 11373 FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr; 11374 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(FailedCandidates.getLocation()); 11375 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result 11376 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, &ExplicitTemplateArgs, 11377 Specialization, Info, 11378 /*IsAddressOfFunction*/true)) { 11379 // Make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics. 11380 // TODO: Actually use the failed-deduction info? 11381 FailedCandidates.addCandidate() 11382 .set(I.getPair(), FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(), 11383 MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, Info)); 11384 continue; 11385 } 11386 11387 assert(Specialization && "no specialization and no error?"); 11388 11389 // Multiple matches; we can't resolve to a single declaration. 11390 if (Matched) { 11391 if (Complain) { 11392 Diag(ovl->getExprLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous) 11393 << ovl->getName(); 11394 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(ovl); 11395 } 11396 return nullptr; 11397 } 11398 11399 Matched = Specialization; 11400 if (FoundResult) *FoundResult = I.getPair(); 11401 } 11402 11403 if (Matched && 11404 completeFunctionType(*this, Matched, ovl->getExprLoc(), Complain)) 11405 return nullptr; 11406 11407 return Matched; 11408 } 11409 11410 // Resolve and fix an overloaded expression that can be resolved 11411 // because it identifies a single function template specialization. 11412 // 11413 // Last three arguments should only be supplied if Complain = true 11414 // 11415 // Return true if it was logically possible to so resolve the 11416 // expression, regardless of whether or not it succeeded. Always 11417 // returns true if 'complain' is set. 11418 bool Sema::ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization( 11419 ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool doFunctionPointerConverion, 11420 bool complain, SourceRange OpRangeForComplaining, 11421 QualType DestTypeForComplaining, 11422 unsigned DiagIDForComplaining) { 11423 assert(SrcExpr.get()->getType() == Context.OverloadTy); 11424 11425 OverloadExpr::FindResult ovl = OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr.get()); 11426 11427 DeclAccessPair found; 11428 ExprResult SingleFunctionExpression; 11429 if (FunctionDecl *fn = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization( 11430 ovl.Expression, /*complain*/ false, &found)) { 11431 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(fn, SrcExpr.get()->getLocStart())) { 11432 SrcExpr = ExprError(); 11433 return true; 11434 } 11435 11436 // It is only correct to resolve to an instance method if we're 11437 // resolving a form that's permitted to be a pointer to member. 11438 // Otherwise we'll end up making a bound member expression, which 11439 // is illegal in all the contexts we resolve like this. 11440 if (!ovl.HasFormOfMemberPointer && 11441 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(fn) && 11442 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(fn)->isInstance()) { 11443 if (!complain) return false; 11444 11445 Diag(ovl.Expression->getExprLoc(), 11446 diag::err_bound_member_function) 11447 << 0 << ovl.Expression->getSourceRange(); 11448 11449 // TODO: I believe we only end up here if there's a mix of 11450 // static and non-static candidates (otherwise the expression 11451 // would have 'bound member' type, not 'overload' type). 11452 // Ideally we would note which candidate was chosen and why 11453 // the static candidates were rejected. 11454 SrcExpr = ExprError(); 11455 return true; 11456 } 11457 11458 // Fix the expression to refer to 'fn'. 11459 SingleFunctionExpression = 11460 FixOverloadedFunctionReference(SrcExpr.get(), found, fn); 11461 11462 // If desired, do function-to-pointer decay. 11463 if (doFunctionPointerConverion) { 11464 SingleFunctionExpression = 11465 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(SingleFunctionExpression.get()); 11466 if (SingleFunctionExpression.isInvalid()) { 11467 SrcExpr = ExprError(); 11468 return true; 11469 } 11470 } 11471 } 11472 11473 if (!SingleFunctionExpression.isUsable()) { 11474 if (complain) { 11475 Diag(OpRangeForComplaining.getBegin(), DiagIDForComplaining) 11476 << ovl.Expression->getName() 11477 << DestTypeForComplaining 11478 << OpRangeForComplaining 11479 << ovl.Expression->getQualifierLoc().getSourceRange(); 11480 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(SrcExpr.get()); 11481 11482 SrcExpr = ExprError(); 11483 return true; 11484 } 11485 11486 return false; 11487 } 11488 11489 SrcExpr = SingleFunctionExpression; 11490 return true; 11491 } 11492 11493 /// Add a single candidate to the overload set. 11494 static void AddOverloadedCallCandidate(Sema &S, 11495 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, 11496 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 11497 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 11498 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 11499 bool PartialOverloading, 11500 bool KnownValid) { 11501 NamedDecl *Callee = FoundDecl.getDecl(); 11502 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)) 11503 Callee = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)->getTargetDecl(); 11504 11505 if (FunctionDecl *Func = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Callee)) { 11506 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) { 11507 assert(!KnownValid && "Explicit template arguments?"); 11508 return; 11509 } 11510 // Prevent ill-formed function decls to be added as overload candidates. 11511 if (!dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Func->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>())) 11512 return; 11513 11514 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Func, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, 11515 /*SuppressUsedConversions=*/false, 11516 PartialOverloading); 11517 return; 11518 } 11519 11520 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FuncTemplate 11521 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Callee)) { 11522 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FuncTemplate, FoundDecl, 11523 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, CandidateSet, 11524 /*SuppressUsedConversions=*/false, 11525 PartialOverloading); 11526 return; 11527 } 11528 11529 assert(!KnownValid && "unhandled case in overloaded call candidate"); 11530 } 11531 11532 /// Add the overload candidates named by callee and/or found by argument 11533 /// dependent lookup to the given overload set. 11534 void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 11535 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 11536 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, 11537 bool PartialOverloading) { 11538 11539 #ifndef NDEBUG 11540 // Verify that ArgumentDependentLookup is consistent with the rules 11541 // in C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3: 11542 // 11543 // Let X be the lookup set produced by unqualified lookup (3.4.1) 11544 // and let Y be the lookup set produced by argument dependent 11545 // lookup (defined as follows). If X contains 11546 // 11547 // -- a declaration of a class member, or 11548 // 11549 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a 11550 // using-declaration, or 11551 // 11552 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function 11553 // template 11554 // 11555 // then Y is empty. 11556 11557 if (ULE->requiresADL()) { 11558 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(), 11559 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) { 11560 assert(!(*I)->getDeclContext()->isRecord()); 11561 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(*I) || 11562 !(*I)->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()); 11563 assert((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate()); 11564 } 11565 } 11566 #endif 11567 11568 // It would be nice to avoid this copy. 11569 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer; 11570 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = nullptr; 11571 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 11572 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer); 11573 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer; 11574 } 11575 11576 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(), 11577 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) 11578 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, 11579 CandidateSet, PartialOverloading, 11580 /*KnownValid*/ true); 11581 11582 if (ULE->requiresADL()) 11583 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ULE->getName(), ULE->getExprLoc(), 11584 Args, ExplicitTemplateArgs, 11585 CandidateSet, PartialOverloading); 11586 } 11587 11588 /// Determine whether a declaration with the specified name could be moved into 11589 /// a different namespace. 11590 static bool canBeDeclaredInNamespace(const DeclarationName &Name) { 11591 switch (Name.getCXXOverloadedOperator()) { 11592 case OO_New: case OO_Array_New: 11593 case OO_Delete: case OO_Array_Delete: 11594 return false; 11595 11596 default: 11597 return true; 11598 } 11599 } 11600 11601 /// Attempt to recover from an ill-formed use of a non-dependent name in a 11602 /// template, where the non-dependent name was declared after the template 11603 /// was defined. This is common in code written for a compilers which do not 11604 /// correctly implement two-stage name lookup. 11605 /// 11606 /// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued. 11607 static bool 11608 DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation FnLoc, 11609 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R, 11610 OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK, 11611 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 11612 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 11613 bool *DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup = nullptr) { 11614 if (!SemaRef.inTemplateInstantiation() || !SS.isEmpty()) 11615 return false; 11616 11617 for (DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.CurContext; DC; DC = DC->getParent()) { 11618 if (DC->isTransparentContext()) 11619 continue; 11620 11621 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC); 11622 11623 if (!R.empty()) { 11624 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 11625 11626 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) { 11627 // Don't diagnose names we find in classes; we get much better 11628 // diagnostics for these from DiagnoseEmptyLookup. 11629 R.clear(); 11630 if (DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup) 11631 *DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup = true; 11632 return false; 11633 } 11634 11635 OverloadCandidateSet Candidates(FnLoc, CSK); 11636 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) 11637 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(SemaRef, I.getPair(), 11638 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, 11639 Candidates, false, /*KnownValid*/ false); 11640 11641 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 11642 if (Candidates.BestViableFunction(SemaRef, FnLoc, Best) != OR_Success) { 11643 // No viable functions. Don't bother the user with notes for functions 11644 // which don't work and shouldn't be found anyway. 11645 R.clear(); 11646 return false; 11647 } 11648 11649 // Find the namespaces where ADL would have looked, and suggest 11650 // declaring the function there instead. 11651 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet AssociatedNamespaces; 11652 Sema::AssociatedClassSet AssociatedClasses; 11653 SemaRef.FindAssociatedClassesAndNamespaces(FnLoc, Args, 11654 AssociatedNamespaces, 11655 AssociatedClasses); 11656 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet SuggestedNamespaces; 11657 if (canBeDeclaredInNamespace(R.getLookupName())) { 11658 DeclContext *Std = SemaRef.getStdNamespace(); 11659 for (Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet::iterator 11660 it = AssociatedNamespaces.begin(), 11661 end = AssociatedNamespaces.end(); it != end; ++it) { 11662 // Never suggest declaring a function within namespace 'std'. 11663 if (Std && Std->Encloses(*it)) 11664 continue; 11665 11666 // Never suggest declaring a function within a namespace with a 11667 // reserved name, like __gnu_cxx. 11668 NamespaceDecl *NS = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(*it); 11669 if (NS && 11670 NS->getQualifiedNameAsString().find("__") != std::string::npos) 11671 continue; 11672 11673 SuggestedNamespaces.insert(*it); 11674 } 11675 } 11676 11677 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup) 11678 << R.getLookupName(); 11679 if (SuggestedNamespaces.empty()) { 11680 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(), 11681 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup) 11682 << R.getLookupName() << 0; 11683 } else if (SuggestedNamespaces.size() == 1) { 11684 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(), 11685 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup) 11686 << R.getLookupName() << 1 << *SuggestedNamespaces.begin(); 11687 } else { 11688 // FIXME: It would be useful to list the associated namespaces here, 11689 // but the diagnostics infrastructure doesn't provide a way to produce 11690 // a localized representation of a list of items. 11691 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(), 11692 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup) 11693 << R.getLookupName() << 2; 11694 } 11695 11696 // Try to recover by calling this function. 11697 return true; 11698 } 11699 11700 R.clear(); 11701 } 11702 11703 return false; 11704 } 11705 11706 /// Attempt to recover from ill-formed use of a non-dependent operator in a 11707 /// template, where the non-dependent operator was declared after the template 11708 /// was defined. 11709 /// 11710 /// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued. 11711 static bool 11712 DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(Sema &SemaRef, OverloadedOperatorKind Op, 11713 SourceLocation OpLoc, 11714 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) { 11715 DeclarationName OpName = 11716 SemaRef.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 11717 LookupResult R(SemaRef, OpName, OpLoc, Sema::LookupOperatorName); 11718 return DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec(), R, 11719 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator, 11720 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs=*/nullptr, Args); 11721 } 11722 11723 namespace { 11724 class BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII { 11725 Sema &SemaRef; 11726 public: 11727 BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII(Sema &S) : SemaRef(S) { 11728 assert(SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr == false); 11729 SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = true; 11730 } 11731 11732 ~BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII() { 11733 SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = false; 11734 } 11735 }; 11736 11737 } 11738 11739 static std::unique_ptr<CorrectionCandidateCallback> 11740 MakeValidator(Sema &SemaRef, MemberExpr *ME, size_t NumArgs, 11741 bool HasTemplateArgs, bool AllowTypoCorrection) { 11742 if (!AllowTypoCorrection) 11743 return llvm::make_unique<NoTypoCorrectionCCC>(); 11744 return llvm::make_unique<FunctionCallFilterCCC>(SemaRef, NumArgs, 11745 HasTemplateArgs, ME); 11746 } 11747 11748 /// Attempts to recover from a call where no functions were found. 11749 /// 11750 /// Returns true if new candidates were found. 11751 static ExprResult 11752 BuildRecoveryCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn, 11753 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 11754 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 11755 MutableArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 11756 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 11757 bool EmptyLookup, bool AllowTypoCorrection) { 11758 // Do not try to recover if it is already building a recovery call. 11759 // This stops infinite loops for template instantiations like 11760 // 11761 // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(t)) {} 11762 // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(&t)) {} 11763 // 11764 if (SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr) 11765 return ExprError(); 11766 BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII RCE(SemaRef); 11767 11768 CXXScopeSpec SS; 11769 SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc()); 11770 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc = ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(); 11771 11772 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer; 11773 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = nullptr; 11774 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 11775 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer); 11776 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer; 11777 } 11778 11779 LookupResult R(SemaRef, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(), 11780 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName); 11781 bool DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup = EmptyLookup; 11782 if (!DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, Fn->getExprLoc(), SS, R, 11783 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal, 11784 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, 11785 &DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup) && 11786 (!DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup || SemaRef.DiagnoseEmptyLookup( 11787 S, SS, R, 11788 MakeValidator(SemaRef, dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Fn), Args.size(), 11789 ExplicitTemplateArgs != nullptr, AllowTypoCorrection), 11790 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args))) 11791 return ExprError(); 11792 11793 assert(!R.empty() && "lookup results empty despite recovery"); 11794 11795 // If recovery created an ambiguity, just bail out. 11796 if (R.isAmbiguous()) { 11797 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 11798 return ExprError(); 11799 } 11800 11801 // Build an implicit member call if appropriate. Just drop the 11802 // casts and such from the call, we don't really care. 11803 ExprResult NewFn = ExprError(); 11804 if ((*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) 11805 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, 11806 ExplicitTemplateArgs, S); 11807 else if (ExplicitTemplateArgs || TemplateKWLoc.isValid()) 11808 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, false, 11809 ExplicitTemplateArgs); 11810 else 11811 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false); 11812 11813 if (NewFn.isInvalid()) 11814 return ExprError(); 11815 11816 // This shouldn't cause an infinite loop because we're giving it 11817 // an expression with viable lookup results, which should never 11818 // end up here. 11819 return SemaRef.ActOnCallExpr(/*Scope*/ nullptr, NewFn.get(), LParenLoc, 11820 MultiExprArg(Args.data(), Args.size()), 11821 RParenLoc); 11822 } 11823 11824 /// Constructs and populates an OverloadedCandidateSet from 11825 /// the given function. 11826 /// \returns true when an the ExprResult output parameter has been set. 11827 bool Sema::buildOverloadedCallSet(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, 11828 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 11829 MultiExprArg Args, 11830 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 11831 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet, 11832 ExprResult *Result) { 11833 #ifndef NDEBUG 11834 if (ULE->requiresADL()) { 11835 // To do ADL, we must have found an unqualified name. 11836 assert(!ULE->getQualifier() && "qualified name with ADL"); 11837 11838 // We don't perform ADL for implicit declarations of builtins. 11839 // Verify that this was correctly set up. 11840 FunctionDecl *F; 11841 if (ULE->decls_begin() + 1 == ULE->decls_end() && 11842 (F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*ULE->decls_begin())) && 11843 F->getBuiltinID() && F->isImplicit()) 11844 llvm_unreachable("performing ADL for builtin"); 11845 11846 // We don't perform ADL in C. 11847 assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "ADL enabled in C"); 11848 } 11849 #endif 11850 11851 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts; 11852 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts)) { 11853 *Result = ExprError(); 11854 return true; 11855 } 11856 11857 // Add the functions denoted by the callee to the set of candidate 11858 // functions, including those from argument-dependent lookup. 11859 AddOverloadedCallCandidates(ULE, Args, *CandidateSet); 11860 11861 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && 11862 CurContext->isDependentContext() && !isSFINAEContext() && 11863 (isa<FunctionDecl>(CurContext) || isa<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext))) { 11864 11865 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 11866 if (CandidateSet->empty() || 11867 CandidateSet->BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best) == 11868 OR_No_Viable_Function) { 11869 // In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class member function then 11870 // create a type dependent CallExpr. The goal is to postpone name lookup 11871 // to instantiation time to be able to search into type dependent base 11872 // classes. 11873 CallExpr *CE = new (Context) CallExpr( 11874 Context, Fn, Args, Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, RParenLoc); 11875 CE->setTypeDependent(true); 11876 CE->setValueDependent(true); 11877 CE->setInstantiationDependent(true); 11878 *Result = CE; 11879 return true; 11880 } 11881 } 11882 11883 if (CandidateSet->empty()) 11884 return false; 11885 11886 UnbridgedCasts.restore(); 11887 return false; 11888 } 11889 11890 /// FinishOverloadedCallExpr - given an OverloadCandidateSet, builds and returns 11891 /// the completed call expression. If overload resolution fails, emits 11892 /// diagnostics and returns ExprError() 11893 static ExprResult FinishOverloadedCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn, 11894 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 11895 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 11896 MultiExprArg Args, 11897 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 11898 Expr *ExecConfig, 11899 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet, 11900 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator *Best, 11901 OverloadingResult OverloadResult, 11902 bool AllowTypoCorrection) { 11903 if (CandidateSet->empty()) 11904 return BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, 11905 RParenLoc, /*EmptyLookup=*/true, 11906 AllowTypoCorrection); 11907 11908 switch (OverloadResult) { 11909 case OR_Success: { 11910 FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function; 11911 SemaRef.CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(ULE, (*Best)->FoundDecl); 11912 if (SemaRef.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FDecl, ULE->getNameLoc())) 11913 return ExprError(); 11914 Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl); 11915 return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc, 11916 ExecConfig); 11917 } 11918 11919 case OR_No_Viable_Function: { 11920 // Try to recover by looking for viable functions which the user might 11921 // have meant to call. 11922 ExprResult Recovery = BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, 11923 Args, RParenLoc, 11924 /*EmptyLookup=*/false, 11925 AllowTypoCorrection); 11926 if (!Recovery.isInvalid()) 11927 return Recovery; 11928 11929 // If the user passes in a function that we can't take the address of, we 11930 // generally end up emitting really bad error messages. Here, we attempt to 11931 // emit better ones. 11932 for (const Expr *Arg : Args) { 11933 if (!Arg->getType()->isFunctionType()) 11934 continue; 11935 if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Arg->IgnoreParenImpCasts())) { 11936 auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl()); 11937 if (FD && 11938 !SemaRef.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD, /*Complain=*/true, 11939 Arg->getExprLoc())) 11940 return ExprError(); 11941 } 11942 } 11943 11944 SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call) 11945 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange(); 11946 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 11947 break; 11948 } 11949 11950 case OR_Ambiguous: 11951 SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call) 11952 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange(); 11953 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args); 11954 break; 11955 11956 case OR_Deleted: { 11957 SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_call) 11958 << (*Best)->Function->isDeleted() 11959 << ULE->getName() 11960 << SemaRef.getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix((*Best)->Function) 11961 << Fn->getSourceRange(); 11962 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 11963 11964 // We emitted an error for the unavailable/deleted function call but keep 11965 // the call in the AST. 11966 FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function; 11967 Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl); 11968 return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc, 11969 ExecConfig); 11970 } 11971 } 11972 11973 // Overload resolution failed. 11974 return ExprError(); 11975 } 11976 11977 static void markUnaddressableCandidatesUnviable(Sema &S, 11978 OverloadCandidateSet &CS) { 11979 for (auto I = CS.begin(), E = CS.end(); I != E; ++I) { 11980 if (I->Viable && 11981 !S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(I->Function, /*Complain=*/false)) { 11982 I->Viable = false; 11983 I->FailureKind = ovl_fail_addr_not_available; 11984 } 11985 } 11986 } 11987 11988 /// BuildOverloadedCallExpr - Given the call expression that calls Fn 11989 /// (which eventually refers to the declaration Func) and the call 11990 /// arguments Args/NumArgs, attempt to resolve the function call down 11991 /// to a specific function. If overload resolution succeeds, returns 11992 /// the call expression produced by overload resolution. 11993 /// Otherwise, emits diagnostics and returns ExprError. 11994 ExprResult Sema::BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, 11995 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE, 11996 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 11997 MultiExprArg Args, 11998 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 11999 Expr *ExecConfig, 12000 bool AllowTypoCorrection, 12001 bool CalleesAddressIsTaken) { 12002 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Fn->getExprLoc(), 12003 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 12004 ExprResult result; 12005 12006 if (buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, ULE, Args, LParenLoc, &CandidateSet, 12007 &result)) 12008 return result; 12009 12010 // If the user handed us something like `(&Foo)(Bar)`, we need to ensure that 12011 // functions that aren't addressible are considered unviable. 12012 if (CalleesAddressIsTaken) 12013 markUnaddressableCandidatesUnviable(*this, CandidateSet); 12014 12015 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 12016 OverloadingResult OverloadResult = 12017 CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best); 12018 12019 return FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, 12020 RParenLoc, ExecConfig, &CandidateSet, 12021 &Best, OverloadResult, 12022 AllowTypoCorrection); 12023 } 12024 12025 static bool IsOverloaded(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions) { 12026 return Functions.size() > 1 || 12027 (Functions.size() == 1 && isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*Functions.begin())); 12028 } 12029 12030 /// Create a unary operation that may resolve to an overloaded 12031 /// operator. 12032 /// 12033 /// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '*'). 12034 /// 12035 /// \param Opc The UnaryOperatorKind that describes this operator. 12036 /// 12037 /// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be 12038 /// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this 12039 /// set based on the context using, e.g., 12040 /// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This 12041 /// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added 12042 /// by CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(). 12043 /// 12044 /// \param Input The input argument. 12045 ExprResult 12046 Sema::CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, UnaryOperatorKind Opc, 12047 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, 12048 Expr *Input, bool PerformADL) { 12049 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc); 12050 assert(Op != OO_None && "Invalid opcode for overloaded unary operator"); 12051 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 12052 // TODO: provide better source location info. 12053 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc); 12054 12055 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Input)) 12056 return ExprError(); 12057 12058 Expr *Args[2] = { Input, nullptr }; 12059 unsigned NumArgs = 1; 12060 12061 // For post-increment and post-decrement, add the implicit '0' as 12062 // the second argument, so that we know this is a post-increment or 12063 // post-decrement. 12064 if (Opc == UO_PostInc || Opc == UO_PostDec) { 12065 llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false); 12066 Args[1] = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy, 12067 SourceLocation()); 12068 NumArgs = 2; 12069 } 12070 12071 ArrayRef<Expr *> ArgsArray(Args, NumArgs); 12072 12073 if (Input->isTypeDependent()) { 12074 if (Fns.empty()) 12075 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, Context.DependentTy, 12076 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, OpLoc, false); 12077 12078 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators 12079 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn 12080 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass, 12081 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo, 12082 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns), 12083 Fns.begin(), Fns.end()); 12084 return new (Context) 12085 CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn, ArgsArray, Context.DependentTy, 12086 VK_RValue, OpLoc, FPOptions()); 12087 } 12088 12089 // Build an empty overload set. 12090 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator); 12091 12092 // Add the candidates from the given function set. 12093 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, ArgsArray, CandidateSet); 12094 12095 // Add operator candidates that are member functions. 12096 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray, CandidateSet); 12097 12098 // Add candidates from ADL. 12099 if (PerformADL) { 12100 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, OpLoc, ArgsArray, 12101 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/nullptr, 12102 CandidateSet); 12103 } 12104 12105 // Add builtin operator candidates. 12106 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray, CandidateSet); 12107 12108 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 12109 12110 // Perform overload resolution. 12111 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 12112 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) { 12113 case OR_Success: { 12114 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator. 12115 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function; 12116 12117 if (FnDecl) { 12118 Expr *Base = nullptr; 12119 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that 12120 // operator. 12121 12122 // Convert the arguments. 12123 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) { 12124 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], nullptr, Best->FoundDecl); 12125 12126 ExprResult InputRes = 12127 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Input, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, 12128 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 12129 if (InputRes.isInvalid()) 12130 return ExprError(); 12131 Base = Input = InputRes.get(); 12132 } else { 12133 // Convert the arguments. 12134 ExprResult InputInit 12135 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 12136 Context, 12137 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 12138 SourceLocation(), 12139 Input); 12140 if (InputInit.isInvalid()) 12141 return ExprError(); 12142 Input = InputInit.get(); 12143 } 12144 12145 // Build the actual expression node. 12146 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, Best->FoundDecl, 12147 Base, HadMultipleCandidates, 12148 OpLoc); 12149 if (FnExpr.isInvalid()) 12150 return ExprError(); 12151 12152 // Determine the result type. 12153 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType(); 12154 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 12155 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 12156 12157 Args[0] = Input; 12158 CallExpr *TheCall = 12159 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.get(), ArgsArray, 12160 ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, FPOptions()); 12161 12162 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall, FnDecl)) 12163 return ExprError(); 12164 12165 if (CheckFunctionCall(FnDecl, TheCall, 12166 FnDecl->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>())) 12167 return ExprError(); 12168 12169 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 12170 } else { 12171 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then 12172 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in 12173 // operator node. 12174 ExprResult InputRes = PerformImplicitConversion( 12175 Input, Best->BuiltinParamTypes[0], Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing); 12176 if (InputRes.isInvalid()) 12177 return ExprError(); 12178 Input = InputRes.get(); 12179 break; 12180 } 12181 } 12182 12183 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 12184 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by 12185 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were 12186 // defined too late to be candidates. 12187 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray)) 12188 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function. 12189 return ExprError(); 12190 12191 // No viable function; fall through to handling this as a 12192 // built-in operator, which will produce an error message for us. 12193 break; 12194 12195 case OR_Ambiguous: 12196 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary) 12197 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 12198 << Input->getType() 12199 << Input->getSourceRange(); 12200 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, ArgsArray, 12201 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc); 12202 return ExprError(); 12203 12204 case OR_Deleted: 12205 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 12206 << Best->Function->isDeleted() 12207 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 12208 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function) 12209 << Input->getSourceRange(); 12210 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, ArgsArray, 12211 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc); 12212 return ExprError(); 12213 } 12214 12215 // Either we found no viable overloaded operator or we matched a 12216 // built-in operator. In either case, fall through to trying to 12217 // build a built-in operation. 12218 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input); 12219 } 12220 12221 /// Create a binary operation that may resolve to an overloaded 12222 /// operator. 12223 /// 12224 /// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '+'). 12225 /// 12226 /// \param Opc The BinaryOperatorKind that describes this operator. 12227 /// 12228 /// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be 12229 /// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this 12230 /// set based on the context using, e.g., 12231 /// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This 12232 /// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added 12233 /// by CreateOverloadedBinOp(). 12234 /// 12235 /// \param LHS Left-hand argument. 12236 /// \param RHS Right-hand argument. 12237 ExprResult 12238 Sema::CreateOverloadedBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, 12239 BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 12240 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, 12241 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS, bool PerformADL) { 12242 Expr *Args[2] = { LHS, RHS }; 12243 LHS=RHS=nullptr; // Please use only Args instead of LHS/RHS couple 12244 12245 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc); 12246 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op); 12247 12248 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent 12249 // expression. 12250 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) { 12251 if (Fns.empty()) { 12252 // If there are no functions to store, just build a dependent 12253 // BinaryOperator or CompoundAssignment. 12254 if (Opc <= BO_Assign || Opc > BO_OrAssign) 12255 return new (Context) BinaryOperator( 12256 Args[0], Args[1], Opc, Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, 12257 OpLoc, FPFeatures); 12258 12259 return new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator( 12260 Args[0], Args[1], Opc, Context.DependentTy, VK_LValue, OK_Ordinary, 12261 Context.DependentTy, Context.DependentTy, OpLoc, 12262 FPFeatures); 12263 } 12264 12265 // FIXME: save results of ADL from here? 12266 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators 12267 // TODO: provide better source location info in DNLoc component. 12268 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc); 12269 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn 12270 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass, 12271 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo, 12272 /*ADL*/PerformADL, IsOverloaded(Fns), 12273 Fns.begin(), Fns.end()); 12274 return new (Context) 12275 CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn, Args, Context.DependentTy, 12276 VK_RValue, OpLoc, FPFeatures); 12277 } 12278 12279 // Always do placeholder-like conversions on the RHS. 12280 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1])) 12281 return ExprError(); 12282 12283 // Do placeholder-like conversion on the LHS; note that we should 12284 // not get here with a PseudoObject LHS. 12285 assert(Args[0]->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty); 12286 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0])) 12287 return ExprError(); 12288 12289 // If this is the assignment operator, we only perform overload resolution 12290 // if the left-hand side is a class or enumeration type. This is actually 12291 // a hack. The standard requires that we do overload resolution between the 12292 // various built-in candidates, but as DR507 points out, this can lead to 12293 // problems. So we do it this way, which pretty much follows what GCC does. 12294 // Note that we go the traditional code path for compound assignment forms. 12295 if (Opc == BO_Assign && !Args[0]->getType()->isOverloadableType()) 12296 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 12297 12298 // If this is the .* operator, which is not overloadable, just 12299 // create a built-in binary operator. 12300 if (Opc == BO_PtrMemD) 12301 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 12302 12303 // Build an empty overload set. 12304 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator); 12305 12306 // Add the candidates from the given function set. 12307 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, Args, CandidateSet); 12308 12309 // Add operator candidates that are member functions. 12310 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet); 12311 12312 // Add candidates from ADL. Per [over.match.oper]p2, this lookup is not 12313 // performed for an assignment operator (nor for operator[] nor operator->, 12314 // which don't get here). 12315 if (Opc != BO_Assign && PerformADL) 12316 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, OpLoc, Args, 12317 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ nullptr, 12318 CandidateSet); 12319 12320 // Add builtin operator candidates. 12321 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet); 12322 12323 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 12324 12325 // Perform overload resolution. 12326 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 12327 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) { 12328 case OR_Success: { 12329 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator. 12330 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function; 12331 12332 if (FnDecl) { 12333 Expr *Base = nullptr; 12334 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that 12335 // operator. 12336 12337 // Convert the arguments. 12338 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) { 12339 // Best->Access is only meaningful for class members. 12340 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl); 12341 12342 ExprResult Arg1 = 12343 PerformCopyInitialization( 12344 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, 12345 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 12346 SourceLocation(), Args[1]); 12347 if (Arg1.isInvalid()) 12348 return ExprError(); 12349 12350 ExprResult Arg0 = 12351 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, 12352 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 12353 if (Arg0.isInvalid()) 12354 return ExprError(); 12355 Base = Args[0] = Arg0.getAs<Expr>(); 12356 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.getAs<Expr>(); 12357 } else { 12358 // Convert the arguments. 12359 ExprResult Arg0 = PerformCopyInitialization( 12360 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, 12361 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 12362 SourceLocation(), Args[0]); 12363 if (Arg0.isInvalid()) 12364 return ExprError(); 12365 12366 ExprResult Arg1 = 12367 PerformCopyInitialization( 12368 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, 12369 FnDecl->getParamDecl(1)), 12370 SourceLocation(), Args[1]); 12371 if (Arg1.isInvalid()) 12372 return ExprError(); 12373 Args[0] = LHS = Arg0.getAs<Expr>(); 12374 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.getAs<Expr>(); 12375 } 12376 12377 // Build the actual expression node. 12378 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, 12379 Best->FoundDecl, Base, 12380 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc); 12381 if (FnExpr.isInvalid()) 12382 return ExprError(); 12383 12384 // Determine the result type. 12385 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType(); 12386 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 12387 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 12388 12389 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = 12390 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.get(), 12391 Args, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, 12392 FPFeatures); 12393 12394 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall, 12395 FnDecl)) 12396 return ExprError(); 12397 12398 ArrayRef<const Expr *> ArgsArray(Args, 2); 12399 const Expr *ImplicitThis = nullptr; 12400 // Cut off the implicit 'this'. 12401 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) { 12402 ImplicitThis = ArgsArray[0]; 12403 ArgsArray = ArgsArray.slice(1); 12404 } 12405 12406 // Check for a self move. 12407 if (Op == OO_Equal) 12408 DiagnoseSelfMove(Args[0], Args[1], OpLoc); 12409 12410 checkCall(FnDecl, nullptr, ImplicitThis, ArgsArray, 12411 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl), OpLoc, TheCall->getSourceRange(), 12412 VariadicDoesNotApply); 12413 12414 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 12415 } else { 12416 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then 12417 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in 12418 // operator node. 12419 ExprResult ArgsRes0 = 12420 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[0], 12421 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing); 12422 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid()) 12423 return ExprError(); 12424 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.get(); 12425 12426 ExprResult ArgsRes1 = 12427 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[1], 12428 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing); 12429 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid()) 12430 return ExprError(); 12431 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.get(); 12432 break; 12433 } 12434 } 12435 12436 case OR_No_Viable_Function: { 12437 // C++ [over.match.oper]p9: 12438 // If the operator is the operator , [...] and there are no 12439 // viable functions, then the operator is assumed to be the 12440 // built-in operator and interpreted according to clause 5. 12441 if (Opc == BO_Comma) 12442 break; 12443 12444 // For class as left operand for assignment or compound assignment 12445 // operator do not fall through to handling in built-in, but report that 12446 // no overloaded assignment operator found 12447 ExprResult Result = ExprError(); 12448 if (Args[0]->getType()->isRecordType() && 12449 Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign) { 12450 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper) 12451 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 12452 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 12453 if (Args[0]->getType()->isIncompleteType()) { 12454 Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_assign_lhs_incomplete) 12455 << Args[0]->getType() 12456 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 12457 } 12458 } else { 12459 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by 12460 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were 12461 // defined too late to be candidates. 12462 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, Args)) 12463 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function. 12464 return ExprError(); 12465 12466 // No viable function; try to create a built-in operation, which will 12467 // produce an error. Then, show the non-viable candidates. 12468 Result = CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 12469 } 12470 assert(Result.isInvalid() && 12471 "C++ binary operator overloading is missing candidates!"); 12472 if (Result.isInvalid()) 12473 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 12474 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc); 12475 return Result; 12476 } 12477 12478 case OR_Ambiguous: 12479 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary) 12480 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 12481 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType() 12482 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 12483 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, 12484 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc); 12485 return ExprError(); 12486 12487 case OR_Deleted: 12488 if (isImplicitlyDeleted(Best->Function)) { 12489 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function); 12490 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_special_oper) 12491 << Context.getRecordType(Method->getParent()) 12492 << getSpecialMember(Method); 12493 12494 // The user probably meant to call this special member. Just 12495 // explain why it's deleted. 12496 NoteDeletedFunction(Method); 12497 return ExprError(); 12498 } else { 12499 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 12500 << Best->Function->isDeleted() 12501 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 12502 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function) 12503 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 12504 } 12505 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 12506 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc); 12507 return ExprError(); 12508 } 12509 12510 // We matched a built-in operator; build it. 12511 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]); 12512 } 12513 12514 ExprResult 12515 Sema::CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(SourceLocation LLoc, 12516 SourceLocation RLoc, 12517 Expr *Base, Expr *Idx) { 12518 Expr *Args[2] = { Base, Idx }; 12519 DeclarationName OpName = 12520 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Subscript); 12521 12522 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent 12523 // expression. 12524 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) { 12525 12526 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators 12527 // CHECKME: no 'operator' keyword? 12528 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, LLoc); 12529 OpNameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc)); 12530 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn 12531 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass, 12532 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo, 12533 /*ADL*/ true, /*Overloaded*/ false, 12534 UnresolvedSetIterator(), 12535 UnresolvedSetIterator()); 12536 // Can't add any actual overloads yet 12537 12538 return new (Context) 12539 CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript, Fn, Args, 12540 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, RLoc, FPOptions()); 12541 } 12542 12543 // Handle placeholders on both operands. 12544 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0])) 12545 return ExprError(); 12546 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1])) 12547 return ExprError(); 12548 12549 // Build an empty overload set. 12550 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator); 12551 12552 // Subscript can only be overloaded as a member function. 12553 12554 // Add operator candidates that are member functions. 12555 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, CandidateSet); 12556 12557 // Add builtin operator candidates. 12558 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, CandidateSet); 12559 12560 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 12561 12562 // Perform overload resolution. 12563 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 12564 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, LLoc, Best)) { 12565 case OR_Success: { 12566 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator. 12567 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function; 12568 12569 if (FnDecl) { 12570 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that 12571 // operator. 12572 12573 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl); 12574 12575 // Convert the arguments. 12576 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl); 12577 ExprResult Arg0 = 12578 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, 12579 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 12580 if (Arg0.isInvalid()) 12581 return ExprError(); 12582 Args[0] = Arg0.get(); 12583 12584 // Convert the arguments. 12585 ExprResult InputInit 12586 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 12587 Context, 12588 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)), 12589 SourceLocation(), 12590 Args[1]); 12591 if (InputInit.isInvalid()) 12592 return ExprError(); 12593 12594 Args[1] = InputInit.getAs<Expr>(); 12595 12596 // Build the actual expression node. 12597 DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(OpName, LLoc); 12598 OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc)); 12599 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, 12600 Best->FoundDecl, 12601 Base, 12602 HadMultipleCandidates, 12603 OpLocInfo.getLoc(), 12604 OpLocInfo.getInfo()); 12605 if (FnExpr.isInvalid()) 12606 return ExprError(); 12607 12608 // Determine the result type 12609 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType(); 12610 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 12611 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 12612 12613 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = 12614 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript, 12615 FnExpr.get(), Args, 12616 ResultTy, VK, RLoc, 12617 FPOptions()); 12618 12619 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), LLoc, TheCall, FnDecl)) 12620 return ExprError(); 12621 12622 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, 12623 Method->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>())) 12624 return ExprError(); 12625 12626 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 12627 } else { 12628 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then 12629 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in 12630 // operator node. 12631 ExprResult ArgsRes0 = 12632 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[0], 12633 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing); 12634 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid()) 12635 return ExprError(); 12636 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.get(); 12637 12638 ExprResult ArgsRes1 = 12639 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[1], 12640 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing); 12641 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid()) 12642 return ExprError(); 12643 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.get(); 12644 12645 break; 12646 } 12647 } 12648 12649 case OR_No_Viable_Function: { 12650 if (CandidateSet.empty()) 12651 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_oper) 12652 << Args[0]->getType() << /*subscript*/ 0 12653 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 12654 else 12655 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_subscript) 12656 << Args[0]->getType() 12657 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 12658 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 12659 "[]", LLoc); 12660 return ExprError(); 12661 } 12662 12663 case OR_Ambiguous: 12664 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary) 12665 << "[]" 12666 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType() 12667 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 12668 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, 12669 "[]", LLoc); 12670 return ExprError(); 12671 12672 case OR_Deleted: 12673 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 12674 << Best->Function->isDeleted() << "[]" 12675 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function) 12676 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange(); 12677 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 12678 "[]", LLoc); 12679 return ExprError(); 12680 } 12681 12682 // We matched a built-in operator; build it. 12683 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Args[0], LLoc, Args[1], RLoc); 12684 } 12685 12686 /// BuildCallToMemberFunction - Build a call to a member 12687 /// function. MemExpr is the expression that refers to the member 12688 /// function (and includes the object parameter), Args/NumArgs are the 12689 /// arguments to the function call (not including the object 12690 /// parameter). The caller needs to validate that the member 12691 /// expression refers to a non-static member function or an overloaded 12692 /// member function. 12693 ExprResult 12694 Sema::BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope *S, Expr *MemExprE, 12695 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 12696 MultiExprArg Args, 12697 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 12698 assert(MemExprE->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy || 12699 MemExprE->getType() == Context.OverloadTy); 12700 12701 // Dig out the member expression. This holds both the object 12702 // argument and the member function we're referring to. 12703 Expr *NakedMemExpr = MemExprE->IgnoreParens(); 12704 12705 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function. 12706 if (BinaryOperator *op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedMemExpr)) { 12707 assert(op->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy); 12708 assert(op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD || op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI); 12709 12710 QualType fnType = 12711 op->getRHS()->getType()->castAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 12712 12713 const FunctionProtoType *proto = fnType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 12714 QualType resultType = proto->getCallResultType(Context); 12715 ExprValueKind valueKind = Expr::getValueKindForType(proto->getReturnType()); 12716 12717 // Check that the object type isn't more qualified than the 12718 // member function we're calling. 12719 Qualifiers funcQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(proto->getTypeQuals()); 12720 12721 QualType objectType = op->getLHS()->getType(); 12722 if (op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI) 12723 objectType = objectType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 12724 Qualifiers objectQuals = objectType.getQualifiers(); 12725 12726 Qualifiers difference = objectQuals - funcQuals; 12727 difference.removeObjCGCAttr(); 12728 difference.removeAddressSpace(); 12729 if (difference) { 12730 std::string qualsString = difference.getAsString(); 12731 Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_pointer_to_member_call_drops_quals) 12732 << fnType.getUnqualifiedType() 12733 << qualsString 12734 << (qualsString.find(' ') == std::string::npos ? 1 : 2); 12735 } 12736 12737 CXXMemberCallExpr *call 12738 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args, 12739 resultType, valueKind, RParenLoc); 12740 12741 if (CheckCallReturnType(proto->getReturnType(), op->getRHS()->getLocStart(), 12742 call, nullptr)) 12743 return ExprError(); 12744 12745 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(call, op, nullptr, proto, Args, RParenLoc)) 12746 return ExprError(); 12747 12748 if (CheckOtherCall(call, proto)) 12749 return ExprError(); 12750 12751 return MaybeBindToTemporary(call); 12752 } 12753 12754 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) 12755 return new (Context) 12756 CallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args, Context.VoidTy, VK_RValue, RParenLoc); 12757 12758 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts; 12759 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts)) 12760 return ExprError(); 12761 12762 MemberExpr *MemExpr; 12763 CXXMethodDecl *Method = nullptr; 12764 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(nullptr, AS_public); 12765 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = nullptr; 12766 if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) { 12767 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr); 12768 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemExpr->getMemberDecl()); 12769 FoundDecl = MemExpr->getFoundDecl(); 12770 Qualifier = MemExpr->getQualifier(); 12771 UnbridgedCasts.restore(); 12772 } else { 12773 UnresolvedMemberExpr *UnresExpr = cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr); 12774 Qualifier = UnresExpr->getQualifier(); 12775 12776 QualType ObjectType = UnresExpr->getBaseType(); 12777 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification 12778 = UnresExpr->isArrow()? Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue() 12779 : UnresExpr->getBase()->Classify(Context); 12780 12781 // Add overload candidates 12782 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), 12783 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 12784 12785 // FIXME: avoid copy. 12786 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr; 12787 if (UnresExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 12788 UnresExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer); 12789 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer; 12790 } 12791 12792 for (UnresolvedMemberExpr::decls_iterator I = UnresExpr->decls_begin(), 12793 E = UnresExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) { 12794 12795 NamedDecl *Func = *I; 12796 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext()); 12797 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)) 12798 Func = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)->getTargetDecl(); 12799 12800 12801 // Microsoft supports direct constructor calls. 12802 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) { 12803 AddOverloadCandidate(cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func), I.getPair(), 12804 Args, CandidateSet); 12805 } else if ((Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func))) { 12806 // If explicit template arguments were provided, we can't call a 12807 // non-template member function. 12808 if (TemplateArgs) 12809 continue; 12810 12811 AddMethodCandidate(Method, I.getPair(), ActingDC, ObjectType, 12812 ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet, 12813 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false); 12814 } else { 12815 AddMethodTemplateCandidate( 12816 cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Func), I.getPair(), ActingDC, 12817 TemplateArgs, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet, 12818 /*SuppressUsedConversions=*/false); 12819 } 12820 } 12821 12822 DeclarationName DeclName = UnresExpr->getMemberName(); 12823 12824 UnbridgedCasts.restore(); 12825 12826 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 12827 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UnresExpr->getLocStart(), 12828 Best)) { 12829 case OR_Success: 12830 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function); 12831 FoundDecl = Best->FoundDecl; 12832 CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(UnresExpr, Best->FoundDecl); 12833 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UnresExpr->getNameLoc())) 12834 return ExprError(); 12835 // If FoundDecl is different from Method (such as if one is a template 12836 // and the other a specialization), make sure DiagnoseUseOfDecl is 12837 // called on both. 12838 // FIXME: This would be more comprehensively addressed by modifying 12839 // DiagnoseUseOfDecl to accept both the FoundDecl and the decl 12840 // being used. 12841 if (Method != FoundDecl.getDecl() && 12842 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Method, UnresExpr->getNameLoc())) 12843 return ExprError(); 12844 break; 12845 12846 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 12847 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), 12848 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call) 12849 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange(); 12850 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 12851 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions! 12852 return ExprError(); 12853 12854 case OR_Ambiguous: 12855 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_member_call) 12856 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange(); 12857 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 12858 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions! 12859 return ExprError(); 12860 12861 case OR_Deleted: 12862 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_member_call) 12863 << Best->Function->isDeleted() 12864 << DeclName 12865 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function) 12866 << MemExprE->getSourceRange(); 12867 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 12868 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions! 12869 return ExprError(); 12870 } 12871 12872 MemExprE = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(MemExprE, FoundDecl, Method); 12873 12874 // If overload resolution picked a static member, build a 12875 // non-member call based on that function. 12876 if (Method->isStatic()) { 12877 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(MemExprE, Method, LParenLoc, Args, 12878 RParenLoc); 12879 } 12880 12881 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(MemExprE->IgnoreParens()); 12882 } 12883 12884 QualType ResultType = Method->getReturnType(); 12885 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultType); 12886 ResultType = ResultType.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 12887 12888 assert(Method && "Member call to something that isn't a method?"); 12889 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall = 12890 new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args, 12891 ResultType, VK, RParenLoc); 12892 12893 // Check for a valid return type. 12894 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), MemExpr->getMemberLoc(), 12895 TheCall, Method)) 12896 return ExprError(); 12897 12898 // Convert the object argument (for a non-static member function call). 12899 // We only need to do this if there was actually an overload; otherwise 12900 // it was done at lookup. 12901 if (!Method->isStatic()) { 12902 ExprResult ObjectArg = 12903 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(MemExpr->getBase(), Qualifier, 12904 FoundDecl, Method); 12905 if (ObjectArg.isInvalid()) 12906 return ExprError(); 12907 MemExpr->setBase(ObjectArg.get()); 12908 } 12909 12910 // Convert the rest of the arguments 12911 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = 12912 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 12913 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, MemExpr, Method, Proto, Args, 12914 RParenLoc)) 12915 return ExprError(); 12916 12917 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args); 12918 12919 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto)) 12920 return ExprError(); 12921 12922 // In the case the method to call was not selected by the overloading 12923 // resolution process, we still need to handle the enable_if attribute. Do 12924 // that here, so it will not hide previous -- and more relevant -- errors. 12925 if (auto *MemE = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) { 12926 if (const EnableIfAttr *Attr = CheckEnableIf(Method, Args, true)) { 12927 Diag(MemE->getMemberLoc(), 12928 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call) 12929 << Method << Method->getSourceRange(); 12930 Diag(Method->getLocation(), 12931 diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_function_cond_attr) 12932 << Attr->getCond()->getSourceRange() << Attr->getMessage(); 12933 return ExprError(); 12934 } 12935 } 12936 12937 if ((isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(CurContext) || 12938 isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)) && 12939 TheCall->getMethodDecl()->isPure()) { 12940 const CXXMethodDecl *MD = TheCall->getMethodDecl(); 12941 12942 if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(MemExpr->getBase()->IgnoreParenCasts()) && 12943 MemExpr->performsVirtualDispatch(getLangOpts())) { 12944 Diag(MemExpr->getLocStart(), 12945 diag::warn_call_to_pure_virtual_member_function_from_ctor_dtor) 12946 << MD->getDeclName() << isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext) 12947 << MD->getParent()->getDeclName(); 12948 12949 Diag(MD->getLocStart(), diag::note_previous_decl) << MD->getDeclName(); 12950 if (getLangOpts().AppleKext) 12951 Diag(MemExpr->getLocStart(), 12952 diag::note_pure_qualified_call_kext) 12953 << MD->getParent()->getDeclName() 12954 << MD->getDeclName(); 12955 } 12956 } 12957 12958 if (CXXDestructorDecl *DD = 12959 dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(TheCall->getMethodDecl())) { 12960 // a->A::f() doesn't go through the vtable, except in AppleKext mode. 12961 bool CallCanBeVirtual = !MemExpr->hasQualifier() || getLangOpts().AppleKext; 12962 CheckVirtualDtorCall(DD, MemExpr->getLocStart(), /*IsDelete=*/false, 12963 CallCanBeVirtual, /*WarnOnNonAbstractTypes=*/true, 12964 MemExpr->getMemberLoc()); 12965 } 12966 12967 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 12968 } 12969 12970 /// BuildCallToObjectOfClassType - Build a call to an object of class 12971 /// type (C++ [over.call.object]), which can end up invoking an 12972 /// overloaded function call operator (@c operator()) or performing a 12973 /// user-defined conversion on the object argument. 12974 ExprResult 12975 Sema::BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope *S, Expr *Obj, 12976 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 12977 MultiExprArg Args, 12978 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 12979 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Obj)) 12980 return ExprError(); 12981 ExprResult Object = Obj; 12982 12983 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts; 12984 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts)) 12985 return ExprError(); 12986 12987 assert(Object.get()->getType()->isRecordType() && 12988 "Requires object type argument"); 12989 const RecordType *Record = Object.get()->getType()->getAs<RecordType>(); 12990 12991 // C++ [over.call.object]p1: 12992 // If the primary-expression E in the function call syntax 12993 // evaluates to a class object of type "cv T", then the set of 12994 // candidate functions includes at least the function call 12995 // operators of T. The function call operators of T are obtained by 12996 // ordinary lookup of the name operator() in the context of 12997 // (E).operator(). 12998 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LParenLoc, 12999 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator); 13000 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call); 13001 13002 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Object.get()->getType(), 13003 diag::err_incomplete_object_call, Object.get())) 13004 return true; 13005 13006 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, LParenLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 13007 LookupQualifiedName(R, Record->getDecl()); 13008 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 13009 13010 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end(); 13011 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) { 13012 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Object.get()->getType(), 13013 Object.get()->Classify(Context), Args, CandidateSet, 13014 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false); 13015 } 13016 13017 // C++ [over.call.object]p2: 13018 // In addition, for each (non-explicit in C++0x) conversion function 13019 // declared in T of the form 13020 // 13021 // operator conversion-type-id () cv-qualifier; 13022 // 13023 // where cv-qualifier is the same cv-qualification as, or a 13024 // greater cv-qualification than, cv, and where conversion-type-id 13025 // denotes the type "pointer to function of (P1,...,Pn) returning 13026 // R", or the type "reference to pointer to function of 13027 // (P1,...,Pn) returning R", or the type "reference to function 13028 // of (P1,...,Pn) returning R", a surrogate call function [...] 13029 // is also considered as a candidate function. Similarly, 13030 // surrogate call functions are added to the set of candidate 13031 // functions for each conversion function declared in an 13032 // accessible base class provided the function is not hidden 13033 // within T by another intervening declaration. 13034 const auto &Conversions = 13035 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions(); 13036 for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) { 13037 NamedDecl *D = *I; 13038 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()); 13039 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 13040 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 13041 13042 // Skip over templated conversion functions; they aren't 13043 // surrogates. 13044 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)) 13045 continue; 13046 13047 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D); 13048 if (!Conv->isExplicit()) { 13049 // Strip the reference type (if any) and then the pointer type (if 13050 // any) to get down to what might be a function type. 13051 QualType ConvType = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(); 13052 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>()) 13053 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType(); 13054 13055 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 13056 { 13057 AddSurrogateCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingContext, Proto, 13058 Object.get(), Args, CandidateSet); 13059 } 13060 } 13061 } 13062 13063 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 13064 13065 // Perform overload resolution. 13066 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 13067 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Object.get()->getLocStart(), 13068 Best)) { 13069 case OR_Success: 13070 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the appropriate call 13071 // below. 13072 break; 13073 13074 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 13075 if (CandidateSet.empty()) 13076 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_no_oper) 13077 << Object.get()->getType() << /*call*/ 1 13078 << Object.get()->getSourceRange(); 13079 else 13080 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(), 13081 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_object_call) 13082 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange(); 13083 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 13084 break; 13085 13086 case OR_Ambiguous: 13087 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(), 13088 diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_object_call) 13089 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange(); 13090 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args); 13091 break; 13092 13093 case OR_Deleted: 13094 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(), 13095 diag::err_ovl_deleted_object_call) 13096 << Best->Function->isDeleted() 13097 << Object.get()->getType() 13098 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function) 13099 << Object.get()->getSourceRange(); 13100 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 13101 break; 13102 } 13103 13104 if (Best == CandidateSet.end()) 13105 return true; 13106 13107 UnbridgedCasts.restore(); 13108 13109 if (Best->Function == nullptr) { 13110 // Since there is no function declaration, this is one of the 13111 // surrogate candidates. Dig out the conversion function. 13112 CXXConversionDecl *Conv 13113 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>( 13114 Best->Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction); 13115 13116 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), nullptr, 13117 Best->FoundDecl); 13118 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc)) 13119 return ExprError(); 13120 assert(Conv == Best->FoundDecl.getDecl() && 13121 "Found Decl & conversion-to-functionptr should be same, right?!"); 13122 // We selected one of the surrogate functions that converts the 13123 // object parameter to a function pointer. Perform the conversion 13124 // on the object argument, then let ActOnCallExpr finish the job. 13125 13126 // Create an implicit member expr to refer to the conversion operator. 13127 // and then call it. 13128 ExprResult Call = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(Object.get(), Best->FoundDecl, 13129 Conv, HadMultipleCandidates); 13130 if (Call.isInvalid()) 13131 return ExprError(); 13132 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast. 13133 Call = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, Call.get()->getType(), 13134 CK_UserDefinedConversion, Call.get(), 13135 nullptr, VK_RValue); 13136 13137 return ActOnCallExpr(S, Call.get(), LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc); 13138 } 13139 13140 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), nullptr, Best->FoundDecl); 13141 13142 // We found an overloaded operator(). Build a CXXOperatorCallExpr 13143 // that calls this method, using Object for the implicit object 13144 // parameter and passing along the remaining arguments. 13145 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function); 13146 13147 // An error diagnostic has already been printed when parsing the declaration. 13148 if (Method->isInvalidDecl()) 13149 return ExprError(); 13150 13151 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = 13152 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 13153 13154 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 13155 13156 DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo( 13157 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call), LParenLoc); 13158 OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc)); 13159 ExprResult NewFn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl, 13160 Obj, HadMultipleCandidates, 13161 OpLocInfo.getLoc(), 13162 OpLocInfo.getInfo()); 13163 if (NewFn.isInvalid()) 13164 return true; 13165 13166 // Build the full argument list for the method call (the implicit object 13167 // parameter is placed at the beginning of the list). 13168 SmallVector<Expr *, 8> MethodArgs(Args.size() + 1); 13169 MethodArgs[0] = Object.get(); 13170 std::copy(Args.begin(), Args.end(), MethodArgs.begin() + 1); 13171 13172 // Once we've built TheCall, all of the expressions are properly 13173 // owned. 13174 QualType ResultTy = Method->getReturnType(); 13175 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 13176 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 13177 13178 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = new (Context) 13179 CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Call, NewFn.get(), MethodArgs, ResultTy, 13180 VK, RParenLoc, FPOptions()); 13181 13182 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), LParenLoc, TheCall, Method)) 13183 return true; 13184 13185 // We may have default arguments. If so, we need to allocate more 13186 // slots in the call for them. 13187 if (Args.size() < NumParams) 13188 TheCall->setNumArgs(Context, NumParams + 1); 13189 13190 bool IsError = false; 13191 13192 // Initialize the implicit object parameter. 13193 ExprResult ObjRes = 13194 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Object.get(), /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, 13195 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 13196 if (ObjRes.isInvalid()) 13197 IsError = true; 13198 else 13199 Object = ObjRes; 13200 TheCall->setArg(0, Object.get()); 13201 13202 // Check the argument types. 13203 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumParams; i++) { 13204 Expr *Arg; 13205 if (i < Args.size()) { 13206 Arg = Args[i]; 13207 13208 // Pass the argument. 13209 13210 ExprResult InputInit 13211 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 13212 Context, 13213 Method->getParamDecl(i)), 13214 SourceLocation(), Arg); 13215 13216 IsError |= InputInit.isInvalid(); 13217 Arg = InputInit.getAs<Expr>(); 13218 } else { 13219 ExprResult DefArg 13220 = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(LParenLoc, Method, Method->getParamDecl(i)); 13221 if (DefArg.isInvalid()) { 13222 IsError = true; 13223 break; 13224 } 13225 13226 Arg = DefArg.getAs<Expr>(); 13227 } 13228 13229 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg); 13230 } 13231 13232 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...". 13233 if (Proto->isVariadic()) { 13234 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7). 13235 for (unsigned i = NumParams, e = Args.size(); i < e; i++) { 13236 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod, 13237 nullptr); 13238 IsError |= Arg.isInvalid(); 13239 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg.get()); 13240 } 13241 } 13242 13243 if (IsError) return true; 13244 13245 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args); 13246 13247 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto)) 13248 return true; 13249 13250 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 13251 } 13252 13253 /// BuildOverloadedArrowExpr - Build a call to an overloaded @c operator-> 13254 /// (if one exists), where @c Base is an expression of class type and 13255 /// @c Member is the name of the member we're trying to find. 13256 ExprResult 13257 Sema::BuildOverloadedArrowExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc, 13258 bool *NoArrowOperatorFound) { 13259 assert(Base->getType()->isRecordType() && 13260 "left-hand side must have class type"); 13261 13262 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Base)) 13263 return ExprError(); 13264 13265 SourceLocation Loc = Base->getExprLoc(); 13266 13267 // C++ [over.ref]p1: 13268 // 13269 // [...] An expression x->m is interpreted as (x.operator->())->m 13270 // for a class object x of type T if T::operator->() exists and if 13271 // the operator is selected as the best match function by the 13272 // overload resolution mechanism (13.3). 13273 DeclarationName OpName = 13274 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Arrow); 13275 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator); 13276 const RecordType *BaseRecord = Base->getType()->getAs<RecordType>(); 13277 13278 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, Base->getType(), 13279 diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag, Base)) 13280 return ExprError(); 13281 13282 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 13283 LookupQualifiedName(R, BaseRecord->getDecl()); 13284 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 13285 13286 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end(); 13287 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) { 13288 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Base->getType(), Base->Classify(Context), 13289 None, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false); 13290 } 13291 13292 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 13293 13294 // Perform overload resolution. 13295 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 13296 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) { 13297 case OR_Success: 13298 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the call below. 13299 break; 13300 13301 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 13302 if (CandidateSet.empty()) { 13303 QualType BaseType = Base->getType(); 13304 if (NoArrowOperatorFound) { 13305 // Report this specific error to the caller instead of emitting a 13306 // diagnostic, as requested. 13307 *NoArrowOperatorFound = true; 13308 return ExprError(); 13309 } 13310 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow) 13311 << BaseType << Base->getSourceRange(); 13312 if (BaseType->isRecordType() && !BaseType->isPointerType()) { 13313 Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion) 13314 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "."); 13315 } 13316 } else 13317 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper) 13318 << "operator->" << Base->getSourceRange(); 13319 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base); 13320 return ExprError(); 13321 13322 case OR_Ambiguous: 13323 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary) 13324 << "->" << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange(); 13325 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Base); 13326 return ExprError(); 13327 13328 case OR_Deleted: 13329 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper) 13330 << Best->Function->isDeleted() 13331 << "->" 13332 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function) 13333 << Base->getSourceRange(); 13334 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base); 13335 return ExprError(); 13336 } 13337 13338 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Base, nullptr, Best->FoundDecl); 13339 13340 // Convert the object parameter. 13341 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function); 13342 ExprResult BaseResult = 13343 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Base, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, 13344 Best->FoundDecl, Method); 13345 if (BaseResult.isInvalid()) 13346 return ExprError(); 13347 Base = BaseResult.get(); 13348 13349 // Build the operator call. 13350 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl, 13351 Base, HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc); 13352 if (FnExpr.isInvalid()) 13353 return ExprError(); 13354 13355 QualType ResultTy = Method->getReturnType(); 13356 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 13357 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 13358 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = 13359 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Arrow, FnExpr.get(), 13360 Base, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, FPOptions()); 13361 13362 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall, Method)) 13363 return ExprError(); 13364 13365 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, 13366 Method->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>())) 13367 return ExprError(); 13368 13369 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 13370 } 13371 13372 /// BuildLiteralOperatorCall - Build a UserDefinedLiteral by creating a call to 13373 /// a literal operator described by the provided lookup results. 13374 ExprResult Sema::BuildLiteralOperatorCall(LookupResult &R, 13375 DeclarationNameInfo &SuffixInfo, 13376 ArrayRef<Expr*> Args, 13377 SourceLocation LitEndLoc, 13378 TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) { 13379 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = SuffixInfo.getCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(); 13380 13381 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UDSuffixLoc, 13382 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 13383 AddFunctionCandidates(R.asUnresolvedSet(), Args, CandidateSet, TemplateArgs, 13384 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true); 13385 13386 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1); 13387 13388 // Perform overload resolution. This will usually be trivial, but might need 13389 // to perform substitutions for a literal operator template. 13390 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 13391 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UDSuffixLoc, Best)) { 13392 case OR_Success: 13393 case OR_Deleted: 13394 break; 13395 13396 case OR_No_Viable_Function: 13397 Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call) 13398 << R.getLookupName(); 13399 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args); 13400 return ExprError(); 13401 13402 case OR_Ambiguous: 13403 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call) << R.getLookupName(); 13404 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args); 13405 return ExprError(); 13406 } 13407 13408 FunctionDecl *FD = Best->Function; 13409 ExprResult Fn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FD, Best->FoundDecl, 13410 nullptr, HadMultipleCandidates, 13411 SuffixInfo.getLoc(), 13412 SuffixInfo.getInfo()); 13413 if (Fn.isInvalid()) 13414 return true; 13415 13416 // Check the argument types. This should almost always be a no-op, except 13417 // that array-to-pointer decay is applied to string literals. 13418 Expr *ConvArgs[2]; 13419 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) { 13420 ExprResult InputInit = PerformCopyInitialization( 13421 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, FD->getParamDecl(ArgIdx)), 13422 SourceLocation(), Args[ArgIdx]); 13423 if (InputInit.isInvalid()) 13424 return true; 13425 ConvArgs[ArgIdx] = InputInit.get(); 13426 } 13427 13428 QualType ResultTy = FD->getReturnType(); 13429 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy); 13430 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 13431 13432 UserDefinedLiteral *UDL = 13433 new (Context) UserDefinedLiteral(Context, Fn.get(), 13434 llvm::makeArrayRef(ConvArgs, Args.size()), 13435 ResultTy, VK, LitEndLoc, UDSuffixLoc); 13436 13437 if (CheckCallReturnType(FD->getReturnType(), UDSuffixLoc, UDL, FD)) 13438 return ExprError(); 13439 13440 if (CheckFunctionCall(FD, UDL, nullptr)) 13441 return ExprError(); 13442 13443 return MaybeBindToTemporary(UDL); 13444 } 13445 13446 /// Build a call to 'begin' or 'end' for a C++11 for-range statement. If the 13447 /// given LookupResult is non-empty, it is assumed to describe a member which 13448 /// will be invoked. Otherwise, the function will be found via argument 13449 /// dependent lookup. 13450 /// CallExpr is set to a valid expression and FRS_Success returned on success, 13451 /// otherwise CallExpr is set to ExprError() and some non-success value 13452 /// is returned. 13453 Sema::ForRangeStatus 13454 Sema::BuildForRangeBeginEndCall(SourceLocation Loc, 13455 SourceLocation RangeLoc, 13456 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, 13457 LookupResult &MemberLookup, 13458 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet, 13459 Expr *Range, ExprResult *CallExpr) { 13460 Scope *S = nullptr; 13461 13462 CandidateSet->clear(OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 13463 if (!MemberLookup.empty()) { 13464 ExprResult MemberRef = 13465 BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Range, Range->getType(), Loc, 13466 /*IsPtr=*/false, CXXScopeSpec(), 13467 /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(), 13468 /*FirstQualifierInScope=*/nullptr, 13469 MemberLookup, 13470 /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr, S); 13471 if (MemberRef.isInvalid()) { 13472 *CallExpr = ExprError(); 13473 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued; 13474 } 13475 *CallExpr = ActOnCallExpr(S, MemberRef.get(), Loc, None, Loc, nullptr); 13476 if (CallExpr->isInvalid()) { 13477 *CallExpr = ExprError(); 13478 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued; 13479 } 13480 } else { 13481 UnresolvedSet<0> FoundNames; 13482 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn = 13483 UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, /*NamingClass=*/nullptr, 13484 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), NameInfo, 13485 /*NeedsADL=*/true, /*Overloaded=*/false, 13486 FoundNames.begin(), FoundNames.end()); 13487 13488 bool CandidateSetError = buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, Fn, Range, Loc, 13489 CandidateSet, CallExpr); 13490 if (CandidateSet->empty() || CandidateSetError) { 13491 *CallExpr = ExprError(); 13492 return FRS_NoViableFunction; 13493 } 13494 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 13495 OverloadingResult OverloadResult = 13496 CandidateSet->BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best); 13497 13498 if (OverloadResult == OR_No_Viable_Function) { 13499 *CallExpr = ExprError(); 13500 return FRS_NoViableFunction; 13501 } 13502 *CallExpr = FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, Fn, Loc, Range, 13503 Loc, nullptr, CandidateSet, &Best, 13504 OverloadResult, 13505 /*AllowTypoCorrection=*/false); 13506 if (CallExpr->isInvalid() || OverloadResult != OR_Success) { 13507 *CallExpr = ExprError(); 13508 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued; 13509 } 13510 } 13511 return FRS_Success; 13512 } 13513 13514 13515 /// FixOverloadedFunctionReference - E is an expression that refers to 13516 /// a C++ overloaded function (possibly with some parentheses and 13517 /// perhaps a '&' around it). We have resolved the overloaded function 13518 /// to the function declaration Fn, so patch up the expression E to 13519 /// refer (possibly indirectly) to Fn. Returns the new expr. 13520 Expr *Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair Found, 13521 FunctionDecl *Fn) { 13522 if (ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) { 13523 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(PE->getSubExpr(), 13524 Found, Fn); 13525 if (SubExpr == PE->getSubExpr()) 13526 return PE; 13527 13528 return new (Context) ParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), SubExpr); 13529 } 13530 13531 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) { 13532 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ICE->getSubExpr(), 13533 Found, Fn); 13534 assert(Context.hasSameType(ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(), 13535 SubExpr->getType()) && 13536 "Implicit cast type cannot be determined from overload"); 13537 assert(ICE->path_empty() && "fixing up hierarchy conversion?"); 13538 if (SubExpr == ICE->getSubExpr()) 13539 return ICE; 13540 13541 return ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, ICE->getType(), 13542 ICE->getCastKind(), 13543 SubExpr, nullptr, 13544 ICE->getValueKind()); 13545 } 13546 13547 if (auto *GSE = dyn_cast<GenericSelectionExpr>(E)) { 13548 if (!GSE->isResultDependent()) { 13549 Expr *SubExpr = 13550 FixOverloadedFunctionReference(GSE->getResultExpr(), Found, Fn); 13551 if (SubExpr == GSE->getResultExpr()) 13552 return GSE; 13553 13554 // Replace the resulting type information before rebuilding the generic 13555 // selection expression. 13556 ArrayRef<Expr *> A = GSE->getAssocExprs(); 13557 SmallVector<Expr *, 4> AssocExprs(A.begin(), A.end()); 13558 unsigned ResultIdx = GSE->getResultIndex(); 13559 AssocExprs[ResultIdx] = SubExpr; 13560 13561 return new (Context) GenericSelectionExpr( 13562 Context, GSE->getGenericLoc(), GSE->getControllingExpr(), 13563 GSE->getAssocTypeSourceInfos(), AssocExprs, GSE->getDefaultLoc(), 13564 GSE->getRParenLoc(), GSE->containsUnexpandedParameterPack(), 13565 ResultIdx); 13566 } 13567 // Rather than fall through to the unreachable, return the original generic 13568 // selection expression. 13569 return GSE; 13570 } 13571 13572 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) { 13573 assert(UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf && 13574 "Can only take the address of an overloaded function"); 13575 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) { 13576 if (Method->isStatic()) { 13577 // Do nothing: static member functions aren't any different 13578 // from non-member functions. 13579 } else { 13580 // Fix the subexpression, which really has to be an 13581 // UnresolvedLookupExpr holding an overloaded member function 13582 // or template. 13583 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(), 13584 Found, Fn); 13585 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr()) 13586 return UnOp; 13587 13588 assert(isa<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr) 13589 && "fixed to something other than a decl ref"); 13590 assert(cast<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)->getQualifier() 13591 && "fixed to a member ref with no nested name qualifier"); 13592 13593 // We have taken the address of a pointer to member 13594 // function. Perform the computation here so that we get the 13595 // appropriate pointer to member type. 13596 QualType ClassType 13597 = Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Method->getDeclContext())); 13598 QualType MemPtrType 13599 = Context.getMemberPointerType(Fn->getType(), ClassType.getTypePtr()); 13600 // Under the MS ABI, lock down the inheritance model now. 13601 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) 13602 (void)isCompleteType(UnOp->getOperatorLoc(), MemPtrType); 13603 13604 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, MemPtrType, 13605 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, 13606 UnOp->getOperatorLoc(), false); 13607 } 13608 } 13609 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(), 13610 Found, Fn); 13611 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr()) 13612 return UnOp; 13613 13614 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, 13615 Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()), 13616 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, 13617 UnOp->getOperatorLoc(), false); 13618 } 13619 13620 // C++ [except.spec]p17: 13621 // An exception-specification is considered to be needed when: 13622 // - in an expression the function is the unique lookup result or the 13623 // selected member of a set of overloaded functions 13624 if (auto *FPT = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) 13625 ResolveExceptionSpec(E->getExprLoc(), FPT); 13626 13627 if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) { 13628 // FIXME: avoid copy. 13629 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr; 13630 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 13631 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer); 13632 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer; 13633 } 13634 13635 DeclRefExpr *DRE = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context, 13636 ULE->getQualifierLoc(), 13637 ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), 13638 Fn, 13639 /*enclosing*/ false, // FIXME? 13640 ULE->getNameLoc(), 13641 Fn->getType(), 13642 VK_LValue, 13643 Found.getDecl(), 13644 TemplateArgs); 13645 MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE); 13646 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(ULE->getNumDecls() > 1); 13647 return DRE; 13648 } 13649 13650 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E)) { 13651 // FIXME: avoid copy. 13652 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr; 13653 if (MemExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 13654 MemExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer); 13655 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer; 13656 } 13657 13658 Expr *Base; 13659 13660 // If we're filling in a static method where we used to have an 13661 // implicit member access, rewrite to a simple decl ref. 13662 if (MemExpr->isImplicitAccess()) { 13663 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) { 13664 DeclRefExpr *DRE = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context, 13665 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(), 13666 MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), 13667 Fn, 13668 /*enclosing*/ false, 13669 MemExpr->getMemberLoc(), 13670 Fn->getType(), 13671 VK_LValue, 13672 Found.getDecl(), 13673 TemplateArgs); 13674 MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE); 13675 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(MemExpr->getNumDecls() > 1); 13676 return DRE; 13677 } else { 13678 SourceLocation Loc = MemExpr->getMemberLoc(); 13679 if (MemExpr->getQualifier()) 13680 Loc = MemExpr->getQualifierLoc().getBeginLoc(); 13681 CheckCXXThisCapture(Loc); 13682 Base = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, 13683 MemExpr->getBaseType(), 13684 /*isImplicit=*/true); 13685 } 13686 } else 13687 Base = MemExpr->getBase(); 13688 13689 ExprValueKind valueKind; 13690 QualType type; 13691 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) { 13692 valueKind = VK_LValue; 13693 type = Fn->getType(); 13694 } else { 13695 valueKind = VK_RValue; 13696 type = Context.BoundMemberTy; 13697 } 13698 13699 MemberExpr *ME = MemberExpr::Create( 13700 Context, Base, MemExpr->isArrow(), MemExpr->getOperatorLoc(), 13701 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(), MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), Fn, Found, 13702 MemExpr->getMemberNameInfo(), TemplateArgs, type, valueKind, 13703 OK_Ordinary); 13704 ME->setHadMultipleCandidates(true); 13705 MarkMemberReferenced(ME); 13706 return ME; 13707 } 13708 13709 llvm_unreachable("Invalid reference to overloaded function"); 13710 } 13711 13712 ExprResult Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ExprResult E, 13713 DeclAccessPair Found, 13714 FunctionDecl *Fn) { 13715 return FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E.get(), Found, Fn); 13716 } 13717